]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/gnus.texi
auto upstream
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @syncodeindex fn cp
8 @syncodeindex vr cp
9 @syncodeindex pg cp
10
11 @documentencoding UTF-8
12
13 @copying
14 Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
15
16 @quotation
17 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
18 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
19 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
20 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
23
24 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
25 modify this GNU manual.''
26 @end quotation
27 @end copying
28
29 @iftex
30 @iflatex
31 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
32 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
33 \usepackage{pagestyle}
34 \usepackage{epsfig}
35 \usepackage{pixidx}
36 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
37
38 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
39 \else
40 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
41 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
42 \pdfcompresslevel=9
43 \fi
44
45 \makeindex
46 \begin{document}
47
48 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
49 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
50 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
51 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
52
53 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
54
55 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
56 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
57 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58 \else
59 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
60 \fi
61 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63
64 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66
67 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
74 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
84 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
91
92 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
94 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
95 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
96 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
97 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
98 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
100 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
105
106 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
108 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
109 }
110
111 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
112
113 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
114 {\mbox{}}
115 }
116
117 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
118 \gnusdimen 0pt
119
120 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
121 \gnuscleardoublepage
122 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
123 \chapter{#2}
124 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
125 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
126 \thispagestyle{empty}
127 \hspace*{-2cm}
128 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
129 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
130 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
131 \end{picture}
132 \clearpage
133 }
134
135 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
136 \begin{figure}
137 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
138 #3
139 \end{picture}
140 \caption{#1}
141 \end{figure}
142 }
143
144 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
145 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
149 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
157 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
161
162 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
163 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
164 \section{#1}
165 }
166
167 \newenvironment{codelist}%
168 {\begin{list}{}{
169 }
170 }{\end{list}}
171
172 \newenvironment{asislist}%
173 {\begin{list}{}{
174 }
175 }{\end{list}}
176
177 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
178 {\begin{list}{}{
179 \labelwidth=0cm
180 }
181 }{\end{list}}
182
183 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
184 {\begin{list}{}{
185 }
186 }{\end{list}}
187
188 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
189 {\begin{list}{}{
190 }
191 }{\end{list}}
192
193 \newenvironment{samplist}%
194 {\begin{list}{}{
195 }
196 }{\end{list}}
197
198 \newenvironment{varlist}%
199 {\begin{list}{}{
200 }
201 }{\end{list}}
202
203 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
204 {\begin{list}{}{
205 }
206 }{\end{list}}
207
208 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
209 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
210 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
211
212 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
213 {
214 {
215 \ifodd\count0
216 {
217 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
218 }
219 \else
220 {
221 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
222 }
223 }
224 \fi
225 }
226 }
227 {
228 \ifodd\count0
229 \mbox{} \hfill
230 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
231 \else
232 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
233 \hfill \mbox{}
234 \fi
235 }
236
237 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
238 {
239 {
240 \ifodd\count0
241 {
242 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
243 }
244 \else
245 {
246 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
247 }
248 \fi
249 }
250 }
251 {
252 \ifodd\count0
253 \mbox{} \hfill
254 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
255 \else
256 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
257 \hfill \mbox{}
258 \fi
259 }
260
261 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
262 {
263 {
264 \ifodd\count0
265 {
266 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
267 }
268 \else
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
271 }
272 \fi
273 }
274 }
275 {
276 \ifodd\count0
277 \mbox{} \hfill
278 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
279 \else
280 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
281 \hfill \mbox{}
282 \fi
283 }
284
285 \pagenumbering{roman}
286 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
287
288 @end iflatex
289 @end iftex
290
291 @iftex
292 @iflatex
293
294 \begin{titlepage}
295 {
296
297 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
298 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
299 \parindent=0cm
300 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
301
302 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
303 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
304 \vfill
305 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
306 \vfill
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
309 \newpage
310 }
311
312 \mbox{}
313 \vfill
314
315 \thispagestyle{empty}
316
317 @c @insertcopying
318 \newpage
319 \end{titlepage}
320 @end iflatex
321 @end iftex
322
323 @dircategory Emacs network features
324 @direntry
325 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
326 @end direntry
327 @iftex
328 @finalout
329 @end iftex
330
331
332 @titlepage
333 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
334 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
335 @end ifset
336 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
337 @title Gnus Manual
338 @end ifclear
339
340 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
341 @page
342 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
343 @insertcopying
344 @end titlepage
345
346 @summarycontents
347 @contents
348
349 @node Top
350 @top The Gnus Newsreader
351
352 @ifinfo
353
354 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
355 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
356 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
357 luck.
358
359 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
360 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
361
362 @ifnottex
363 @insertcopying
364 @end ifnottex
365
366 @end ifinfo
367
368 @iftex
369
370 @iflatex
371 \tableofcontents
372 \gnuscleardoublepage
373 @end iflatex
374
375 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
376 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
377
378 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
379 being accused of plagiarism:
380
381 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
382 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
383 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
384 can even read news with it!
385
386 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
387 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
388 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
389 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
390 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
391 the program.
392
393 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
394 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
395
396 @heading Other related manuals
397 @itemize
398 @item Message manual: Composing messages
399 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
400 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
401 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
402 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
403 @end itemize
404
405 @end iftex
406
407 @menu
408 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
409 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
410 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
411 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
412 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
413 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
414 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
415 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
416 * Various:: General purpose settings.
417 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
418 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
419 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
420 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
421 * Key Index:: Key Index.
422
423 Other related manuals
424
425 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
426 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
427 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
428 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
429 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
430
431 @detailmenu
432 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
433
434 Starting Gnus
435
436 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
437 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
438 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
439 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
440 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
441 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
442 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
443 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
444 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
445 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
446
447 New Groups
448
449 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
450 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
451 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
452
453 Group Buffer
454
455 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
456 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
457 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
458 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
459 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
460 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
461 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
462 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
463 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
464 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
465 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
466 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
467 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
468 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
469 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
470 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
471 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
472 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
473
474 Group Buffer Format
475
476 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
477 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
478 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
479
480 Group Topics
481
482 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
483 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
484 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
485 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
486 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
487
488 Misc Group Stuff
489
490 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
491 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
492 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
493 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
494 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
495
496 Summary Buffer
497
498 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
499 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
500 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
501 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
502 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
503 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
504 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
505 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
506 * Threading:: How threads are made.
507 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
508 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
509 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
510 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
511 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
512 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
513 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
514 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
515 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
516 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
517 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
518 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
519 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
520 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
521 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
522 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
523 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
524 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
525 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
526 or reselecting the current group.
527 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
528 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
529 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
530 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
531
532 Summary Buffer Format
533
534 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
535 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
536 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
537 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
538
539 Choosing Articles
540
541 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
542 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
543
544 Reply, Followup and Post
545
546 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
547 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
548 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
549 * Canceling and Superseding::
550
551 Marking Articles
552
553 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
554 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
555 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
556 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
557 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
558 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
559
560 Threading
561
562 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
563 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
564
565 Customizing Threading
566
567 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
568 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
569 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
570 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
571
572 Decoding Articles
573
574 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
575 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
576 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
577 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
578 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
579 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
580
581 Decoding Variables
582
583 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
584 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
585 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
586
587 Article Treatment
588
589 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
590 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
591 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
592 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
593 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
594 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
595 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
596 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
597 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
598 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
599 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
600
601 Alternative Approaches
602
603 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
604 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
605
606 Various Summary Stuff
607
608 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
609 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
610 * Summary Generation Commands::
611 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
612
613 Article Buffer
614
615 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
616 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
617 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
618 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
619 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
620
621 Composing Messages
622
623 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
624 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
625 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
626 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
627 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
628 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
629 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
630 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
631 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
632
633 Select Methods
634
635 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
636 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
637 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
638 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
639 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
640 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
641 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
642 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
643 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
644
645 Server Buffer
646
647 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
648 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
649 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
650 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
651 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
652 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
653 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
654
655 Getting News
656
657 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
658 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
659
660 @acronym{NNTP}
661
662 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
663 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
664 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
665
666 Getting Mail
667
668 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
669 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
670 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
671 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
672 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
673 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
674 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
675 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
676 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
677 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
678 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
679 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
680 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
681
682 Mail Sources
683
684 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
685 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
686 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
687
688 Choosing a Mail Back End
689
690 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
691 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
692 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
693 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
694 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
695 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
696 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
697
698 Browsing the Web
699
700 * Archiving Mail::
701 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
702 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
703 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
704
705 Other Sources
706
707 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
708 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
709 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
710 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
711 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
712
713 Document Groups
714
715 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
716
717 Combined Groups
718
719 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
720
721 Email Based Diary
722
723 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
724 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
725 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
726
727 The NNDiary Back End
728
729 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
730 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
731 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
732
733 The Gnus Diary Library
734
735 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
736 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
737 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
738 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
739
740 Gnus Unplugged
741
742 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
743 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
744 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
745 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
746 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
747 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
748 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
749 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
750 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
751 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
752 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
753 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
754 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
755 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
756
757 Agent Categories
758
759 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
760 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
761 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
762
763 Agent Commands
764
765 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
766 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
767 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
768
769 Scoring
770
771 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
772 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
773 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
774 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
775 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
776 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
777 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
778 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
779 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
780 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
781 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
782 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
783 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
784 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
785 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
786 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
787
788 Advanced Scoring
789
790 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
791 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
792 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
793
794 Searching
795
796 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
797 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
798
799 nnir
800
801 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
802 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
803 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
804
805 Setting up nnir
806
807 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
808
809 Various
810
811 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
812 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
813 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
814 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
815 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
816 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
817 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
818 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
819 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
820 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
821 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
822 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
823 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
824 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
825 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
826 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
827 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
828 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
829 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
830
831 Formatting Variables
832
833 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
834 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
835 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
836 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
837 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
838 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
839 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
840 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
841
842 Image Enhancements
843
844 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
845 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
846 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
847 meant to be shown.
848 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
849 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
850 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
851
852 Thwarting Email Spam
853
854 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
855 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
856 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
857 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
858
859 Spam Package
860
861 * Spam Package Introduction::
862 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
863 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
864 * Spam and Ham Processors::
865 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
866 * Spam Back Ends::
867 * Extending the Spam package::
868 * Spam Statistics Package::
869
870 Spam Statistics Package
871
872 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
873 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
874 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
875
876 Appendices
877
878 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
879 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
880 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
881 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
882 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
883 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
884 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
885 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
886 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
887
888 History
889
890 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
891 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
892 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
893 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
894 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
895 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
896 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
897 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
898
899 New Features
900
901 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
902 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
903 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
904 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
905 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
906 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
907 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
908 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
909
910 Customization
911
912 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
913 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
914 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
915 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
916
917 Gnus Reference Guide
918
919 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
920 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
921 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
922 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
923 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
924 * Group Info:: The group info format.
925 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
926 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
927 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
928
929 Back End Interface
930
931 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
932 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
933 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
934 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
935 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
936 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
937
938 Various File Formats
939
940 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
941 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
942
943 Emacs for Heathens
944
945 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
946 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
947
948 @end detailmenu
949 @end menu
950
951 @node Starting Up
952 @chapter Starting Gnus
953 @cindex starting up
954
955 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
956 Heathens} first.
957
958 @kindex M-x gnus
959 @findex gnus
960 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
961 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
962 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
963 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
964 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
965 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
966
967 @findex gnus-other-frame
968 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
969 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
970 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
971
972 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
973 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
974 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
975
976 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
977 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
978
979 @menu
980 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
981 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
982 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
983 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
984 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
985 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
986 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
987 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
988 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
989 @end menu
990
991
992 @node Finding the News
993 @section Finding the News
994 @cindex finding news
995
996 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
997 @code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
998 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
999 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1000 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1001 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1002 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1003 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1004
1005 @vindex gnus-select-method
1006 @c @head
1007 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1008 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1009 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1010 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1011 secondary or foreign groups.
1012
1013 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1014 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1015
1016 @lisp
1017 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1018 @end lisp
1019
1020 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1021
1022 @lisp
1023 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1024 @end lisp
1025
1026 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1027 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1028 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1029 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1030
1031 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1032 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1033 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1034 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1035 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1036 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1037 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1038 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1039 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1040
1041 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1042 @kindex B (Group)
1043 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1044 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1045 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1046 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1047 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1048 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1049
1050 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1051 @c @head
1052 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1053 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1054 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1055 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1056 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1057 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1058 groups are.
1059
1060 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1061 you would typically set this variable to
1062
1063 @lisp
1064 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1065 @end lisp
1066
1067
1068
1069 @node The Server is Down
1070 @section The Server is Down
1071 @cindex server errors
1072
1073 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1074 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1075 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1076
1077 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1078 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1079 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1080 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1081 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1082 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1083 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1084
1085 @findex gnus-no-server
1086 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1087 @c @head
1088 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1089 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1090 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1091 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1092 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1093 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1094 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1095
1096
1097 @node Slave Gnusae
1098 @section Slave Gnusae
1099 @cindex slave
1100
1101 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1102 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1103 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1104 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1105
1106 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1107 @file{.newsrc} file.
1108
1109 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1110 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1111 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1112 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1113 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1114 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1115 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1116
1117 @findex gnus-slave
1118 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1119 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1120 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1121 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1122 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1123 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1124 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1125 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1126
1127 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1128 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1129
1130 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1131 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1132 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1133 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1134 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1135
1136
1137
1138 @node New Groups
1139 @section New Groups
1140 @cindex new groups
1141 @cindex subscription
1142
1143 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1144 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1145 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1146 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1147 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1148 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1149 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1150 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1151 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1152
1153 @menu
1154 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1155 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1156 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1157 @end menu
1158
1159
1160 @node Checking New Groups
1161 @subsection Checking New Groups
1162
1163 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1164 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1165 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1166 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1167 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1168 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1169 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1170 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1171 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1172 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1173 command.
1174
1175 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1176 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1177 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1178 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1179 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1180 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1181 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1182 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1183 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1184 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1185 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1186
1187 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1188 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1189 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1190 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1191 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1192 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1193
1194
1195 @node Subscription Methods
1196 @subsection Subscription Methods
1197
1198 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1199 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1200 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1201
1202 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1203 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1204
1205 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1206
1207 @table @code
1208
1209 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1210 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1211 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1212 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1213 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1214 (with @kbd{u}).
1215
1216 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1217 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1218 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1219 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1220
1221 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1222 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1223 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1224
1225 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1226 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1227 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1228 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1229 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1230 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1231 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1232 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1233 up. Or something like that.
1234
1235 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1236 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1237 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1238 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1239 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1240
1241 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1242 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1243 Kill all new groups.
1244
1245 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1246 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1247 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1248 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1249 topic parameter that looks like
1250
1251 @example
1252 "nnml"
1253 @end example
1254
1255 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1256 that topic.
1257
1258 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1259 top-level topic.
1260
1261 @end table
1262
1263 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1264 A closely related variable is
1265 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1266 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1267 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1268 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1269 hierarchy or not.
1270
1271 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1272 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1273 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1274 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1275
1276
1277 @node Filtering New Groups
1278 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1279
1280 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1281 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1282 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1283
1284 @example
1285 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1286 @end example
1287
1288 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1289 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1290 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1291 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1292 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1293 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1294 subscribing these groups.
1295 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1296 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1297
1298 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1299 that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1300 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1301
1302 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1303 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1304 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1305 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1306 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1307 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1308 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1309 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1310
1311 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1312 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1313 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1314 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1315 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1316 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1317 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1318 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1319 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1320 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1321 variable to @code{nil}.
1322
1323 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1324 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1325 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1326 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1327 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1328 should be subscribed automatically.
1329
1330 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1331 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1332
1333
1334 @node Changing Servers
1335 @section Changing Servers
1336 @cindex changing servers
1337
1338 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1339 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1340 very flaky and you want to use another.
1341
1342 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1343 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1344
1345 @emph{Wrong!}
1346
1347 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1348 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1349 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1350 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1351 worthless.
1352
1353 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1354 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1355 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1356 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1357 Use with caution.
1358
1359 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1360 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1361 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1362 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1363
1364 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1365 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1366 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1367 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1368 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1369 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1370 cache for all groups).
1371
1372
1373 @node Startup Files
1374 @section Startup Files
1375 @cindex startup files
1376 @cindex .newsrc
1377 @cindex .newsrc.el
1378 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1379
1380 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1381 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1382 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1383 read.
1384
1385 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1386 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1387 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1388 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1389 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1390 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1391 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1392
1393 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1394 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1395 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1396 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1397 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1398 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1399
1400 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1401 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1402 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1403 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1404 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1405 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1406 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1407 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1408 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1409 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1410 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1411 news reader.
1412
1413 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1414 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1415 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1416 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1417 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1418 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1419 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1420 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1421 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1422 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1423 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1424 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1425
1426 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1427 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1428 @vindex version-control
1429 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1430 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1431 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1432 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1433 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1434 @code{version-control} variable.
1435
1436 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1437 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1438 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1439 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1440 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1441 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1442 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1443 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1444 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1445 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1446
1447 @lisp
1448 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1449 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1450
1451 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1452 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1453 @end lisp
1454
1455 @vindex gnus-init-file
1456 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1457 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1458 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1459 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1460 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1461 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1462 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1463 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1464 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1465 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1466 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1467 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1468 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1469
1470
1471 @node Auto Save
1472 @section Auto Save
1473 @cindex dribble file
1474 @cindex auto-save
1475
1476 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1477 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1478 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1479 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1480 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1481 this file.
1482
1483 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1484 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1485 saved.
1486
1487 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1488 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1489 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1490
1491 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1492 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1493 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1494 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1495 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1496 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1497
1498 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1499 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1500 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1501
1502
1503 @node The Active File
1504 @section The Active File
1505 @cindex active file
1506 @cindex ignored groups
1507
1508 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1509 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1510 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1511
1512 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1513 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1514 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1515 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1516 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1517 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1518 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1519
1520 @c This variable is
1521 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1522 @c if you set it to anything else.
1523
1524 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1525 @c @head
1526 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1527 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1528 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1529
1530 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1531 you actually subscribe to.
1532
1533 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1534 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1535 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1536 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1537
1538 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1539 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1540 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1541 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1542 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1543 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1544
1545 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1546 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1547 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1548 variable.
1549
1550 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1551 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1552 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1553 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1554 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1555 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1556
1557 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1558 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1559
1560 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1561 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1562
1563 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1564 secondary select methods.
1565
1566
1567 @node Startup Variables
1568 @section Startup Variables
1569
1570 @table @code
1571
1572 @item gnus-load-hook
1573 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1574 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1575 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1576 times you start Gnus.
1577
1578 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1579 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1580 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1581
1582 @item gnus-before-resume-hook
1583 @vindex gnus-before-resume-hook
1584 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is resumed after a suspend.
1585
1586 @item gnus-startup-hook
1587 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1588 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1589
1590 @item gnus-started-hook
1591 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1592 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1593 successfully.
1594
1595 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1596 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1597 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1598 generating the group buffer.
1599
1600 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1601 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1602 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1603 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1604 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1605 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1606 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1607 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1608
1609 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1610 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1611 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1612 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1613 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1614 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1615
1616 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1617 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1618 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1619
1620 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1621 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1622 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1623 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1624 group operation some.
1625
1626 @end table
1627
1628
1629 @node Group Buffer
1630 @chapter Group Buffer
1631 @cindex group buffer
1632
1633 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1634 @c
1635 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1636 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1637 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1638 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1639 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1640 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1641 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1642 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1643 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1644 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1645 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1646 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1647 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1648 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1649 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1650 @c human rights at 9...
1651
1652
1653 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1654 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1655 long as Gnus is active.
1656
1657 @iftex
1658 @iflatex
1659 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1660 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1661 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1662 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1663 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1664 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1665 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1666 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1667 }
1668 @end iflatex
1669 @end iftex
1670
1671 @menu
1672 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1673 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1674 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1675 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1676 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1677 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1678 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1679 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1680 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1681 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1682 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1683 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1684 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1685 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1686 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1687 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1688 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1689 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1690 @end menu
1691
1692
1693 @node Group Buffer Format
1694 @section Group Buffer Format
1695
1696 @menu
1697 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1698 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1699 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1700 @end menu
1701
1702 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1703 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1704 available in Emacs.
1705
1706 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1707 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1708 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1709 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1710 Emacs version.
1711
1712 @node Group Line Specification
1713 @subsection Group Line Specification
1714 @cindex group buffer format
1715
1716 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1717 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1718
1719 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1720
1721 @example
1722 25: news.announce.newusers
1723 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1724 @end example
1725
1726 Quite simple, huh?
1727
1728 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1729 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1730 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1731 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1732
1733 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1734 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1735 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1736 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1737 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
1738 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1739
1740 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1741
1742 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1743 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1744 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1745 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1746 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1747
1748 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1749 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1750 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1751
1752 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1753
1754 @table @samp
1755
1756 @item M
1757 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1758
1759 @item S
1760 Whether the group is subscribed.
1761
1762 @item L
1763 Level of subscribedness.
1764
1765 @item N
1766 Number of unread articles.
1767
1768 @item I
1769 Number of dormant articles.
1770
1771 @item T
1772 Number of ticked articles.
1773
1774 @item R
1775 Number of read articles.
1776
1777 @item U
1778 Number of unseen articles.
1779
1780 @item t
1781 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1782 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1783
1784 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1785 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1786 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1787 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1788 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1789 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1790 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1791
1792 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1793 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1794 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1795 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1796 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1797 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1798 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1799
1800 @item y
1801 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1802
1803 @item i
1804 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1805
1806 @item g
1807 Full group name.
1808
1809 @item G
1810 Group name.
1811
1812 @item C
1813 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1814 comment element in the group parameters.
1815
1816 @item D
1817 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1818 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1819 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1820 command.
1821
1822 @item o
1823 @samp{m} if moderated.
1824
1825 @item O
1826 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1827
1828 @item s
1829 Select method.
1830
1831 @item B
1832 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1833
1834 @item n
1835 Select from where.
1836
1837 @item z
1838 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1839 used.
1840
1841 @item P
1842 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1843
1844 @item c
1845 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1846 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1847 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1848 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1849 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1850
1851 @item m
1852 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1853 @cindex %
1854 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1855 the group lately.
1856
1857 @item p
1858 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1859
1860 @item d
1861 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1862 Timestamp}).
1863
1864 @item F
1865 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1866 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1867 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1868 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1869
1870 @item u
1871 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1872 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1873 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1874 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1875 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1876 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1877 specifier.
1878 @end table
1879
1880 @cindex *
1881 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1882 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1883 group, or a bogus native group.
1884
1885
1886 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1887 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1888 @cindex group mode line
1889
1890 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1891 The mode line can be changed by setting
1892 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1893 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1894
1895 @table @samp
1896 @item S
1897 The native news server.
1898 @item M
1899 The native select method.
1900 @end table
1901
1902
1903 @node Group Highlighting
1904 @subsection Group Highlighting
1905 @cindex highlighting
1906 @cindex group highlighting
1907
1908 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1909 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1910 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1911 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1912 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1913
1914 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1915 background is dark:
1916
1917 @lisp
1918 (cond (window-system
1919 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1920 (defface my-group-face-1
1921 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1922 (defface my-group-face-2
1923 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1924 "Second group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-3
1926 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1927 (defface my-group-face-4
1928 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1929 (defface my-group-face-5
1930 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1931
1932 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1933 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1934 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1935 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1936 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1937 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1938 @end lisp
1939
1940 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1941
1942 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1943 include:
1944
1945 @table @code
1946 @item group
1947 The group name.
1948 @item unread
1949 The number of unread articles in the group.
1950 @item method
1951 The select method.
1952 @item mailp
1953 Whether the group is a mail group.
1954 @item level
1955 The level of the group.
1956 @item score
1957 The score of the group.
1958 @item ticked
1959 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1960 @item total
1961 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1962 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1963 @item topic
1964 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1965 topic being inserted.
1966 @end table
1967
1968 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1969 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1970 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1971
1972 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1973 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1974 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1975 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1976
1977
1978 @node Group Maneuvering
1979 @section Group Maneuvering
1980 @cindex group movement
1981
1982 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1983 expected, hopefully.
1984
1985 @table @kbd
1986
1987 @item n
1988 @kindex n (Group)
1989 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1990 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1991 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1992
1993 @item p
1994 @itemx DEL
1995 @kindex DEL (Group)
1996 @kindex p (Group)
1997 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1998 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1999 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2000
2001 @item N
2002 @kindex N (Group)
2003 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2004 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2005
2006 @item P
2007 @kindex P (Group)
2008 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2009 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2010
2011 @item M-n
2012 @kindex M-n (Group)
2013 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2014 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2015 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2016
2017 @item M-p
2018 @kindex M-p (Group)
2019 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2020 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2021 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2022 @end table
2023
2024 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2025
2026 @table @kbd
2027
2028 @item j
2029 @kindex j (Group)
2030 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2031 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2032 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2033 like living groups.
2034
2035 @item ,
2036 @kindex , (Group)
2037 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2038 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2039 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2040
2041 @item .
2042 @kindex . (Group)
2043 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2044 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2045 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2046 @end table
2047
2048 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2049 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2050 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2051 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2052 is @code{t}.
2053
2054 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2055 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2056 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2057 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2058 @code{t}.
2059
2060 @node Selecting a Group
2061 @section Selecting a Group
2062 @cindex group selection
2063
2064 @table @kbd
2065
2066 @item SPACE
2067 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2068 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2069 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2070 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2071 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2072 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2073 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2074 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2075 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2076 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2077
2078 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2079 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2080 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2081
2082 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2083 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2084 ones.
2085
2086 @item RET
2087 @kindex RET (Group)
2088 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2089 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2090 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2091 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2092 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2093 entry.
2094
2095 @item M-RET
2096 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2097 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2098 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2099 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2100 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2101 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2102 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2103 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2104 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2105 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2106
2107 @item M-SPACE
2108 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2109 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2110 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2111 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2112 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2113
2114 @item C-M-RET
2115 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2116 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2117 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2118 doing any processing of its contents
2119 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2120 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2121 manner will have no permanent effects.
2122
2123 @end table
2124
2125 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2126 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2127 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2128 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2129 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2130 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2131 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2132 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2133 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2134 most recently will be fetched.
2135
2136 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2137 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2138 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2139 newsgroups.
2140
2141 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2142 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2143 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2144 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2145 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2146 are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
2147 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2148 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2149 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2150 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2151 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2152 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2153 get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
2154 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2155 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2156 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2157 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2158
2159 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2160 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2161 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2162 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2163 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2164 Which article this is controlled by the
2165 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2166 variable are:
2167
2168 @table @code
2169
2170 @item unread
2171 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2172
2173 @item first
2174 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2175
2176 @item unseen
2177 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2178
2179 @item unseen-or-unread
2180 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2181 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2182 unread article.
2183
2184 @item best
2185 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2186
2187 @end table
2188
2189 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2190 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2191
2192 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2193 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2194 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2195 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2196 selected.
2197
2198
2199 @node Subscription Commands
2200 @section Subscription Commands
2201 @cindex subscription
2202
2203 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2204 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2205 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2206 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2207 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2208
2209 @table @kbd
2210
2211 @item S t
2212 @itemx u
2213 @kindex S t (Group)
2214 @kindex u (Group)
2215 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2216 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2217 Toggle subscription to the current group
2218 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2219
2220 @item S s
2221 @itemx U
2222 @kindex S s (Group)
2223 @kindex U (Group)
2224 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2225 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2226 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2227 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2228
2229 @item S k
2230 @itemx C-k
2231 @kindex S k (Group)
2232 @kindex C-k (Group)
2233 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2234 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2235 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2236
2237 @item S y
2238 @itemx C-y
2239 @kindex S y (Group)
2240 @kindex C-y (Group)
2241 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2242 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2243
2244 @item C-x C-t
2245 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2246 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2247 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2248 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2249 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2250
2251 @item S w
2252 @itemx C-w
2253 @kindex S w (Group)
2254 @kindex C-w (Group)
2255 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2256 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2257
2258 @item S z
2259 @kindex S z (Group)
2260 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2261 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2262
2263 @item S C-k
2264 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2265 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2266 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2267 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2268 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2269 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2270 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2271 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2272 @file{.newsrc} file.
2273
2274 @end table
2275
2276 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2277
2278
2279 @node Group Data
2280 @section Group Data
2281
2282 @table @kbd
2283
2284 @item c
2285 @kindex c (Group)
2286 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2287 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2288 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2289 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2290 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2291 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2292 the group buffer.
2293
2294 @item C
2295 @kindex C (Group)
2296 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2297 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2298 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2299
2300 @item M-c
2301 @kindex M-c (Group)
2302 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2303 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2304 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2305
2306 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2307 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2308 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2309 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2310 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2311 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2312 caution.
2313
2314 @end table
2315
2316
2317 @node Group Levels
2318 @section Group Levels
2319 @cindex group level
2320 @cindex level
2321
2322 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2323 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2324 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2325 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2326 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2327
2328 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2329
2330 @table @kbd
2331
2332 @item S l
2333 @kindex S l (Group)
2334 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2335 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2336 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2337 prompted for a level.
2338 @end table
2339
2340 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2341 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2342 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2343 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2344 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2345 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2346 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2347 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2348 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2349 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2350 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2351 same, but zombie and killed groups store no information on what articles
2352 you have read, etc. This distinction between dead and living
2353 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2354 reasons of efficiency.
2355
2356 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2357 low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
2358
2359 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2360 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2361 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2362 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2363 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2364 groups are hidden, in a way.
2365
2366 @cindex zombie groups
2367 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2368 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2369 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2370 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2371 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2372 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2373
2374 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2375 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2376 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2377 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2378 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2379 list of killed groups.)
2380
2381 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2382 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2383 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2384
2385 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2386 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2387 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2388 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2389 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2390 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2391 relevant valid ranges.
2392
2393 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2394 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2395 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2396 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2397 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2398 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2399 rest.
2400
2401 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2402 one with the best level.
2403
2404 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2405 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2406 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2407 by default.
2408 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2409 be called and the result will be used as value.
2410
2411
2412 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2413 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2414 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2415 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2416 listed.
2417
2418 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2419 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2420 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2421 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2422
2423 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2424 Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
2425 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2426 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2427 to 5. The default is 6.
2428
2429
2430 @node Group Score
2431 @section Group Score
2432 @cindex group score
2433 @cindex group rank
2434 @cindex rank
2435
2436 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2437 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2438 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2439 reason?
2440
2441 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2442 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2443 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2444 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2445 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2446 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2447 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2448 least significant part.))
2449
2450 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2451 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2452 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2453 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2454 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2455 action after each summary exit, you can add
2456 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2457 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2458 slow things down somewhat.
2459
2460
2461 @node Marking Groups
2462 @section Marking Groups
2463 @cindex marking groups
2464
2465 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2466 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2467 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2468 bidding on those groups.
2469
2470 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2471 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2472 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2473
2474 @table @kbd
2475
2476 @item #
2477 @kindex # (Group)
2478 @itemx M m
2479 @kindex M m (Group)
2480 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2481 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2482
2483 @item M-#
2484 @kindex M-# (Group)
2485 @itemx M u
2486 @kindex M u (Group)
2487 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2488 Remove the mark from the current group
2489 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2490
2491 @item M U
2492 @kindex M U (Group)
2493 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2494 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2495
2496 @item M w
2497 @kindex M w (Group)
2498 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2499 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2500
2501 @item M b
2502 @kindex M b (Group)
2503 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2504 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2505
2506 @item M r
2507 @kindex M r (Group)
2508 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2509 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2510 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2511 @end table
2512
2513 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2514
2515 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2516 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2517 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2518 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2519 the command to be executed.
2520
2521
2522 @node Foreign Groups
2523 @section Foreign Groups
2524 @cindex foreign groups
2525
2526 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2527 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2528 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2529 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2530 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2531 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2532 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2533 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2534
2535 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2536 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2537 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2538 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2539 consulted.
2540
2541 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2542 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2543 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2544
2545 @table @kbd
2546
2547 @item G m
2548 @kindex G m (Group)
2549 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2550 @cindex making groups
2551 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2552 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2553 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2554
2555 @item G M
2556 @kindex G M (Group)
2557 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2558 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2559 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2560
2561 @item G r
2562 @kindex G r (Group)
2563 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2564 @cindex renaming groups
2565 Rename the current group to something else
2566 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2567 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2568 on some back ends.
2569
2570 @item G c
2571 @kindex G c (Group)
2572 @cindex customizing
2573 @findex gnus-group-customize
2574 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2575
2576 @item G e
2577 @kindex G e (Group)
2578 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2579 @cindex renaming groups
2580 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2581 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2582
2583 @item G p
2584 @kindex G p (Group)
2585 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2586 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2587 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2588
2589 @item G E
2590 @kindex G E (Group)
2591 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2592 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2593 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2594
2595 @item G d
2596 @kindex G d (Group)
2597 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2598 @cindex nndir
2599 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2600 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2601
2602 @item G h
2603 @kindex G h (Group)
2604 @cindex help group
2605 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2606 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2607
2608 @item G D
2609 @kindex G D (Group)
2610 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2611 @cindex nneething
2612 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2613 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2614 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2615
2616 @item G f
2617 @kindex G f (Group)
2618 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2619 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2620 @cindex nndoc
2621 Make a group based on some file or other
2622 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2623 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2624 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2625 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2626 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2627 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2628 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2629 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2630 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2631
2632 @item G u
2633 @kindex G u (Group)
2634 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2635 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2636 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2637 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2638
2639 @item G w
2640 @kindex G w (Group)
2641 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2642 @cindex Google
2643 @cindex nnweb
2644 @cindex gmane
2645 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2646 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2647 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2648 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2649 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2650 @xref{Web Searches}.
2651
2652 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2653 to a particular group by using a match string like
2654 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2655
2656 @item G R
2657 @kindex G R (Group)
2658 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2659 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2660 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
2661 @xref{RSS}.
2662
2663 @item G DEL
2664 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2665 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2666 This function will delete the current group
2667 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2668 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2669 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2670 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2671 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2672
2673 @item G V
2674 @kindex G V (Group)
2675 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2676 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2677 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2678
2679 @item G v
2680 @kindex G v (Group)
2681 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2682 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2683 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2684 @end table
2685
2686 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2687 methods.
2688
2689 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2690 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2691 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2692 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2693 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2694 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2695 newsgroups.
2696
2697
2698 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2699 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2700
2701 @table @code
2702 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2703 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2704 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2705 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2706 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2707 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2708 the article range.
2709
2710 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2711 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2712 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2713 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2714 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
2715 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2716 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2717 @url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2718 @url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2719 @url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2720
2721 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2722 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2723 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2724 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2725 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2726
2727 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2728 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2729 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2730 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2731 @end table
2732
2733 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2734 Buttons}.
2735
2736 Here is an example:
2737 @lisp
2738 (require 'gnus-art)
2739 (add-to-list
2740 'gnus-button-alist
2741 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2742 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2743 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2744 @end lisp
2745
2746
2747 @node Group Parameters
2748 @section Group Parameters
2749 @cindex group parameters
2750
2751 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2752
2753 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2754 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2755 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2756 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2757 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2758 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2759 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2760
2761 Here's an example group parameter list:
2762
2763 @example
2764 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2765 (auto-expire . t))
2766 @end example
2767
2768 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2769 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2770 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2771 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2772
2773 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2774 is an alist of regexps and values.
2775
2776 The following group parameters can be used:
2777
2778 @table @code
2779 @item to-address
2780 @cindex to-address
2781 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2782
2783 @example
2784 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2785 @end example
2786
2787 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2788 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2789 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2790 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2791 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2792
2793 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2794 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2795 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2796 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2797 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2798 list address instead.
2799
2800 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2801
2802 @item to-list
2803 @cindex to-list
2804 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2805
2806 @example
2807 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2808 @end example
2809
2810 It is totally ignored
2811 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2812 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2813
2814 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2815 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2816 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2817 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2818 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2819
2820 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2821 @cindex mail list groups
2822 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2823 entering summary buffer.
2824
2825 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2826
2827 @anchor{subscribed}
2828 @item subscribed
2829 @cindex subscribed
2830 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2831 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2832 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2833 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2834 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2835 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2836 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2837 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2838
2839 @lisp
2840 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2841 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2842 @end lisp
2843
2844 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2845 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2846
2847 @item visible
2848 @cindex visible
2849 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2850 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2851 of whether it has any unread articles.
2852
2853 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2854 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2855
2856 @item broken-reply-to
2857 @cindex broken-reply-to
2858 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2859 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2860 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2861 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2862 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2863 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2864
2865 @item to-group
2866 @cindex to-group
2867 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2868 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2869
2870 @item newsgroup
2871 @cindex newsgroup
2872 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2873 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2874 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2875 news group.
2876
2877 @item gcc-self
2878 @cindex gcc-self
2879 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2880 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2881 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2882 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2883 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2884 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2885 (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
2886
2887 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2888 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2889 doesn't accept articles.
2890
2891 @item auto-expire
2892 @cindex auto-expire
2893 @cindex expiring mail
2894 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2895 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2896 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2897
2898 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2899
2900 @item total-expire
2901 @cindex total-expire
2902 @cindex expiring mail
2903 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2904 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2905 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2906 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2907 expiry.
2908
2909 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2910
2911 @item expiry-wait
2912 @cindex expiry-wait
2913 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2914 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2915 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2916 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2917 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2918 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2919 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2920
2921 @item expiry-target
2922 @cindex expiry-target
2923 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2924 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2925
2926 @item score-file
2927 @cindex score file group parameter
2928 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2929 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2930 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2931
2932 @item adapt-file
2933 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2934 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2935 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2936 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2937
2938 @item admin-address
2939 @cindex admin-address
2940 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2941 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2942 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2943 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2944
2945 @item display
2946 @cindex display
2947 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2948 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item all
2952 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2953
2954 @item an integer
2955 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2956 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2957
2958 @item default
2959 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2960 ticked articles.
2961
2962 @item an array
2963 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2964
2965 Here are some examples:
2966
2967 @table @code
2968 @item [unread]
2969 Display only unread articles.
2970
2971 @item [not expire]
2972 Display everything except expirable articles.
2973
2974 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2975 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2976 responded to.
2977 @end table
2978
2979 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2980 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2981 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2982 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2983 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2984
2985 @end table
2986
2987 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2988 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2989 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2990
2991 @item comment
2992 @cindex comment
2993 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2994 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2995 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2996
2997 @item charset
2998 @cindex charset
2999 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3000 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3001 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3002
3003 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3004
3005 @item ignored-charsets
3006 @cindex ignored-charset
3007 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3008 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3009 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3010
3011 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3012
3013 @item posting-style
3014 @cindex posting-style
3015 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3016 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3017 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3018 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3019 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3020
3021 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3022 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3023 like this in the group parameters:
3024
3025 @example
3026 (posting-style
3027 (name "Funky Name")
3028 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3029 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3030 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3031 @end example
3032
3033 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3034 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3035 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3036 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3037 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3038 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3039 to.
3040
3041
3042 @item post-method
3043 @cindex post-method
3044 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3045 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3046
3047 @item mail-source
3048 @cindex mail-source
3049 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3050 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3051 mail source for this group.
3052
3053 @item banner
3054 @cindex banner
3055 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3056 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3057 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3058 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3059 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3060
3061 @item sieve
3062 @cindex sieve
3063 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3064 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3065 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3066 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3067
3068 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3069 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3070 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3071 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3072
3073 @example
3074 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3075 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3076 @}
3077 @end example
3078
3079 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3080 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3081 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3082 like the following is generated:
3083
3084 @example
3085 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3086 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3087 @}
3088 @end example
3089
3090 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3091 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3092
3093 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3094 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3095
3096 @item (agent parameters)
3097 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3098 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3099 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3100 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3101 minimize the configuration effort.
3102
3103 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3104 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3105 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3106 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3107 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3108 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3109 @code{eval}ed there.
3110
3111 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3112 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3113 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3114 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3115 form needs to be set to it.
3116
3117 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3118 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3119 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3120 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3121 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3122 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3123 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3124
3125 @lisp
3126 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3127 @end lisp
3128
3129 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3130 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3131 the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
3132
3133 @example
3134 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3135 @end example
3136
3137 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3138 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3139 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3140 into the group parameters for the group.
3141
3142 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3143 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3144 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3145 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3146 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3147
3148 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3149 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3150 following is added to a group parameter
3151
3152 @lisp
3153 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3154 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3155 @end lisp
3156
3157 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3158 expired.
3159
3160 @end table
3161
3162 @vindex gnus-parameters
3163 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3164 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3165 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3166 For example:
3167
3168 @lisp
3169 (setq gnus-parameters
3170 '(("mail\\..*"
3171 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3172 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3173 (gnus-summary-line-format
3174 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3175 (gcc-self . t)
3176 (display . all))
3177
3178 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3179 (to-group . "\\1"))
3180
3181 ("mail\\.me"
3182 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3183
3184 ("list\\..*"
3185 (total-expire . t)
3186 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3187 @end lisp
3188
3189 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3190 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3191 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3192 override the first.
3193
3194 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3195 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3196
3197 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3198 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3199 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3200 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3201 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3202 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3203 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3204 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3205 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3206 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3207 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3208 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3209
3210 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3211 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3212 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3213 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3214 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3215 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3216 weekly news RSS feed
3217 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3218 @xref{RSS}.
3219
3220 @lisp
3221 (setq
3222 gnus-parameters
3223 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3224 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3225 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3226 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3227 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3228 ("nnrss.*debian"
3229 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3230 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3231 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3232 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3233 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3234 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3235 @end lisp
3236
3237
3238 @node Listing Groups
3239 @section Listing Groups
3240 @cindex group listing
3241
3242 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3243
3244 @table @kbd
3245
3246 @item l
3247 @itemx A s
3248 @kindex A s (Group)
3249 @kindex l (Group)
3250 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3251 List all groups that have unread articles
3252 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3253 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3254 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3255 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3256 groups).
3257
3258 @item L
3259 @itemx A u
3260 @kindex A u (Group)
3261 @kindex L (Group)
3262 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3263 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3264 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3265 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3266 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3267 unsubscribed groups).
3268
3269 @item A l
3270 @kindex A l (Group)
3271 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3272 List all unread groups on a specific level
3273 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3274 with no unread articles.
3275
3276 @item A k
3277 @kindex A k (Group)
3278 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3279 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3280 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3281 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3282 from the server.
3283
3284 @item A z
3285 @kindex A z (Group)
3286 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3287 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3288
3289 @item A m
3290 @kindex A m (Group)
3291 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3292 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3293 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3294
3295 @item A M
3296 @kindex A M (Group)
3297 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3298 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3299
3300 @item A A
3301 @kindex A A (Group)
3302 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3303 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3304 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3305 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3306 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3307 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3308 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3309 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3310
3311 @item A a
3312 @kindex A a (Group)
3313 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3314 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3315 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3316
3317 @item A d
3318 @kindex A d (Group)
3319 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3320 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3321 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3322
3323 @item A c
3324 @kindex A c (Group)
3325 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3326 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3327
3328 @item A ?
3329 @kindex A ? (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3331 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3332
3333 @item A !
3334 @kindex A ! (Group)
3335 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3336 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3337
3338 @item A /
3339 @kindex A / (Group)
3340 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3341 Further limit groups within the current selection
3342 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3343 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3344 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3345 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3346 articles.
3347
3348 @item A f
3349 @kindex A f (Group)
3350 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3351 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3352
3353 @item A p
3354 @kindex A p (Group)
3355 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3356 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3357
3358 @end table
3359
3360 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3361 @cindex visible group parameter
3362 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3363 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3364 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3365 get the same effect.
3366
3367 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3368 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3369 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3370 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3371 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3372
3373
3374 @node Sorting Groups
3375 @section Sorting Groups
3376 @cindex sorting groups
3377
3378 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3379 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3380 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3381 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3382 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3383 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3384 include:
3385
3386 @table @code
3387
3388 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3389 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3390 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3391
3392 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3393 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3394 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3395
3396 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3397 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3398 Sort by group level.
3399
3400 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3401 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3402 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3403
3404 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3405 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3406 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3407 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3408
3409 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3410 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3411 Sort by number of unread articles.
3412
3413 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3414 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3415 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3416
3417 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3418 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3419 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3420
3421
3422 @end table
3423
3424 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3425 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3426 the last one.
3427
3428
3429 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3430 some sorting criteria:
3431
3432 @table @kbd
3433 @item G S a
3434 @kindex G S a (Group)
3435 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3436 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3437 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3438
3439 @item G S u
3440 @kindex G S u (Group)
3441 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3442 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3443 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3444
3445 @item G S l
3446 @kindex G S l (Group)
3447 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3448 Sort the group buffer by group level
3449 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3450
3451 @item G S v
3452 @kindex G S v (Group)
3453 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3454 Sort the group buffer by group score
3455 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3456
3457 @item G S r
3458 @kindex G S r (Group)
3459 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3460 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3461 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3462
3463 @item G S m
3464 @kindex G S m (Group)
3465 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3466 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3467 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3468
3469 @item G S n
3470 @kindex G S n (Group)
3471 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3472 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3473 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3474
3475 @end table
3476
3477 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3478 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3479
3480 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3481 commands will sort in reverse order.
3482
3483 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3484
3485 @table @kbd
3486 @item G P a
3487 @kindex G P a (Group)
3488 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3489 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3490 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3491
3492 @item G P u
3493 @kindex G P u (Group)
3494 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3495 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3496 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3497
3498 @item G P l
3499 @kindex G P l (Group)
3500 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3501 Sort the groups by group level
3502 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3503
3504 @item G P v
3505 @kindex G P v (Group)
3506 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3507 Sort the groups by group score
3508 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3509
3510 @item G P r
3511 @kindex G P r (Group)
3512 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3513 Sort the groups by group rank
3514 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3515
3516 @item G P m
3517 @kindex G P m (Group)
3518 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3519 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3520 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3521
3522 @item G P n
3523 @kindex G P n (Group)
3524 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3525 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3526 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3527
3528 @item G P s
3529 @kindex G P s (Group)
3530 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3531 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3532
3533 @end table
3534
3535 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3536 move groups around.
3537
3538
3539 @node Group Maintenance
3540 @section Group Maintenance
3541 @cindex bogus groups
3542
3543 @table @kbd
3544 @item b
3545 @kindex b (Group)
3546 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3547 Find bogus groups and delete them
3548 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3549
3550 @item F
3551 @kindex F (Group)
3552 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3553 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3554 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3555 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3556 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3557 zombies.
3558
3559 @item C-c C-x
3560 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3561 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3562 @cindex expiring mail
3563 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3564 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3565 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3566 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3567
3568 @item C-c C-M-x
3569 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3570 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3571 @cindex expiring mail
3572 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3573 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3574
3575 @end table
3576
3577
3578 @node Browse Foreign Server
3579 @section Browse Foreign Server
3580 @cindex foreign servers
3581 @cindex browsing servers
3582
3583 @table @kbd
3584 @item B
3585 @kindex B (Group)
3586 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3587 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3588 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3589 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3590 @end table
3591
3592 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3593 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3594 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3595 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3596
3597 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3598
3599 @table @kbd
3600 @item n
3601 @kindex n (Browse)
3602 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3603 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3604
3605 @item p
3606 @kindex p (Browse)
3607 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3608 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3609
3610 @item SPACE
3611 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3612 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3613 Enter the current group and display the first article
3614 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3615
3616 @item RET
3617 @kindex RET (Browse)
3618 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3619 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3620
3621 @item u
3622 @kindex u (Browse)
3623 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3624 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3625 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3626 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3627 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3628 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3629 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3630
3631 @item l
3632 @itemx q
3633 @kindex q (Browse)
3634 @kindex l (Browse)
3635 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3636 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3637
3638 @item d
3639 @kindex d (Browse)
3640 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3641 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3642
3643 @item ?
3644 @kindex ? (Browse)
3645 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3646 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3647 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3648
3649 @item DEL
3650 @kindex DEL (Browse)
3651 @findex gnus-browse-delete-group
3652 This function will delete the current group
3653 (@code{gnus-browse-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function
3654 will actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly
3655 remove the group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only
3656 if you are absolutely sure of what you are doing.
3657 @end table
3658
3659
3660 @node Exiting Gnus
3661 @section Exiting Gnus
3662 @cindex exiting Gnus
3663
3664 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3665
3666 @table @kbd
3667 @item z
3668 @kindex z (Group)
3669 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3670 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3671 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3672 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3673
3674 @item q
3675 @kindex q (Group)
3676 @findex gnus-group-exit
3677 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3678 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3679
3680 @item Q
3681 @kindex Q (Group)
3682 @findex gnus-group-quit
3683 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3684 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3685 @end table
3686
3687 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3688 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3689 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3690 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3691 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3692 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3693 exiting Gnus.
3694
3695 Note:
3696
3697 @quotation
3698 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3699 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3700 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3701 plastic chair.
3702 @end quotation
3703
3704
3705 @node Group Topics
3706 @section Group Topics
3707 @cindex topics
3708
3709 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3710 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3711 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3712 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3713 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3714 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3715
3716 @iftex
3717 @iflatex
3718 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3719 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3720 }
3721 @end iflatex
3722 @end iftex
3723
3724 Here's an example:
3725
3726 @example
3727 Gnus
3728 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3729 3: comp.emacs
3730 2: alt.religion.emacs
3731 Naughty Emacs
3732 452: alt.sex.emacs
3733 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3734 Misc
3735 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3736 13: comp.sources.unix
3737 @end example
3738
3739 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3740 @kindex t (Group)
3741 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3742 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3743 is a toggling command.)
3744
3745 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3746 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3747 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3748 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3749 Hot and bothered?
3750
3751 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3752 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3753 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3754
3755 @lisp
3756 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3757 @end lisp
3758
3759 @menu
3760 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3761 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3762 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3763 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3764 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3765 @end menu
3766
3767
3768 @node Topic Commands
3769 @subsection Topic Commands
3770 @cindex topic commands
3771
3772 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3773 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3774 definitions slightly.
3775
3776 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3777 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3778 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3779 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3780 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3781 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3782
3783 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3784 the way you like.
3785
3786 @table @kbd
3787
3788 @item T n
3789 @kindex T n (Topic)
3790 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3791 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3792 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3793
3794 @item T TAB
3795 @itemx TAB
3796 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3797 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3798 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3799 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3800 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3801 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3802
3803 @item M-TAB
3804 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3805 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3806 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3807 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3808
3809 @end table
3810
3811 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3812 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3813 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3814 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3815
3816 @table @kbd
3817
3818 @item C-k
3819 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3820 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3821 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3822 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3823
3824 @item C-y
3825 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3826 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3827 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3828 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3829 before all groups.
3830
3831 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3832 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3833 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3834 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3835 paste. Like I said---E-Z.
3836
3837 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3838 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3839
3840 @end table
3841
3842 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3843 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3844 key.
3845
3846 @table @kbd
3847
3848 @item RET
3849 @kindex RET (Topic)
3850 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3851 @itemx SPACE
3852 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3853 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3854 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3855 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3856 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3857 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3858
3859 @end table
3860
3861 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3862
3863 @table @kbd
3864
3865 @item T m
3866 @kindex T m (Topic)
3867 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3868 Move the current group to some other topic
3869 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3870 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3871
3872 @item T j
3873 @kindex T j (Topic)
3874 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3875 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3876
3877 @item T c
3878 @kindex T c (Topic)
3879 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3880 Copy the current group to some other topic
3881 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3882 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3883
3884 @item T h
3885 @kindex T h (Topic)
3886 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3887 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3888 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3889
3890 @item T s
3891 @kindex T s (Topic)
3892 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3893 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3894 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3895
3896 @item T D
3897 @kindex T D (Topic)
3898 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3899 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3900 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3901 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3902 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3903 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3904 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3905 topic.
3906
3907 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3908 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3909
3910 @item T M
3911 @kindex T M (Topic)
3912 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3913 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3914 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3915
3916 @item T C
3917 @kindex T C (Topic)
3918 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3919 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3920 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3921
3922 @item T H
3923 @kindex T H (Topic)
3924 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3925 Toggle hiding empty topics
3926 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3927
3928 @item T #
3929 @kindex T # (Topic)
3930 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3931 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3932 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3933 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3934
3935 @item T M-#
3936 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3937 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3938 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3939 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3940 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3941
3942 @item C-c C-x
3943 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3944 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3945 @cindex expiring mail
3946 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3947 expiry process (if any)
3948 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3949
3950 @item T r
3951 @kindex T r (Topic)
3952 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3953 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3954
3955 @item T DEL
3956 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3957 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3958 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3959
3960 @item A T
3961 @kindex A T (Topic)
3962 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3963 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3964 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3965
3966 @item T M-n
3967 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3968 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3969 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3970
3971 @item T M-p
3972 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3973 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3974 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3975
3976 @item G p
3977 @kindex G p (Topic)
3978 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3979 @cindex group parameters
3980 @cindex topic parameters
3981 @cindex parameters
3982 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3983 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3984
3985 @end table
3986
3987
3988 @node Topic Variables
3989 @subsection Topic Variables
3990 @cindex topic variables
3991
3992 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3993 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3994
3995 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3996 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3997 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3998 Valid elements are:
3999
4000 @table @samp
4001 @item i
4002 Indentation.
4003 @item n
4004 Topic name.
4005 @item v
4006 Visibility.
4007 @item l
4008 Level.
4009 @item g
4010 Number of groups in the topic.
4011 @item a
4012 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4013 @item A
4014 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4015 @end table
4016
4017 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4018 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4019 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4020 The default is 2.
4021
4022 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4023 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4024
4025 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4026 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4027 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4028
4029
4030 @node Topic Sorting
4031 @subsection Topic Sorting
4032 @cindex topic sorting
4033
4034 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4035 commands:
4036
4037
4038 @table @kbd
4039 @item T S a
4040 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4041 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4042 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4043 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4044
4045 @item T S u
4046 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4047 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4048 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4049 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4050
4051 @item T S l
4052 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4053 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4054 Sort the current topic by group level
4055 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4056
4057 @item T S v
4058 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4059 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4060 Sort the current topic by group score
4061 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4062
4063 @item T S r
4064 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4065 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4066 Sort the current topic by group rank
4067 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4068
4069 @item T S m
4070 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4071 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4072 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4073 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4074
4075 @item T S e
4076 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4077 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4078 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4079 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4080
4081 @item T S s
4082 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4083 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4084 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4085 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4086 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4087
4088 @end table
4089
4090 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4091 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4092 sorting.
4093
4094
4095 @node Topic Topology
4096 @subsection Topic Topology
4097 @cindex topic topology
4098 @cindex topology
4099
4100 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4101
4102 @example
4103 @group
4104 Gnus
4105 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4106 3: comp.emacs
4107 2: alt.religion.emacs
4108 Naughty Emacs
4109 452: alt.sex.emacs
4110 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4111 Misc
4112 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4113 13: comp.sources.unix
4114 @end group
4115 @end example
4116
4117 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4118 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4119 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4120 follows:
4121
4122 @lisp
4123 (("Gnus" visible)
4124 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4125 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4126 (("Misc" visible)))
4127 @end lisp
4128
4129 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4130 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4131 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4132 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4133 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4134 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4135
4136 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4137 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4138 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4139
4140
4141 @node Topic Parameters
4142 @subsection Topic Parameters
4143 @cindex topic parameters
4144
4145 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4146 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4147 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4148 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4149 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4150
4151 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4152 parameters:
4153
4154 @table @code
4155 @item subscribe
4156 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4157 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4158 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4159 topic.
4160
4161 @item subscribe-level
4162 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4163 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4164 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4165
4166 @end table
4167
4168 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4169 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4170 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4171 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4172
4173 @example
4174 @group
4175 Gnus
4176 Emacs
4177 3: comp.emacs
4178 2: alt.religion.emacs
4179 452: alt.sex.emacs
4180 Relief
4181 452: alt.sex.emacs
4182 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4183 Misc
4184 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4185 13: comp.sources.unix
4186 452: alt.sex.emacs
4187 @end group
4188 @end example
4189
4190 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4191 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4192 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4193 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4194 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4195 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4196
4197 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4198 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4199 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4200 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4201 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4202
4203 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4204 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4205 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4206 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4207 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4208 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4209 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4210 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4211
4212
4213 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4214 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4215 @cindex non-ascii group names
4216
4217 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4218 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4219 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4220 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4221 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4222 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4223 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4224 back end.
4225
4226 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4227 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4228 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4229 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4230 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4231 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4232 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4233 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4234
4235 @table @code
4236 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4237 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4238 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4239 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4240 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4241
4242 @lisp
4243 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4244 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4245 @end lisp
4246
4247 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4248 ones specified for the same groups with the
4249 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4250
4251 A select method can be very long, like:
4252
4253 @lisp
4254 (nntp "gmane"
4255 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4256 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4257 (nntp-open-connection-function
4258 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4259 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4260 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4261 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4262 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4263 @end lisp
4264
4265 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4266 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4267 the server name.
4268
4269 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4270 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4271 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4272 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4273 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4274 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4275
4276 @lisp
4277 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4278 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4279 (".*" . utf-8)))
4280 @end lisp
4281
4282 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4283 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4284 @end table
4285
4286 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4287 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4288 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4289 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4290 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4291 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4292
4293 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4294 names:
4295
4296 @table @code
4297 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4298 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4299 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4300 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4301 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4302 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4303
4304 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4305 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4306 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4307 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4308 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4309
4310 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4311 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4312 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4313 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4314 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4315 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4316
4317 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4318 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4319 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4320 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4321
4322 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4323 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4324 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4325 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4326
4327 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4328 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4329 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4330 typical case where you have to customize
4331 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4332 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4333 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4334 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4335 @end table
4336
4337 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4338 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4339 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4340 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4341
4342
4343 @node Misc Group Stuff
4344 @section Misc Group Stuff
4345
4346 @menu
4347 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4348 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4349 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4350 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4351 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4352 @end menu
4353
4354 @table @kbd
4355
4356 @item v
4357 @kindex v (Group)
4358 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4359 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4360 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4361
4362 @lisp
4363 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4364 (lambda ()
4365 (interactive)
4366 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4367 @end lisp
4368
4369 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4370 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4371
4372 @item ^
4373 @kindex ^ (Group)
4374 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4375 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4376 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4377
4378 @item a
4379 @kindex a (Group)
4380 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4381 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4382 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4383 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4384 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4385 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4386 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4387
4388 @item m
4389 @kindex m (Group)
4390 @findex gnus-group-mail
4391 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4392 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4393 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4394 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4395
4396 @item i
4397 @kindex i (Group)
4398 @findex gnus-group-news
4399 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4400 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4401 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4402
4403 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4404 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4405 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4406 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4407 for this to work though.
4408
4409 @item G z
4410 @kindex G z (Group)
4411 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4412
4413 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4414 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4415 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4416 count.
4417
4418 @end table
4419
4420 Variables for the group buffer:
4421
4422 @table @code
4423
4424 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4425 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4426 is called after the group buffer has been
4427 created.
4428
4429 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4430 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4431 is called after the group buffer is
4432 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4433 unnatural way.
4434
4435 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4436 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4437 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4438 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4439
4440 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4441 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4442 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4443 whether they are empty or not.
4444
4445 @end table
4446
4447 @node Scanning New Messages
4448 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4449 @cindex new messages
4450 @cindex scanning new news
4451
4452 @table @kbd
4453
4454 @item g
4455 @kindex g (Group)
4456 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4457 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4458 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4459 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4460 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4461 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4462 back end(s).
4463
4464 @item M-g
4465 @kindex M-g (Group)
4466 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4467 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4468 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4469 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4470 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4471 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4472 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4473
4474 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4475 @cindex activating groups
4476 @item C-c M-g
4477 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4478 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4479
4480 @item R
4481 @kindex R (Group)
4482 @cindex restarting
4483 @findex gnus-group-restart
4484 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4485 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4486 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4487
4488 @end table
4489
4490 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4491 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4492
4493 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4494 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4495 news.
4496
4497
4498 @node Group Information
4499 @subsection Group Information
4500 @cindex group information
4501 @cindex information on groups
4502
4503 @table @kbd
4504
4505
4506 @item H d
4507 @itemx C-c C-d
4508 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4509 @kindex H d (Group)
4510 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4511 @cindex describing groups
4512 @cindex group description
4513 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4514 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4515 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4516
4517 @item M-d
4518 @kindex M-d (Group)
4519 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4520 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4521 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4522
4523 @item H v
4524 @itemx V
4525 @kindex V (Group)
4526 @kindex H v (Group)
4527 @cindex version
4528 @findex gnus-version
4529 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4530
4531 @item ?
4532 @kindex ? (Group)
4533 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4534 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4535
4536 @item C-c C-i
4537 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4538 @cindex info
4539 @cindex manual
4540 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4541 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4542 @end table
4543
4544
4545 @node Group Timestamp
4546 @subsection Group Timestamp
4547 @cindex timestamps
4548 @cindex group timestamps
4549
4550 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4551 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4552 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4553
4554 @lisp
4555 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4556 @end lisp
4557
4558 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4559
4560 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4561 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4562
4563 @lisp
4564 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4565 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4566 @end lisp
4567
4568 This will result in lines looking like:
4569
4570 @example
4571 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4572 0: custom 19961002T012713
4573 @end example
4574
4575 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4576 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4577 something like:
4578
4579 @lisp
4580 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4581 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4582 @end lisp
4583
4584 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4585 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4586 trick:
4587
4588 @lisp
4589 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4590 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4591 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4592 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4593 (if time
4594 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4595 "")))
4596 @end lisp
4597
4598 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4599 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4600 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4601 either.
4602
4603
4604 @node File Commands
4605 @subsection File Commands
4606 @cindex file commands
4607
4608 @table @kbd
4609
4610 @item r
4611 @kindex r (Group)
4612 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4613 @vindex gnus-init-file
4614 @cindex reading init file
4615 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4616 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4617
4618 @item s
4619 @kindex s (Group)
4620 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4621 @cindex saving .newsrc
4622 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4623 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4624 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4625
4626 @c @item Z
4627 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4628 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4629 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4630
4631 @end table
4632
4633
4634 @node Sieve Commands
4635 @subsection Sieve Commands
4636 @cindex group sieve commands
4637
4638 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4639 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4640 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4641 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4642 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4643
4644 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4645 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4646 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4647 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4648 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4649 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4650 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4651 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4652 regenerate the Sieve script.
4653
4654 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4655 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4656 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4657 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4658 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4659 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4660 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4661 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4662 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4663 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4664
4665 @example
4666 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4667 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4668 stop;
4669 @}
4670 @end example
4671
4672 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4673
4674 @table @kbd
4675
4676 @item D g
4677 @kindex D g (Group)
4678 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4679 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4680 @cindex generating sieve script
4681 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4682 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4683
4684 @item D u
4685 @kindex D u (Group)
4686 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4687 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4688 @cindex updating sieve script
4689 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4690 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4691 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4692
4693 @end table
4694
4695
4696 @node Summary Buffer
4697 @chapter Summary Buffer
4698 @cindex summary buffer
4699
4700 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4701 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4702
4703 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4704 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4705
4706 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4707
4708 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4709 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4710 available in Emacs.
4711
4712 @kindex v (Summary)
4713 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4714 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4715 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4716 @lisp
4717 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4718 @end lisp
4719
4720 @menu
4721 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4722 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4723 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4724 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4725 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4726 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4727 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4728 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4729 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4730 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4731 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4732 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4733 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4734 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4735 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4736 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4737 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4738 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4739 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4740 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4741 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4742 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4743 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4744 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4745 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4746 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4747 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4748 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4749 or reselecting the current group.
4750 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4751 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4752 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4753 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4754 @end menu
4755
4756
4757 @node Summary Buffer Format
4758 @section Summary Buffer Format
4759 @cindex summary buffer format
4760
4761 @iftex
4762 @iflatex
4763 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4764 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4765 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4766 }
4767 @end iflatex
4768 @end iftex
4769
4770 @menu
4771 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4772 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4773 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4774 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4775 @end menu
4776
4777 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4778 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4779 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4780 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4781 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4782 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4783 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4784 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4785 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4786 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4787 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4788
4789 @lisp
4790 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4791 'mail-extract-address-components)
4792 @end lisp
4793
4794 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4795 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4796 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4797 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4798
4799
4800 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4801 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4802
4803 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4804 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4805 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4806 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4807 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4808
4809 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4810 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4811 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4812 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4813 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4814 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4815
4816 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4817
4818 The following format specification characters and extended format
4819 specification(s) are understood:
4820
4821 @table @samp
4822 @item N
4823 Article number.
4824 @item S
4825 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4826 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4827 @item s
4828 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4829 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4830 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4831 @item F
4832 Full @code{From} header.
4833 @item n
4834 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4835 @item f
4836 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4837 From Newsgroups}).
4838 @item a
4839 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4840 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4841 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4842 may be more thorough.
4843 @item A
4844 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4845 the @code{a} spec.
4846 @item L
4847 Number of lines in the article.
4848 @item c
4849 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4850 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4851 @item k
4852 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4853 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4854 @item I
4855 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4856 @item B
4857 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4858 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4859
4860 @example
4861 >
4862 +->
4863 | +->
4864 | | \->
4865 | | \->
4866 | \->
4867 +->
4868 \->
4869 @end example
4870
4871 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4872 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4873 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4874 line-drawing glyphs.
4875 @table @code
4876 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4877 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4878 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4879 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4880
4881 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4882 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4883 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4884 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4885
4886 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4887 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4888 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4889 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4890
4891 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4892 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4893 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4894
4895 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4896 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4897 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4898
4899 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4900 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4901 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4902
4903 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4904 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4905 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4906
4907 @end table
4908
4909 @item T
4910 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4911 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4912 @item [
4913 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4914 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4915 @item ]
4916 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4917 for adopted articles.
4918 @item >
4919 One space for each thread level.
4920 @item <
4921 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4922 @item U
4923 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4924
4925 @item R
4926 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4927 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4928 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4929
4930 @item i
4931 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4932 @item z
4933 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4934 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4935 default level. If the difference between
4936 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4937 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4938 @item V
4939 Total thread score.
4940 @item x
4941 @code{Xref}.
4942 @item D
4943 @code{Date}.
4944 @item d
4945 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4946 @item o
4947 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4948 @item M
4949 @code{Message-ID}.
4950 @item r
4951 @code{References}.
4952 @item t
4953 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4954 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4955 @item e
4956 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4957 article has any children.
4958 @item P
4959 The line number.
4960 @item O
4961 Download mark.
4962 @item *
4963 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4964 @item &user-date;
4965 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4966 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4967 @item u
4968 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4969 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4970 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4971 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4972 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4973 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4974 @end table
4975
4976 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4977 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4978 There can only be one such area.
4979
4980 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4981 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4982 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4983 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4984 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4985 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4986
4987 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4988 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4989
4990 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4991
4992
4993 @node To From Newsgroups
4994 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4995 @cindex To
4996 @cindex Newsgroups
4997
4998 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4999 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5000 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5001 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5002 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
5003
5004 @enumerate
5005 @item
5006 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
5007 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5008 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5009 instance:
5010
5011 @lisp
5012 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5013 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5014 @end lisp
5015
5016 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5017 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5018
5019 @item
5020 @findex gnus-extra-header
5021 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5022 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5023 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5024
5025 @example
5026 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5027 @end example
5028
5029 @item
5030 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5031 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5032 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5033 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5034 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5035 headers are used instead.
5036
5037 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5038 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5039 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5040 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5041 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5042 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5043
5044 @end enumerate
5045
5046 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5047 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5048 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5049 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5050 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5051 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
5052 regeneration.
5053
5054 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5055 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5056 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5057 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5058
5059 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5060 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5061
5062 @lisp
5063 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5064 '(To Newsgroups))
5065 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5066 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5067 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5068 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5069 "Your Name Here")
5070 @end lisp
5071
5072 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5073 to fit your needs.)
5074
5075 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5076 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5077 support:
5078
5079 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5080 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5081 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5082
5083 @example
5084 Newsgroups:full
5085 @end example
5086
5087 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5088 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5089
5090
5091 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5092 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5093
5094 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5095 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5096 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5097 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5098
5099 Here are the elements you can play with:
5100
5101 @table @samp
5102 @item G
5103 Group name.
5104 @item p
5105 Unprefixed group name.
5106 @item A
5107 Current article number.
5108 @item z
5109 Current article score.
5110 @item V
5111 Gnus version.
5112 @item U
5113 Number of unread articles in this group.
5114 @item e
5115 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5116 summary buffer.
5117 @item Z
5118 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5119 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5120 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5121 and no unselected ones.
5122 @item g
5123 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5124 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5125 @item S
5126 Subject of the current article.
5127 @item u
5128 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5129 @item s
5130 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5131 @item d
5132 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5133 @item t
5134 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5135 @item r
5136 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5137 @item E
5138 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5139 @end table
5140
5141
5142 @node Summary Highlighting
5143 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5144
5145 @table @code
5146
5147 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5148 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5149 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5150 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5151 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5152
5153 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5154 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5155 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5156 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5157
5158 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5159 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5160 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5161 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5162
5163 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5164 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5165 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5166 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5167 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5168 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5169 to something like
5170 @lisp
5171 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5172 ((> score default) . bold))
5173 @end lisp
5174 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5175 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5176 @end table
5177
5178
5179 @node Summary Maneuvering
5180 @section Summary Maneuvering
5181 @cindex summary movement
5182
5183 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5184 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5185
5186 None of these commands select articles.
5187
5188 @table @kbd
5189 @item G M-n
5190 @itemx M-n
5191 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5192 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5193 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5194 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5195 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5196
5197 @item G M-p
5198 @itemx M-p
5199 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5200 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5201 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5202 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5203 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5204
5205 @item G g
5206 @kindex G g (Summary)
5207 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5208 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5209 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5210 @end table
5211
5212 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5213 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5214 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5215 to the group buffer.
5216
5217 Variables related to summary movement:
5218
5219 @table @code
5220
5221 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5222 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5223 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5224 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5225 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5226 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5227 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5228 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5229 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5230 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5231 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5232 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5233 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5234 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5235
5236 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5237 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5238 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5239 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5240 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5241 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5242 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5243
5244 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5245
5246 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5247 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5248 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5249 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5250 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5251
5252 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5253 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5254 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5255 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5256 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5257 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5258 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5259 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5260 threads.
5261
5262 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5263 the given number of lines from the top.
5264
5265 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5266 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5267 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5268 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5269
5270 @end table
5271
5272
5273 @node Choosing Articles
5274 @section Choosing Articles
5275 @cindex selecting articles
5276
5277 @menu
5278 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5279 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5280 @end menu
5281
5282
5283 @node Choosing Commands
5284 @subsection Choosing Commands
5285
5286 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5287 and they all select and display an article.
5288
5289 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5290 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5291
5292 @table @kbd
5293 @item SPACE
5294 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5295 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5296 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5297 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5298
5299 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5300 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5301 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5302
5303 @item G n
5304 @itemx n
5305 @kindex n (Summary)
5306 @kindex G n (Summary)
5307 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5308 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5309 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5310
5311 @item G p
5312 @itemx p
5313 @kindex p (Summary)
5314 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5315 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5316 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5317
5318 @item G N
5319 @itemx N
5320 @kindex N (Summary)
5321 @kindex G N (Summary)
5322 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5323 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5324
5325 @item G P
5326 @itemx P
5327 @kindex P (Summary)
5328 @kindex G P (Summary)
5329 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5330 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5331
5332 @item G C-n
5333 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5334 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5335 Go to the next article with the same subject
5336 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5337
5338 @item G C-p
5339 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5340 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5341 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5342 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5343
5344 @item G f
5345 @itemx .
5346 @kindex G f (Summary)
5347 @kindex . (Summary)
5348 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5349 Go to the first unread article
5350 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5351
5352 @item G b
5353 @itemx ,
5354 @kindex G b (Summary)
5355 @kindex , (Summary)
5356 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5357 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5358 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5359 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5360
5361 @item G l
5362 @itemx l
5363 @kindex l (Summary)
5364 @kindex G l (Summary)
5365 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5366 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5367
5368 @item G o
5369 @kindex G o (Summary)
5370 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5371 @cindex history
5372 @cindex article history
5373 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5374 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5375 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5376 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5377 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5378 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5379
5380 @item G j
5381 @itemx j
5382 @kindex j (Summary)
5383 @kindex G j (Summary)
5384 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5385 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5386 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5387
5388 @end table
5389
5390
5391 @node Choosing Variables
5392 @subsection Choosing Variables
5393
5394 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5395
5396 @table @code
5397 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5398 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5399 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5400 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5401 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5402 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5403
5404 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5405 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5406 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5407 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5408 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5409 hook will do so.
5410
5411 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5412 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5413 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5414 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5415 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5416 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5417 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5418 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5419 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5420 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5421 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5422 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5423 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5424 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5425
5426 @end table
5427
5428
5429 @node Paging the Article
5430 @section Scrolling the Article
5431 @cindex article scrolling
5432
5433 @table @kbd
5434
5435 @item SPACE
5436 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5437 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5438 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5439 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5440 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5441
5442 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5443 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5444 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5445 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5446 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5447 what is considered uninteresting with
5448 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5449 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5450
5451 @item DEL
5452 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5453 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5454 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5455
5456 @item RET
5457 @kindex RET (Summary)
5458 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5459 Scroll the current article one line forward
5460 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5461
5462 @item M-RET
5463 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5464 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5465 Scroll the current article one line backward
5466 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5467
5468 @item A g
5469 @itemx g
5470 @kindex A g (Summary)
5471 @kindex g (Summary)
5472 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5473 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5474 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5475 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5476 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5477 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5478 treatment functions.
5479
5480 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5481 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5482 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5483 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5484
5485 @lisp
5486 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5487 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5488 (2 . big5)))
5489 @end lisp
5490
5491 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5492
5493 @item A <
5494 @itemx <
5495 @kindex < (Summary)
5496 @kindex A < (Summary)
5497 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5498 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5499 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5500
5501 @item A >
5502 @itemx >
5503 @kindex > (Summary)
5504 @kindex A > (Summary)
5505 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5506 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5507
5508 @item A s
5509 @itemx s
5510 @kindex A s (Summary)
5511 @kindex s (Summary)
5512 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5513 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5514 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5515
5516 @item h
5517 @kindex h (Summary)
5518 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5519 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5520
5521 @end table
5522
5523
5524 @node Reply Followup and Post
5525 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5526
5527 @menu
5528 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5529 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5530 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5531 * Canceling and Superseding::
5532 @end menu
5533
5534
5535 @node Summary Mail Commands
5536 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5537 @cindex mail
5538 @cindex composing mail
5539
5540 Commands for composing a mail message:
5541
5542 @table @kbd
5543
5544 @item S r
5545 @itemx r
5546 @kindex S r (Summary)
5547 @kindex r (Summary)
5548 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5549 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5550 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5551 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5552 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5553
5554 @item S R
5555 @itemx R
5556 @kindex R (Summary)
5557 @kindex S R (Summary)
5558 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5559 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5560 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5561 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5562 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5563
5564 @item S w
5565 @kindex S w (Summary)
5566 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5567 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5568 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5569 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5570 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5571 present, that's used instead.
5572
5573 @item S W
5574 @kindex S W (Summary)
5575 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5576 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5577 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5578 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5579 first article to determine the recipients.
5580
5581 @item S L
5582 @kindex S L (Summary)
5583 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5584 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5585 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5586 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5587
5588 @item S v
5589 @kindex S v (Summary)
5590 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5591 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5592 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5593 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5594 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5595 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5596
5597 @item S V
5598 @kindex S V (Summary)
5599 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5600 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5601 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5602 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5603
5604 @item S B r
5605 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5606 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5607 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5608 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5609 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5610 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5611 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5612 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5613
5614 @item S B R
5615 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5616 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5617 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5618 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5619 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5620
5621 @item S o m
5622 @itemx C-c C-f
5623 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5624 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5625 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5626 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5627 Forward the current article to some other person
5628 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5629 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5630 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5631 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5632 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5633 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5634 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5635 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5636 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5637 section.
5638
5639 @item S m
5640 @itemx m
5641 @kindex m (Summary)
5642 @kindex S m (Summary)
5643 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5644 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5645 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5646 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5647 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5648
5649 @item S i
5650 @kindex S i (Summary)
5651 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5652 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5653 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5654 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5655
5656 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5657 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5658 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5659 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5660 for this to work though.
5661
5662 @item S D b
5663 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5664 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5665 @cindex bouncing mail
5666 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5667 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5668 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5669 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5670 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5671 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5672 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5673 very well fail, though.
5674
5675 @item S D r
5676 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5677 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5678 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5679 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5680 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5681 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5682 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5683 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5684 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5685 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5686
5687 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5688 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5689 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5690 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5691 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5692
5693 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5694 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5695
5696 @item S D e
5697 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5698 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5699
5700 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5701 if it were a new message before resending.
5702
5703 @item S O m
5704 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5705 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5706 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5707 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5708 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5709
5710 @item S M-c
5711 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5712 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5713 @cindex crossposting
5714 @cindex excessive crossposting
5715 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5716 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5717
5718 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5719 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5720 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5721 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5722 command understands the process/prefix convention
5723 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5724
5725 @end table
5726
5727 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5728 Manual}, for more information.
5729
5730
5731 @node Summary Post Commands
5732 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5733 @cindex post
5734 @cindex composing news
5735
5736 Commands for posting a news article:
5737
5738 @table @kbd
5739 @item S p
5740 @itemx a
5741 @kindex a (Summary)
5742 @kindex S p (Summary)
5743 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5744 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5745 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5746 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5747 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5748
5749 @item S f
5750 @itemx f
5751 @kindex f (Summary)
5752 @kindex S f (Summary)
5753 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5754 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5755 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5756
5757 @item S F
5758 @itemx F
5759 @kindex S F (Summary)
5760 @kindex F (Summary)
5761 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5762 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5763 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5764 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5765 process/prefix convention.
5766
5767 @item S n
5768 @kindex S n (Summary)
5769 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5770 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5771 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5772
5773 @item S N
5774 @kindex S N (Summary)
5775 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5776 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5777 message through mail and include the original message
5778 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5779 the process/prefix convention.
5780
5781 @item S o p
5782 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5783 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5784 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5785 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5786 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5787 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5788 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5789 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5790 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5791 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5792 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5793 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5794 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5795
5796 @item S O p
5797 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5798 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5799 @cindex digests
5800 @cindex making digests
5801 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5802 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5803 process/prefix convention.
5804
5805 @item S u
5806 @kindex S u (Summary)
5807 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5808 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5809 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5810 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5811 @end table
5812
5813 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5814 Manual}, for more information.
5815
5816
5817 @node Summary Message Commands
5818 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5819
5820 @table @kbd
5821 @item S y
5822 @kindex S y (Summary)
5823 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5824 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5825 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5826 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5827 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5828
5829 @end table
5830
5831
5832 @node Canceling and Superseding
5833 @subsection Canceling Articles
5834 @cindex canceling articles
5835 @cindex superseding articles
5836
5837 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5838 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5839
5840 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5841
5842 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5843 @kindex C (Summary)
5844 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5845 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5846 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5847 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5848 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5849 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5850
5851 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5852 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5853 question.
5854
5855 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5856 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5857 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5858
5859 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5860 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5861 message, Message Manual}).
5862
5863 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5864 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5865 your original article.
5866
5867 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5868 @kindex S (Summary)
5869 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5870 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5871 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5872 usual way.
5873
5874 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5875 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5876 have posted almost the same article twice.
5877
5878 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5879 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5880 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5881 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5882 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5883 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5884 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5885 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5886 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5887 canceled/superseded.
5888
5889 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5890
5891 @node Delayed Articles
5892 @section Delayed Articles
5893 @cindex delayed sending
5894 @cindex send delayed
5895
5896 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5897 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5898 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5899 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5900
5901 @lisp
5902 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5903 @end lisp
5904
5905 @findex gnus-delay-article
5906 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5907 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5908 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5909 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5910
5911 @itemize @bullet
5912 @item
5913 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5914 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5915 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5916 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5917
5918 @item
5919 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5920 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5921 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5922
5923 @item
5924 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5925 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5926 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5927 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5928 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5929 that means a time tomorrow.
5930 @end itemize
5931
5932 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5933 couple of variables:
5934
5935 @table @code
5936 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5937 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5938 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5939 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5940
5941 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5942 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5943 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5944 formats described above.
5945
5946 @item gnus-delay-group
5947 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5948 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5949 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5950 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5951
5952 @item gnus-delay-header
5953 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5954 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5955 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5956 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5957 @end table
5958
5959 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5960 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5961 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5962 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5963 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5964
5965 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5966 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5967 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5968 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5969 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5970 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5971 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5972
5973 @table @code
5974 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5975 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5976 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5977 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5978 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5979 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5980 argument is ignored.
5981
5982 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5983 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5984 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5985 @end table
5986
5987 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5988 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5989 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
5990 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
5991 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
5992
5993
5994 @node Marking Articles
5995 @section Marking Articles
5996 @cindex article marking
5997 @cindex article ticking
5998 @cindex marks
5999
6000 There are several marks you can set on an article.
6001
6002 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6003 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6004 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
6005
6006 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
6007
6008 @ifinfo
6009 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6010 @end ifinfo
6011
6012 @menu
6013 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6014 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6015 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6016 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6017 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6018 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6019 @end menu
6020
6021
6022 @node Unread Articles
6023 @subsection Unread Articles
6024
6025 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6026 other.
6027
6028 @table @samp
6029 @item !
6030 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6031 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6032
6033 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6034 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6035 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6036 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6037 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6038 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6039 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6040
6041 @item ?
6042 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6043 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6044
6045 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6046 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6047 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6048 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6049 messages.
6050
6051 @item SPACE
6052 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6053 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6054
6055 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6056 @end table
6057
6058
6059 @node Read Articles
6060 @subsection Read Articles
6061 @cindex expirable mark
6062
6063 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6064
6065 @table @samp
6066
6067 @item r
6068 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6069 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6070 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6071
6072 @item R
6073 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6074 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6075
6076 @item O
6077 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6078 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6079 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6080
6081 @item K
6082 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6083 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6084
6085 @item X
6086 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6087 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6088
6089 @item Y
6090 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6091 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6092
6093 @item C
6094 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6095 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6096
6097 @item G
6098 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6099 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6100
6101 @item Q
6102 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6103 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6104 Threading}.
6105
6106 @item M
6107 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6108 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6109 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6110
6111 @end table
6112
6113 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6114 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6115
6116 One more special mark, though:
6117
6118 @table @samp
6119 @item E
6120 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6121 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6122
6123 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6124 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6125 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6126 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6127 any time.
6128 @end table
6129
6130
6131 @node Other Marks
6132 @subsection Other Marks
6133 @cindex process mark
6134 @cindex bookmarks
6135
6136 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6137 read or not.
6138
6139 @itemize @bullet
6140
6141 @item
6142 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6143 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6144 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6145 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6146 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6147
6148 @item
6149 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6150 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6151 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6152 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6153
6154 @item
6155 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6156 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6157 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6158
6159 @item
6160 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6161 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6162 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6163
6164 @item
6165 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6166 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6167 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6168 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6169
6170 @item
6171 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6172 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6173 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6174
6175 @item
6176 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6177 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6178 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6179 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6180 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6181 use.)
6182
6183 @item
6184 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6185 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6186 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6187 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6188 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6189 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6190
6191 @item
6192 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6193 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6194 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6195 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6196 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6197 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6198 use.)
6199
6200 @item
6201 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6202 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6203 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6204 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6205 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6206
6207 @item
6208 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6209 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6210 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6211 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6212 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6213 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6214
6215 @end itemize
6216
6217 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6218 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6219 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6220
6221 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6222 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6223 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6224
6225
6226 @node Setting Marks
6227 @subsection Setting Marks
6228 @cindex setting marks
6229
6230 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6231
6232 @table @kbd
6233 @item M c
6234 @itemx M-u
6235 @kindex M c (Summary)
6236 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6237 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6238 @cindex mark as unread
6239 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6240 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6241 article as unread.
6242
6243 @item M t
6244 @itemx !
6245 @kindex ! (Summary)
6246 @kindex M t (Summary)
6247 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6248 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6249 @xref{Article Caching}.
6250
6251 @item M ?
6252 @itemx ?
6253 @kindex ? (Summary)
6254 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6255 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6256 Mark the current article as dormant
6257 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6258
6259 @item M d
6260 @itemx d
6261 @kindex M d (Summary)
6262 @kindex d (Summary)
6263 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6264 Mark the current article as read
6265 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6266
6267 @item D
6268 @kindex D (Summary)
6269 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6270 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6271 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6272
6273 @item M k
6274 @itemx k
6275 @kindex k (Summary)
6276 @kindex M k (Summary)
6277 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6278 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6279 and then select the next unread article
6280 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6281
6282 @item M K
6283 @itemx C-k
6284 @kindex M K (Summary)
6285 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6286 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6287 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6288 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6289
6290 @item M C
6291 @kindex M C (Summary)
6292 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6293 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6294 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6295
6296 @item M C-c
6297 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6298 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6299 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6300 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6301
6302 @item M H
6303 @kindex M H (Summary)
6304 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6305 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6306 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6307
6308 @item M h
6309 @kindex M h (Summary)
6310 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6311 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6312 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6313
6314 @item C-w
6315 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6316 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6317 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6318 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6319
6320 @item M V k
6321 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6322 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6323 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6324 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6325
6326 @item M e
6327 @itemx E
6328 @kindex M e (Summary)
6329 @kindex E (Summary)
6330 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6331 Mark the current article as expirable
6332 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6333
6334 @item M b
6335 @kindex M b (Summary)
6336 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6337 Set a bookmark in the current article
6338 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6339
6340 @item M B
6341 @kindex M B (Summary)
6342 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6343 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6344 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6345
6346 @item M V c
6347 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6348 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6349 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6350 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6351
6352 @item M V u
6353 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6354 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6355 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6356 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6357
6358 @item M V m
6359 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6360 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6361 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6362 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6363 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6364 @end table
6365
6366 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6367 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6368 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6369 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6370 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6371 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6372 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6373 The default is @code{t}.
6374
6375
6376 @node Generic Marking Commands
6377 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6378
6379 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6380 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6381 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6382 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6383 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6384 well.
6385
6386 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6387 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6388 command should do.
6389
6390 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6391 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6392 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6393 to list in this manual.
6394
6395 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6396 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6397 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6398 article, you could say something like:
6399
6400 @lisp
6401 @group
6402 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6403 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6404 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6405 @end group
6406 @end lisp
6407
6408 @noindent
6409 or
6410
6411 @lisp
6412 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6413 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6414 @end lisp
6415
6416
6417 @node Setting Process Marks
6418 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6419 @cindex setting process marks
6420
6421 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6422 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6423 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6424 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6425 articles into the cache. For more information,
6426 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6427
6428 @table @kbd
6429
6430 @item M P p
6431 @itemx #
6432 @kindex # (Summary)
6433 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6434 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6435 Mark the current article with the process mark
6436 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6437 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6438
6439 @item M P u
6440 @itemx M-#
6441 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6442 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6443 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6444 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6445
6446 @item M P U
6447 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6448 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6449 Remove the process mark from all articles
6450 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6451
6452 @item M P i
6453 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6454 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6455 Invert the list of process marked articles
6456 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6457
6458 @item M P R
6459 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6460 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6461 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6462 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6463
6464 @item M P G
6465 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6466 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6467 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6468 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6469
6470 @item M P r
6471 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6472 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6473 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6474
6475 @item M P g
6476 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6477 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6478 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6479
6480 @item M P t
6481 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6482 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6483 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6484 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6485
6486 @item M P T
6487 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6488 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6489 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6490 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6491
6492 @item M P v
6493 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6494 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6495 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6496 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6497
6498 @item M P s
6499 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6500 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6501 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6502
6503 @item M P S
6504 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6505 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6506 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6507 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6508
6509 @item M P a
6510 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6511 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6512 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6513
6514 @item M P b
6515 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6516 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6517 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6518 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6519
6520 @item M P k
6521 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6522 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6523 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6524 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6525
6526 @item M P y
6527 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6528 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6529 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6530 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6531
6532 @item M P w
6533 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6534 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6535 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6536 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6537
6538 @end table
6539
6540 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6541 set process marks based on article body contents.
6542
6543
6544 @node Limiting
6545 @section Limiting
6546 @cindex limiting
6547
6548 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6549 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6550 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6551 buffer.
6552
6553 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6554 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6555 articles.
6556
6557 @table @kbd
6558
6559 @item / /
6560 @itemx / s
6561 @kindex / / (Summary)
6562 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6563 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6564 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6565 matching articles.
6566
6567 @item / a
6568 @kindex / a (Summary)
6569 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6570 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6571 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6572 matching articles.
6573
6574 @item / R
6575 @kindex / R (Summary)
6576 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6577 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6578 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6579 matching articles.
6580
6581 @item / A
6582 @kindex / A (Summary)
6583 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6584 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6585 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6586 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6587
6588 @item / S
6589 @kindex / S (Summary)
6590 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6591 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6592 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6593 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6594
6595 @item / x
6596 @kindex / x (Summary)
6597 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6598 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6599 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6600 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6601 matching articles.
6602
6603 @item / u
6604 @itemx x
6605 @kindex / u (Summary)
6606 @kindex x (Summary)
6607 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6608 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6609 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6610 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6611 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6612
6613 @item / m
6614 @kindex / m (Summary)
6615 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6616 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6617 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6618
6619 @item / t
6620 @kindex / t (Summary)
6621 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6622 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6623 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6624 articles younger than that number of days.
6625
6626 @item / n
6627 @kindex / n (Summary)
6628 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6629 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6630 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6631 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6632
6633 @item / w
6634 @kindex / w (Summary)
6635 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6636 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6637 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6638 the stack.
6639
6640 @item / .
6641 @kindex / . (Summary)
6642 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6643 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6644 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6645
6646 @item / v
6647 @kindex / v (Summary)
6648 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6649 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6650 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6651
6652 @item / p
6653 @kindex / p (Summary)
6654 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6655 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6656 group parameter predicate
6657 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6658 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6659
6660 @item / r
6661 @kindex / r (Summary)
6662 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6663 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6664 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6665 replied articles.
6666
6667 @item / E
6668 @itemx M S
6669 @kindex M S (Summary)
6670 @kindex / E (Summary)
6671 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6672 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6673 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6674
6675 @item / D
6676 @kindex / D (Summary)
6677 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6678 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6679 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6680
6681 @item / *
6682 @kindex / * (Summary)
6683 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6684 Include all cached articles in the limit
6685 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6686
6687 @item / d
6688 @kindex / d (Summary)
6689 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6690 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6691 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6692
6693 @item / M
6694 @kindex / M (Summary)
6695 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6696 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6697
6698 @item / T
6699 @kindex / T (Summary)
6700 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6701 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6702
6703 @item / c
6704 @kindex / c (Summary)
6705 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6706 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6707 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6708
6709 @item / C
6710 @kindex / C (Summary)
6711 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6712 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6713 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6714 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6715
6716 @item / b
6717 @kindex / b (Summary)
6718 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6719 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6720 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6721 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6722 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6723
6724 @item / h
6725 @kindex / h (Summary)
6726 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6727 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6728 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6729
6730 @end table
6731
6732
6733 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6734 prefix as well.
6735
6736 @table @kbd
6737 @item / N
6738 @kindex / N (Summary)
6739 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6740 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6741 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6742
6743 @item / o
6744 @kindex / o (Summary)
6745 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6746 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6747 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6748
6749 @end table
6750
6751
6752 @node Threading
6753 @section Threading
6754 @cindex threading
6755 @cindex article threading
6756
6757 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6758 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6759 hierarchical fashion.
6760
6761 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6762 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6763 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6764 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6765 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6766 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6767 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6768
6769 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6770
6771 @table @dfn
6772 @item root
6773 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6774
6775 @item thread
6776 A tree-like article structure.
6777
6778 @item sub-thread
6779 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6780
6781 @item loose threads
6782 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6783 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6784 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6785 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6786 called loose threads.
6787
6788 @item thread gathering
6789 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6790
6791 @item sparse threads
6792 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6793 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6794
6795 @end table
6796
6797
6798 @menu
6799 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6800 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6801 @end menu
6802
6803
6804 @node Customizing Threading
6805 @subsection Customizing Threading
6806 @cindex customizing threading
6807
6808 @menu
6809 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6810 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6811 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6812 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6813 @end menu
6814
6815
6816 @node Loose Threads
6817 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6818 @cindex <
6819 @cindex >
6820 @cindex loose threads
6821
6822 @table @code
6823 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6824 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6825 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6826 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6827 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6828 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6829
6830 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6831 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6832 There are four possible values:
6833
6834 @iftex
6835 @iflatex
6836 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6837 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6838 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6839 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6840 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6841 }
6842 @end iflatex
6843 @end iftex
6844
6845 @cindex adopting articles
6846
6847 @table @code
6848
6849 @item adopt
6850 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6851 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6852 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6853 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6854
6855 @item dummy
6856 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6857 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6858 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6859 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6860 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6861 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6862 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6863 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6864 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6865 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6866
6867 @item empty
6868 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6869 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6870 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6871 Buffer Format}).)
6872
6873 @item none
6874 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6875 display them after one another.
6876
6877 @item nil
6878 Don't gather loose threads.
6879 @end table
6880
6881 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6882 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6883 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6884 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6885 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6886 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6887 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6888 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6889 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6890 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6891 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6892
6893 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6894 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6895 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6896 Matching}).
6897
6898 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6899 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6900 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6901 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6902 simplification is used.
6903
6904 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6905 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6906 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6907 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6908
6909 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6910 @lisp
6911 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6912 (concat
6913 "\\`\\[?\\("
6914 (mapconcat
6915 'identity
6916 '("looking"
6917 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6918 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6919 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6920 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6921 ;; ...
6922 )
6923 "\\|")
6924 "\\)\\s *\\("
6925 (mapconcat 'identity
6926 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6927 "\\|")
6928 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6929 @end lisp
6930
6931 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6932 subjects.
6933
6934 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6935 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6936 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6937 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6938 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6939 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6940
6941 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6942
6943 @table @code
6944 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6945 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6946 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6947
6948 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6949 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6950 Simplify fuzzily.
6951
6952 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6953 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6954 Remove excessive whitespace.
6955
6956 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6957 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6958 Remove all whitespace.
6959 @end table
6960
6961 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6962
6963
6964 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6965 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6966 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6967 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6968 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6969 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6970 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6971 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6972
6973 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6974 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6975 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6976 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6977 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6978 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6979 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6980 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6981 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6982 cholera:
6983
6984 @table @code
6985 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6986 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6987 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6988 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6989
6990 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6991 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6992 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6993 @end table
6994
6995 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6996 something like:
6997
6998 @lisp
6999 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7000 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7001 @end lisp
7002
7003 @end table
7004
7005
7006 @node Filling In Threads
7007 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
7008
7009 @table @code
7010 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7011 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7012 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7013 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7014 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7015 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7016 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7017 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7018 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7019 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7020 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7021 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7022 do about that.
7023
7024 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7025 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7026 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7027
7028 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7029
7030 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7031 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7032 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7033 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7034 slow summary generation.
7035
7036 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7037 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7038 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7039 newsgroups.
7040
7041 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7042 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7043 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7044 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7045 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7046 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7047 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7048 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7049 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7050 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7051 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7052 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7053 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7054 @code{nil} by default.
7055
7056 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7057 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7058 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7059 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7060 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7061 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7062 web-based groups.
7063
7064 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7065 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7066 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7067
7068 @end table
7069
7070
7071 @node More Threading
7072 @subsubsection More Threading
7073
7074 @table @code
7075 @item gnus-show-threads
7076 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7077 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7078 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7079 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7080 slower and more awkward.
7081
7082 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7083 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7084 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7085 generated.
7086
7087 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7088 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7089 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7090
7091 Here's an example:
7092
7093 @lisp
7094 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7095 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7096 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7097 @end lisp
7098
7099 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7100 unread, but you get my drift.)
7101
7102
7103 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7104 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7105 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7106 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7107 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7108 threads are expunged.
7109
7110 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7111 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7112 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7113 will be hidden.
7114
7115 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7116 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7117 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7118 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7119 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7120 result in a new thread.
7121
7122 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7123 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7124 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7125 The default is 4.
7126
7127 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7128 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7129 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7130 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7131 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7132 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7133 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7134 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7135 (e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7136 appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7137 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7138
7139 @end table
7140
7141
7142 @node Low-Level Threading
7143 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7144
7145 @table @code
7146
7147 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7148 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7149 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7150
7151 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7152 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7153 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7154 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7155 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7156 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7157 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7158 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7159 meaningful. Here's one example:
7160
7161 @lisp
7162 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7163
7164 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7165 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7166 (when (string-match
7167 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7168 (mail-header-set-id
7169 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7170 header))))
7171 @end lisp
7172
7173 @end table
7174
7175
7176 @node Thread Commands
7177 @subsection Thread Commands
7178 @cindex thread commands
7179
7180 @table @kbd
7181
7182 @item T k
7183 @itemx C-M-k
7184 @kindex T k (Summary)
7185 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7186 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7187 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7188 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7189 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7190 articles instead.
7191
7192 @item T l
7193 @itemx C-M-l
7194 @kindex T l (Summary)
7195 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7196 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7197 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7198 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7199
7200 @item T i
7201 @kindex T i (Summary)
7202 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7203 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7204 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7205
7206 @item T #
7207 @kindex T # (Summary)
7208 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7209 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7210 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7211
7212 @item T M-#
7213 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7214 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7215 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7216 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7217
7218 @item T T
7219 @kindex T T (Summary)
7220 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7221 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7222
7223 @item T s
7224 @kindex T s (Summary)
7225 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7226 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7227 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7228
7229 @item T h
7230 @kindex T h (Summary)
7231 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7232 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7233
7234 @item T S
7235 @kindex T S (Summary)
7236 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7237 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7238
7239 @item T H
7240 @kindex T H (Summary)
7241 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7242 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7243
7244 @item T t
7245 @kindex T t (Summary)
7246 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7247 Re-thread the current article's thread
7248 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7249 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7250
7251 @item T ^
7252 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7253 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7254 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7255 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7256
7257 @item T M-^
7258 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7259 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7260 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7261 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7262
7263 @end table
7264
7265 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7266 understand the numeric prefix.
7267
7268 @table @kbd
7269
7270 @item T n
7271 @kindex T n (Summary)
7272 @itemx C-M-f
7273 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7274 @itemx M-down
7275 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7276 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7277 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7278
7279 @item T p
7280 @kindex T p (Summary)
7281 @itemx C-M-b
7282 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7283 @itemx M-up
7284 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7285 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7286 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7287
7288 @item T d
7289 @kindex T d (Summary)
7290 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7291 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7292
7293 @item T u
7294 @kindex T u (Summary)
7295 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7296 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7297
7298 @item T o
7299 @kindex T o (Summary)
7300 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7301 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7302 @end table
7303
7304 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7305 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7306 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7307 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7308 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7309 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7310 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7311 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7312 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7313 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7314 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7315 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7316 Matching}).
7317
7318
7319 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7320 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7321
7322 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7323 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7324 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7325 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7326 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7327 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7328 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7329 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7330 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7331 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7332 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7333 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7334 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7335 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7336 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7337
7338 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7339 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7340 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7341 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7342 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7343 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7344 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7345 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7346 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7347 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7348
7349 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7350 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7351 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7352 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7353 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7354
7355 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7356 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7357 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7358 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7359 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7360 ascending article order.
7361
7362 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7363 by number, you could do something like:
7364
7365 @lisp
7366 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7367 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7368 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7369 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7370 @end lisp
7371
7372 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7373 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7374 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7375 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7376 which the articles arrived.
7377
7378 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7379 say something like:
7380
7381 @lisp
7382 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7383 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7384 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7385 @end lisp
7386
7387 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7388 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7389 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7390 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7391 tickles your fancy.
7392
7393 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7394 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7395 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7396 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7397 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7398 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7399 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7400 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7401 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7402 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7403 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7404 variable. It is very similar to the
7405 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7406 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7407 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7408 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7409 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7410 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7411 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7412
7413 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7414 say something like:
7415
7416 @lisp
7417 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7418 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7419 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7420 @end lisp
7421
7422 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7423 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7424
7425
7426 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7427 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7428 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7429 @cindex article pre-fetch
7430 @cindex pre-fetch
7431
7432 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7433 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7434 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7435 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7436 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7437
7438 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7439 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7440
7441 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7442 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7443 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7444 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7445 connection is blocked.
7446
7447 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7448 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7449 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7450 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7451
7452 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7453 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7454 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7455 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7456 extra connection.
7457
7458 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7459 you really want to.
7460
7461 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7462 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7463 happen automatically.
7464
7465 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7466 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7467 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7468 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7469 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7470 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7471 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7472
7473 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7474 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7475 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7476 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7477 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7478 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7479 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7480 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7481 article data structure as the only parameter.
7482
7483 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7484 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7485
7486 @lisp
7487 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7488 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7489 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7490 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7491 100)))
7492
7493 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7494 @end lisp
7495
7496 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7497 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7498 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7499
7500 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7501 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7502 After an article has been prefetched, this
7503 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7504 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7505 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7506 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7507 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7508 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7509
7510 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7511 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7512 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7513 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7514
7515 @table @code
7516 @item read
7517 Remove articles when they are read.
7518
7519 @item exit
7520 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7521 @end table
7522
7523 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7524
7525 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7526 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7527 @c from the next group.
7528
7529
7530 @node Article Caching
7531 @section Article Caching
7532 @cindex article caching
7533 @cindex caching
7534
7535 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7536 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7537 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7538 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7539 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7540
7541 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7542
7543 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7544 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7545 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7546 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7547 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7548 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7549 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7550 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7551
7552 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7553 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7554 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7555 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7556 as dormant, and don't worry.
7557
7558 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7559
7560 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7561 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7562 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7563 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7564 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7565 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7566 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7567 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7568 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7569 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7570
7571 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7572 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7573 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7574 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7575 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7576 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7577 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7578 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7579 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7580 not then be downloaded by this command.
7581
7582 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7583 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7584 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7585 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7586 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7587 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7588
7589 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7590 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7591 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7592 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7593 variables, the group is not cached.
7594
7595 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7596 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7597 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7598 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7599 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7600 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7601 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7602 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7603 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7604 file.
7605
7606 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7607 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7608 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7609 where, isn't that cool?
7610
7611 @node Persistent Articles
7612 @section Persistent Articles
7613 @cindex persistent articles
7614
7615 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7616 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7617 useful in my opinion.
7618
7619 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7620 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7621 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7622 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7623 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7624 the expiry going on at the news server.
7625
7626 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7627 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7628 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7629
7630 @table @kbd
7631
7632 @item *
7633 @kindex * (Summary)
7634 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7635 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7636
7637 @item M-*
7638 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7639 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7640 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7641 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7642 article.
7643 @end table
7644
7645 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7646
7647 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7648 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7649 interested in persistent articles:
7650
7651 @lisp
7652 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7653 @end lisp
7654
7655 @node Sticky Articles
7656 @section Sticky Articles
7657 @cindex sticky articles
7658
7659 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7660 according to the value of the variable
7661 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7662 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7663 has its own article buffer.
7664
7665 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7666 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7667 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7668 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7669
7670 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7671 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7672 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7673
7674 @table @kbd
7675 @item A S
7676 @kindex A S (Summary)
7677 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7678 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7679 name for this sticky article buffer.
7680 @end table
7681
7682 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7683
7684 @table @kbd
7685 @item q
7686 @kindex q (Article)
7687 @findex bury-buffer
7688 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7689
7690 @item k
7691 @kindex k (Article)
7692 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7693 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7694 @end table
7695
7696 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7697
7698 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7699 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7700 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7701 @end defun
7702
7703 @node Article Backlog
7704 @section Article Backlog
7705 @cindex backlog
7706 @cindex article backlog
7707
7708 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7709 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7710 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7711 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7712 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7713 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7714 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7715 increase memory usage some.
7716
7717 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7718 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7719 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7720 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7721 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7722 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7723 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7724
7725 The default value is 20.
7726
7727
7728 @node Saving Articles
7729 @section Saving Articles
7730 @cindex saving articles
7731
7732 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7733 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7734 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7735 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7736 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7737
7738 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7739 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7740 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7741
7742 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7743 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7744 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7745
7746 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7747 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7748 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7749 deleted before saving.
7750
7751 @table @kbd
7752
7753 @item O o
7754 @itemx o
7755 @kindex O o (Summary)
7756 @kindex o (Summary)
7757 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7758 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7759 Save the current article using the default article saver
7760 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7761
7762 @item O m
7763 @kindex O m (Summary)
7764 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7765 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7766 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7767
7768 @item O r
7769 @kindex O r (Summary)
7770 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7771 Save the current article in Rmail format
7772 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7773 Babyl in older versions.
7774
7775 @item O f
7776 @kindex O f (Summary)
7777 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7778 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7779 Save the current article in plain file format
7780 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7781
7782 @item O F
7783 @kindex O F (Summary)
7784 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7785 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7786 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7787
7788 @item O b
7789 @kindex O b (Summary)
7790 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7791 Save the current article body in plain file format
7792 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7793
7794 @item O h
7795 @kindex O h (Summary)
7796 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7797 Save the current article in mh folder format
7798 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7799
7800 @item O v
7801 @kindex O v (Summary)
7802 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7803 Save the current article in a VM folder
7804 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7805
7806 @item O p
7807 @itemx |
7808 @kindex O p (Summary)
7809 @kindex | (Summary)
7810 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7811 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7812 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7813 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7814 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7815 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7816 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7817 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7818 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7819 @code{nil}).
7820
7821 @item O P
7822 @kindex O P (Summary)
7823 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7824 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7825 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7826 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7827 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7828 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7829 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7830
7831 @end table
7832
7833 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7834 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7835 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7836 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7837 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7838 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7839 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7840 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7841 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7842 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7843 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7844 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7845 files.
7846
7847
7848 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7849 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7850 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7851 functions below, or you can create your own.
7852
7853 @table @code
7854
7855 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7856 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7857 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7858 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7859 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7860 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7861 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7862 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7863 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7864 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7865 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7866
7867 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7868 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7869 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7870 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7871 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7872 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7873
7874 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7875 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7876 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7877 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7878 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7879 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7880 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7881
7882 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7883 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7884 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7885 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7886 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7887 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7888
7889 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7890 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7891 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7892 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7893 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7894
7895 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7896 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7897 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7898 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7899 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7900 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7901
7902 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7903 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7904 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7905 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7906 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7907 @cindex rcvstore
7908 @cindex MH folders
7909 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7910 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7911 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7912 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7913 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7914
7915 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7916 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7917 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7918 reader to use this setting.
7919
7920 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7921 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7922 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7923 arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7924
7925 @itemize @bullet
7926 @item a string@*
7927 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7928 @item @code{nil}@*
7929 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7930 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7931 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7932 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7933 last used for saving.
7934 @end itemize
7935
7936 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7937 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7938 headers will be piped.
7939 @end table
7940
7941 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7942
7943 @table @code
7944 @item :decode
7945 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7946 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7947 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7948 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7949 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7950 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7951
7952 @item :function
7953 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7954 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7955 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7956 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7957 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7958 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7959
7960 @item :headers
7961 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7962 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7963 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7964 headers should be saved.
7965 @end table
7966
7967 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7968 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7969 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7970 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7971 default.
7972
7973 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7974 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7975 available functions that generate names:
7976
7977 @table @code
7978
7979 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7980 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7981 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7982
7983 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7984 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7985 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7986
7987 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7988 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7989 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7990
7991 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7992 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7993 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7994
7995 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7996 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7997 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7998 @end table
7999
8000 @vindex gnus-split-methods
8001 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8002 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8003 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8004 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8005 like:
8006
8007 @lisp
8008 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8009 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8010 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8011 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8012 @end lisp
8013
8014 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8015 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8016 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8017 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8018 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8019 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8020 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8021 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8022 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8023
8024 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8025 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8026 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8027 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8028
8029 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8030 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8031 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8032 name.
8033
8034 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8035 lots of mail groups called things like
8036 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8037 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8038 following will do just that:
8039
8040 @lisp
8041 (defun my-save-name (group)
8042 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8043 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8044
8045 (setq gnus-split-methods
8046 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8047 (my-save-name)))
8048 @end lisp
8049
8050
8051 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8052 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8053 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8054 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8055 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8056 all the files in the top level directory
8057 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8058 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8059 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8060 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8061
8062 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8063 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8064 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8065 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8066 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8067 for kill files.
8068
8069 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8070 a spool, you could
8071
8072 @lisp
8073 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8074 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8075 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8076 @end lisp
8077
8078 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8079 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8080 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8081 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8082
8083
8084 @node Decoding Articles
8085 @section Decoding Articles
8086 @cindex decoding articles
8087
8088 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8089 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8090
8091 @menu
8092 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8093 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8094 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8095 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8096 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8097 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8098 @end menu
8099
8100 @cindex series
8101 @cindex article series
8102 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8103 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8104 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8105 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8106 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8107
8108 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8109 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8110 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8111
8112 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8113 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8114 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8115
8116 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8117 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8118 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8119
8120
8121 @node Uuencoded Articles
8122 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8123 @cindex uudecode
8124 @cindex uuencoded articles
8125
8126 @table @kbd
8127
8128 @item X u
8129 @kindex X u (Summary)
8130 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8131 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8132 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8133
8134 @item X U
8135 @kindex X U (Summary)
8136 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8137 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8138 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8139
8140 @item X v u
8141 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8142 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8143 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8144
8145 @item X v U
8146 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8147 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8148 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8149 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8150
8151 @end table
8152
8153 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8154 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8155 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8156 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8157 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8158
8159 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8160 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8161 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8162 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8163 @kbd{X u}.
8164
8165 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8166 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8167 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8168 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8169 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8170 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8171 off.
8172
8173
8174 @node Shell Archives
8175 @subsection Shell Archives
8176 @cindex unshar
8177 @cindex shell archives
8178 @cindex shared articles
8179
8180 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8181 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8182 some commands to deal with these:
8183
8184 @table @kbd
8185
8186 @item X s
8187 @kindex X s (Summary)
8188 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8189 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8190
8191 @item X S
8192 @kindex X S (Summary)
8193 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8194 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8195
8196 @item X v s
8197 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8198 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8199 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8200
8201 @item X v S
8202 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8203 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8204 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8205 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8206 @end table
8207
8208
8209 @node PostScript Files
8210 @subsection PostScript Files
8211 @cindex PostScript
8212
8213 @table @kbd
8214
8215 @item X p
8216 @kindex X p (Summary)
8217 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8218 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8219
8220 @item X P
8221 @kindex X P (Summary)
8222 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8223 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8224 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8225
8226 @item X v p
8227 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8228 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8229 View the current PostScript series
8230 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8231
8232 @item X v P
8233 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8234 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8235 View and save the current PostScript series
8236 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8237 @end table
8238
8239
8240 @node Other Files
8241 @subsection Other Files
8242
8243 @table @kbd
8244 @item X o
8245 @kindex X o (Summary)
8246 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8247 Save the current series
8248 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8249
8250 @item X b
8251 @kindex X b (Summary)
8252 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8253 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8254 doesn't really work yet.
8255
8256 @item X Y
8257 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8258 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8259 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8260 @end table
8261
8262
8263 @node Decoding Variables
8264 @subsection Decoding Variables
8265
8266 Adjective, not verb.
8267
8268 @menu
8269 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8270 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8271 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8272 @end menu
8273
8274
8275 @node Rule Variables
8276 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8277 @cindex rule variables
8278
8279 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8280 variables are of the form
8281
8282 @lisp
8283 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8284 '(regexp2 command2)
8285 ...)
8286 @end lisp
8287
8288 @table @code
8289
8290 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8291 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8292 @cindex sox
8293 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8294 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8295 say something like:
8296 @lisp
8297 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8298 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8299 @end lisp
8300
8301 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8302 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8303 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8304 user and default view rules.
8305
8306 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8307 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8308 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8309 archives.
8310 @end table
8311
8312
8313 @node Other Decode Variables
8314 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8315
8316 @table @code
8317 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8318
8319 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8320 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8321 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8322 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8323 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8324
8325 @table @code
8326
8327 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8328 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8329 View the file.
8330
8331 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8332 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8333 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8334 @end table
8335
8336 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8337 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8338 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8339 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8340 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8341 time.
8342
8343 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8344 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8345 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8346
8347 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8348 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8349 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8350 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8351 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8352 kludgy.
8353
8354 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8355 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8356 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8357
8358 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8359 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8360 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8361 looking for files to display.
8362
8363 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8364 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8365 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8366 after viewing it.
8367
8368 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8369 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8370 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8371 rules.
8372
8373 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8374 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8375 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8376 unpacking commands.
8377
8378 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8379 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8380 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8381 from articles.
8382
8383 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8384 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8385 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8386 decoded articles as unread.
8387
8388 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8389 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8390 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8391 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8392
8393 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8394 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8395 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8396
8397 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8398 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8399 @cindex metamail
8400 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8401 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8402 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8403 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8404
8405 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8406 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8407 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8408 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8409 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8410 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8411 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8412 simply dropped them.
8413
8414 @end table
8415
8416
8417 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8418 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8419
8420 @table @code
8421
8422 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8423 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8424 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8425 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8426 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8427 for you when you post the article.
8428
8429 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8430 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8431 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8432 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8433
8434 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8435 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8436 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8437 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8438 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8439 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8440 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8441
8442 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8443 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8444 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8445 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8446 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8447 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8448 Default is @code{t}.
8449
8450 @end table
8451
8452
8453 @node Viewing Files
8454 @subsection Viewing Files
8455 @cindex viewing files
8456 @cindex pseudo-articles
8457
8458 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8459 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8460 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8461 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8462 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8463 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8464 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8465
8466 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8467 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8468 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8469 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8470
8471 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8472 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8473 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8474
8475 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8476 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8477 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8478 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8479 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8480
8481 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8482 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8483 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8484 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8485 a list of parameters to that command.
8486
8487 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8488 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8489 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8490
8491 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8492 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8493 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8494
8495
8496 @node Article Treatment
8497 @section Article Treatment
8498
8499 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8500 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8501 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8502 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8503 these articles easier.
8504
8505 @menu
8506 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8507 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8508 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8509 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8510 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8511 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8512 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8513 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8514 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8515 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8516 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8517 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8518 @end menu
8519
8520
8521 @node Article Highlighting
8522 @subsection Article Highlighting
8523 @cindex highlighting
8524
8525 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8526 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8527
8528 @table @kbd
8529
8530 @item W H a
8531 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8532 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8533 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8534 Do much highlighting of the current article
8535 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8536 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8537
8538 @item W H h
8539 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8540 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8541 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8542 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8543 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8544 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8545 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8546 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8547 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8548 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8549 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8550 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8551
8552 @item W H c
8553 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8554 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8555 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8556
8557 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8558
8559 @table @code
8560 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8561
8562 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8563 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8564 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8565
8566 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8567 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8568 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8569
8570 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8571 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8572 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8573 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8574 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8575 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8576
8577 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8578 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8579 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8580
8581 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8582 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8583 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8584
8585 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8586 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8587 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8588 that it's a citation.
8589
8590 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8591 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8592 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8593
8594 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8595 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8596 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8597
8598 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8599 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8600 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8601 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8602
8603 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8604 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8605 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8606 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8607 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8608 is @code{t}.
8609
8610 @end table
8611
8612
8613 @item W H s
8614 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8615 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8616 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8617 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8618 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8619 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8620 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8621 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8622 default.
8623
8624 @end table
8625
8626 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8627
8628
8629 @node Article Fontisizing
8630 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8631 @cindex emphasis
8632 @cindex article emphasis
8633
8634 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8635 @kindex W e (Summary)
8636 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8637 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8638 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8639 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8640
8641 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8642 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8643 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8644 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8645 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8646 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8647 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8648 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8649 highlighting.
8650
8651 @lisp
8652 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8653 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8654 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8655 @end lisp
8656
8657 @cindex slash
8658 @cindex asterisk
8659 @cindex underline
8660 @cindex /
8661 @cindex *
8662
8663 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8664 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8665 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8666 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8667 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8668 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8669 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8670 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8671 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8672 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8673 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8674 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8675 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8676
8677 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8678 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8679 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8680 say something like:
8681
8682 @lisp
8683 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8684 @end lisp
8685
8686 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8687
8688 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8689 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8690 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8691 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8692
8693 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8694
8695
8696 @node Article Hiding
8697 @subsection Article Hiding
8698 @cindex article hiding
8699
8700 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8701 too much cruft in most articles.
8702
8703 @table @kbd
8704
8705 @item W W a
8706 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8707 @findex gnus-article-hide
8708 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8709 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8710 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8711
8712 @item W W h
8713 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8714 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8715 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8716 Headers}.
8717
8718 @item W W b
8719 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8720 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8721 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8722 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8723
8724 @item W W s
8725 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8726 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8727 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8728 Signature}.
8729
8730 @item W W l
8731 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8732 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8733 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8734 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8735 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8736 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8737 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8738 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8739
8740 @table @code
8741
8742 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8743 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8744 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8745 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8746
8747 @end table
8748
8749 @item W W P
8750 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8751 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8752 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8753 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8754
8755 @item W W B
8756 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8757 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8758 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8759 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8760 @cindex banner
8761 @cindex OneList
8762 @cindex stripping advertisements
8763 @cindex advertisements
8764 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8765 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8766 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8767 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8768 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8769 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8770 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8771 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8772 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8773 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8774 used.
8775
8776 For instance:
8777
8778 @lisp
8779 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8780 ((googleGroups .
8781 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8782 @end lisp
8783
8784 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8785 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8786 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8787
8788 @table @code
8789
8790 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8791 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8792 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8793 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8794 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8795 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8796 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8797 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8798 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8799 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8800 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8801
8802 @lisp
8803 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8804 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8805 @end lisp
8806
8807 @end table
8808
8809 @item W W c
8810 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8811 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8812 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8813 customizing the hiding:
8814
8815 @table @code
8816
8817 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8818 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8819 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8820 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8821 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8822 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8823 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8824 specs are valid:
8825
8826 @table @samp
8827 @item b
8828 Starting point of the hidden text.
8829 @item e
8830 Ending point of the hidden text.
8831 @item l
8832 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8833 @item n
8834 Number of lines of hidden text.
8835 @end table
8836
8837 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8838 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8839 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8840 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8841 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8842
8843 @end table
8844
8845 @item W W C-c
8846 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8847 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8848
8849 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8850 following two variables:
8851
8852 @table @code
8853 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8854 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8855 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8856 50), hide the cited text.
8857
8858 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8859 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8860 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8861 is hidden.
8862 @end table
8863
8864 @item W W C
8865 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8866 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8867 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8868 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8869 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8870 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8871
8872 @end table
8873
8874 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8875 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8876 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8877
8878 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8879 citation customization.
8880
8881 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8882 automatically.
8883
8884
8885 @node Article Washing
8886 @subsection Article Washing
8887 @cindex washing
8888 @cindex article washing
8889
8890 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8891 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8892
8893 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8894 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8895 Cleaner, perhaps.
8896
8897 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8898 articles by default.
8899
8900 @table @kbd
8901
8902 @item C-u g
8903 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8904 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8905 the server.
8906
8907 @item g
8908 Force redisplaying of the current article
8909 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8910 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8911 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8912 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8913
8914 @item W l
8915 @kindex W l (Summary)
8916 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8917 Remove page breaks from the current article
8918 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8919 delimiters.
8920
8921 @item W r
8922 @kindex W r (Summary)
8923 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8924 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8925 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8926 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8927 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8928 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8929
8930 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8931 positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8932 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8933 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8934
8935 @item W m
8936 @kindex W m (Summary)
8937 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8938 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8939
8940 @item W i
8941 @kindex W i (Summary)
8942 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8943 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8944 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8945 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8946 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8947 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8948 to work.
8949
8950 @item W t
8951 @item t
8952 @kindex W t (Summary)
8953 @kindex t (Summary)
8954 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8955 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8956 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8957
8958 @item W v
8959 @kindex W v (Summary)
8960 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8961 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8962 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8963
8964 @item W o
8965 @kindex W o (Summary)
8966 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8967 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8968
8969 @item W d
8970 @kindex W d (Summary)
8971 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8972 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8973 @cindex Smartquotes
8974 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8975 @cindex Latin 1
8976 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8977 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8978 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8979 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8980 interactively.
8981
8982 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8983 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8984 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8985 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8986
8987 @item W U
8988 @kindex W U (Summary)
8989 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
8990 @cindex Unicode
8991 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
8992 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
8993 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
8994 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
8995 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
8996 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
8997
8998 @item W Y f
8999 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
9000 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9001 @cindex Outlook Express
9002 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9003 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9004 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
9005
9006 @item W Y u
9007 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
9008 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9009 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9010 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9011 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9012 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9013 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9014 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9015 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9016 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9017
9018 @item W Y a
9019 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9020 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9021 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9022 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9023
9024 @item W Y c
9025 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9026 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9027 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9028 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9029
9030 @item W w
9031 @kindex W w (Summary)
9032 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9033 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9034
9035 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9036 when filling.
9037
9038 @item W Q
9039 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9040 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9041 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9042
9043 @item W C
9044 @kindex W C (Summary)
9045 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9046 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9047 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9048
9049 @item W c
9050 @kindex W c (Summary)
9051 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9052 Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9053 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9054 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9055 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9056
9057 @item W q
9058 @kindex W q (Summary)
9059 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9060 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9061 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9062 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9063 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9064 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9065 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9066 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9067 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9068
9069 @item W 6
9070 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9071 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9072 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9073 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9074 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9075 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9076 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9077 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9078
9079 @item W Z
9080 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9081 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9082 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9083 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9084 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9085
9086 @item W A
9087 @kindex W A (Summary)
9088 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9089 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9090 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9091 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9092 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9093
9094 @item W u
9095 @kindex W u (Summary)
9096 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9097 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9098 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9099 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9100 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9101
9102 @item W h
9103 @kindex W h (Summary)
9104 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9105 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9106 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9107 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9108
9109 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9110 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9111 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9112
9113 The default is to use the function specified by
9114 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9115 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9116 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9117
9118 @table @code
9119 @item shr
9120 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9121
9122 @item gnus-w3m
9123 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9124
9125 @item w3
9126 Use Emacs/W3.
9127
9128 @item w3m
9129 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9130
9131 @item w3m-standalone
9132 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9133
9134 @item links
9135 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9136
9137 @item lynx
9138 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9139
9140 @item html2text
9141 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9142
9143 @end table
9144
9145 @item W b
9146 @kindex W b (Summary)
9147 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9148 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9149 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9150
9151 @item W B
9152 @kindex W B (Summary)
9153 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9154 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9155 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9156
9157 @item W p
9158 @kindex W p (Summary)
9159 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9160 Verify a signed control message
9161 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9162 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9163 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9164 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9165 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9166 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9167
9168 @item W s
9169 @kindex W s (Summary)
9170 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9171 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9172 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9173 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9174
9175 @item W a
9176 @kindex W a (Summary)
9177 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9178 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9179 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9180
9181 @item W E l
9182 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9183 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9184 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9185 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9186
9187 @item W E m
9188 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9189 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9190 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9191 lines with a single empty line.
9192 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9193
9194 @item W E t
9195 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9196 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9197 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9198 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9199
9200 @item W E a
9201 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9202 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9203 Do all the three commands above
9204 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9205
9206 @item W E A
9207 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9208 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9209 Remove all blank lines
9210 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9211
9212 @item W E s
9213 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9214 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9215 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9216 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9217
9218 @item W E e
9219 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9220 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9221 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9222 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9223
9224 @end table
9225
9226 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9227
9228
9229 @node Article Header
9230 @subsection Article Header
9231
9232 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9233
9234 @table @kbd
9235
9236 @item W G u
9237 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9238 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9239 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9240
9241 @item W G n
9242 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9243 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9244 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9245 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9246
9247 @item W G f
9248 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9249 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9250 Fold all the message headers
9251 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9252
9253 @item W E w
9254 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9255 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9256 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9257 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9258
9259 @end table
9260
9261
9262 @node Article Buttons
9263 @subsection Article Buttons
9264 @cindex buttons
9265
9266 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9267 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9268 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9269 button on these references.
9270
9271 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9272 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9273 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9274 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9275 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9276
9277 @table @code
9278
9279 @item gnus-button-alist
9280 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9281 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9282
9283 @lisp
9284 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9285 @end lisp
9286
9287 @table @var
9288
9289 @item regexp
9290 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9291 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9292 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9293 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9294 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9295
9296 @item button-par
9297 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9298 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9299 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9300
9301 @item use-p
9302 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9303 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9304 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9305 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9306 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9307
9308 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9309
9310 @item function
9311 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9312
9313 @item data-par
9314 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9315 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9316
9317 @end table
9318
9319 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9320
9321 @lisp
9322 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9323 @end lisp
9324
9325 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9326 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9327 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9328 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9329 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9330
9331 @lisp
9332 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9333 @end lisp
9334
9335 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9336 @end table
9337
9338 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9339
9340 @table @code
9341 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9342 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9343
9344 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9345
9346 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9347 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9348 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9349 default values of the variables above.
9350
9351 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9352
9353 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9354 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9355 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9356 argument with a string naming the man page.
9357
9358 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9359
9360 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9361 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9362 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9363
9364 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9365 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9366 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9367 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9368 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9369 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9370 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9371 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9372 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9373 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9374 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9375 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9376
9377 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9378 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9379 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9380 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9381 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9382 string is invalid.
9383
9384 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9385 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9386 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9387 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9388
9389 @c Misc stuff
9390
9391 @item gnus-article-button-face
9392 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9393 Face used on buttons.
9394
9395 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9396 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9397 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9398
9399 @end table
9400
9401 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9402
9403
9404 @node Article Button Levels
9405 @subsection Article button levels
9406 @cindex button levels
9407 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9408 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9409 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9410 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9411 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9412 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9413 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9414 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9415
9416 @lisp
9417 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9418 (setq gnus-parameters
9419 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9420 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9421 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9422 @end lisp
9423
9424 @table @code
9425
9426 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9427 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9428 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9429 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9430 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9431 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9432
9433 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9434 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9435 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9436 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9437 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9438 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9439 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9440 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9441 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9442 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9443 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9444 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9445 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9446
9447 @item gnus-button-man-level
9448 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9449 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9450 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9451
9452 @item gnus-button-message-level
9453 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9454 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9455 Related variables and functions include
9456 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9457 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9458 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9459 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9460
9461 @end table
9462
9463
9464 @node Article Date
9465 @subsection Article Date
9466
9467 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9468 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9469 when the article was sent.
9470
9471 @table @kbd
9472
9473 @item W T u
9474 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9475 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9476 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9477 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9478
9479 @item W T i
9480 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9481 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9482 @cindex ISO 8601
9483 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9484 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9485
9486 @item W T l
9487 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9488 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9489 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9490
9491 @item W T p
9492 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9493 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9494 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9495 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9496
9497 @item W T s
9498 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9499 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9500 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9501 @findex format-time-string
9502 Display the date using a user-defined format
9503 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9504 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9505 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9506 for a list of possible format specs.
9507
9508 @item W T e
9509 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9510 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9511 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9512 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9513 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9514 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9515
9516 @example
9517 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9518 @end example
9519
9520 This line is updated continually by default. The frequency (in
9521 seconds) is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers}
9522 variable.
9523
9524 If you wish to switch updating off, say:
9525
9526 @vindex gnus-article-update-date-headers
9527 @lisp
9528 (setq gnus-article-update-date-headers nil)
9529 @end lisp
9530
9531 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9532
9533 @item W T o
9534 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9535 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9536 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9537 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9538 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9539 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9540 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9541
9542 @end table
9543
9544 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9545 preferred format automatically.
9546
9547
9548 @node Article Display
9549 @subsection Article Display
9550 @cindex picons
9551 @cindex x-face
9552 @cindex smileys
9553 @cindex gravatars
9554
9555 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9556 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9557
9558 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9559 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9560
9561 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9562 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9563
9564 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9565 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9566
9567 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9568 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9569
9570 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9571 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9572
9573 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9574 they'll be removed.
9575
9576 @table @kbd
9577 @item W D x
9578 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9579 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9580 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9581 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9582
9583 @item W D d
9584 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9585 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9586 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9587 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9588
9589 @item W D s
9590 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9591 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9592 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9593
9594 @item W D f
9595 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9596 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9597 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9598
9599 @item W D m
9600 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9601 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9602 Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9603 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9604
9605 @item W D n
9606 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9607 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9608 Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9609 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9610
9611 @item W D g
9612 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9613 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9614 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9615
9616 @item W D h
9617 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9618 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9619 Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9620 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9621
9622 @item W D D
9623 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9624 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9625 Remove all images from the article buffer
9626 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9627
9628 @item W D W
9629 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9630 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9631 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9632 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9633 the buffer with this command.
9634 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9635
9636 @end table
9637
9638
9639
9640 @node Article Signature
9641 @subsection Article Signature
9642 @cindex signatures
9643 @cindex article signature
9644
9645 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9646 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9647 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9648 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9649 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9650 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9651 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9652 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9653 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9654
9655 @lisp
9656 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9657 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9658 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9659 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9660 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9661 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9662 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9663 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9664 @end lisp
9665
9666 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9667 positives.
9668
9669 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9670 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9671 signature when displaying articles.
9672
9673 @enumerate
9674 @item
9675 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9676 that integer.
9677 @item
9678 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9679 than that number.
9680 @item
9681 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9682 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9683 @item
9684 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9685 in question is not a signature.
9686 @end enumerate
9687
9688 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9689 listed above. Here's an example:
9690
9691 @lisp
9692 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9693 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9694 @end lisp
9695
9696 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9697 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9698 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9699 signature after all.
9700
9701
9702 @node Article Miscellanea
9703 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9704
9705 @table @kbd
9706 @item A t
9707 @kindex A t (Summary)
9708 @findex gnus-article-babel
9709 Translate the article from one language to another
9710 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9711
9712 @end table
9713
9714
9715 @node MIME Commands
9716 @section MIME Commands
9717 @cindex MIME decoding
9718 @cindex attachments
9719 @cindex viewing attachments
9720
9721 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9722 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9723
9724 @table @kbd
9725 @item b
9726 @itemx K v
9727 @kindex b (Summary)
9728 @kindex K v (Summary)
9729 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9730
9731 @item K o
9732 @kindex K o (Summary)
9733 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9734
9735 @item K O
9736 @kindex K O (Summary)
9737 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9738 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9739 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9740
9741 @item K r
9742 @kindex K r (Summary)
9743 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9744
9745 @item K d
9746 @kindex K d (Summary)
9747 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9748 removed part.
9749
9750 @item K c
9751 @kindex K c (Summary)
9752 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9753
9754 @item K e
9755 @kindex K e (Summary)
9756 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9757
9758 @item K i
9759 @kindex K i (Summary)
9760 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9761
9762 @item K |
9763 @kindex K | (Summary)
9764 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9765 @end table
9766
9767 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9768 the same manner:
9769
9770 @table @kbd
9771 @item K H
9772 @kindex K H (Summary)
9773 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9774 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9775 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9776 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9777 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9778 unless the prefix argument is given.
9779
9780 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9781 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9782 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9783 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9784 trusted senders.
9785
9786 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9787 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9788
9789 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9790 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9791 the group (if you want).
9792
9793 @item K b
9794 @kindex K b (Summary)
9795 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9796 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9797 parts.
9798
9799 @item K m
9800 @kindex K m (Summary)
9801 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9802 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9803 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9804 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9805 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9806
9807 @item X m
9808 @kindex X m (Summary)
9809 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9810 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9811 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9812 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9813
9814 @item M-t
9815 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9816 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9817 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9818 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9819
9820 @item W M w
9821 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9822 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9823 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9824 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9825
9826 @item W M c
9827 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9828 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9829 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9830 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9831
9832 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9833 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9834 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9835 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9836 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9837 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9838
9839 @item W M v
9840 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9841 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9842 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9843 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9844
9845 @end table
9846
9847 Relevant variables:
9848
9849 @table @code
9850 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9851 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9852 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9853 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9854 @code{nil}.
9855
9856 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9857
9858 @lisp
9859 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9860 '("text/x-vcard"))
9861 @end lisp
9862
9863 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9864 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9865 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9866 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9867 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9868 default is @code{t}.
9869
9870 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9871 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9872 @cindex uuencode
9873 @cindex yEnc
9874 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9875 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9876 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9877 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9878 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9879 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9880 for encoding in Gnus.
9881
9882 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9883 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9884 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9885 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9886 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9887 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9888 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9889 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9890
9891 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9892 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9893 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9894 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9895 displayed. This variable overrides
9896 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9897 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9898 is @code{nil}.
9899
9900 E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9901 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9902 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9903
9904 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9905 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9906 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9907 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9908 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9909
9910 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9911 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9912 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9913 default value is @code{nil}.
9914
9915 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9916 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9917 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9918 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9919 users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9920 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
9921 save all jpegs into some directory).
9922
9923 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9924
9925 @lisp
9926 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9927 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9928 (with-temp-buffer
9929 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9930 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9931 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9932 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9933 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9934 @end lisp
9935
9936 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9937 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9938 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9939
9940 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9941 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9942 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9943
9944 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9945 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9946 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9947
9948 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9949 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9950 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9951 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9952 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9953
9954 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9955 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9956 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9957 overrides @code{nil} values of
9958 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9959 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9960
9961 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9962 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9963 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9964 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9965
9966 Ready-made functions include@*
9967 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9968 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9969 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9970 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9971 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9972 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9973 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9974 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9975 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9976 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9977 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9978 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9979
9980 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9981 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9982
9983 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9984 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9985 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9986
9987 @lisp
9988 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9989 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9990 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9991 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9992 @end lisp
9993
9994 @noindent
9995 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9996
9997 @end table
9998
9999
10000 @node Charsets
10001 @section Charsets
10002 @cindex charsets
10003
10004 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10005 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10006 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10007 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10008 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10009 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10010 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10011
10012 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10013 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10014 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10015 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10016
10017 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10018 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10019 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10020 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10021 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10022 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10023 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10024 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10025 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10026
10027 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10028 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10029 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10030 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10031 quoted-printable header encoding.
10032
10033 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10034 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10035 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10036
10037 @table @var
10038 @item test
10039 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10040 variable to query,
10041 @item header
10042 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10043 means encode all charsets),
10044 @item body-list
10045 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10046 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10047 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10048 @end table
10049
10050 @cindex Russian
10051 @cindex koi8-r
10052 @cindex koi8-u
10053 @cindex iso-8859-5
10054 @cindex coding system aliases
10055 @cindex preferred charset
10056
10057 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10058 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10059 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10060
10061 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10062
10063 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10064 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10065
10066 @lisp
10067 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10068 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10069 @end lisp
10070
10071 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10072 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10073
10074 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10075
10076 @lisp
10077 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10078 @end lisp
10079
10080 This will almost do the right thing.
10081
10082 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10083 something like
10084
10085 @lisp
10086 (codepage-setup 1251)
10087 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10088 @end lisp
10089
10090
10091 @node Article Commands
10092 @section Article Commands
10093
10094 @table @kbd
10095
10096 @item A P
10097 @cindex PostScript
10098 @cindex printing
10099 @kindex A P (Summary)
10100 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10101 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10102 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10103 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10104 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10105 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10106
10107 @item A C
10108 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10109 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10110 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10111 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10112 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10113 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10114 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10115 do so.
10116
10117 @end table
10118
10119
10120 @node Summary Sorting
10121 @section Summary Sorting
10122 @cindex summary sorting
10123
10124 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10125 can't really see why you'd want that.
10126
10127 @table @kbd
10128
10129 @item C-c C-s C-n
10130 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10131 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10132 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10133
10134 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10135 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10136 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10137 Sort by most recent article number
10138 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10139
10140 @item C-c C-s C-a
10141 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10142 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10143 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10144
10145 @item C-c C-s C-t
10146 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10147 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10148 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10149
10150 @item C-c C-s C-s
10151 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10152 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10153 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10154
10155 @item C-c C-s C-d
10156 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10157 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10158 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10159
10160 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10161 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10162 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10163 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10164
10165 @item C-c C-s C-l
10166 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10167 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10168 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10169
10170 @item C-c C-s C-c
10171 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10172 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10173 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10174
10175 @item C-c C-s C-i
10176 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10177 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10178 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10179
10180 @item C-c C-s C-r
10181 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10182 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10183 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10184
10185 @item C-c C-s C-o
10186 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10187 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10188 Sort using the default sorting method
10189 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10190 @end table
10191
10192 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10193 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10194 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10195 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10196 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10197 Commands}).
10198
10199 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10200
10201
10202 @node Finding the Parent
10203 @section Finding the Parent
10204 @cindex parent articles
10205 @cindex referring articles
10206
10207 @table @kbd
10208 @item ^
10209 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10210 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10211 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10212 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10213 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10214 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10215 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10216 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10217 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10218 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10219
10220 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10221 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10222 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10223 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10224 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10225 article.
10226
10227 @item A R (Summary)
10228 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10229 @kindex A R (Summary)
10230 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10231 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10232
10233 @item A T (Summary)
10234 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10235 @kindex A T (Summary)
10236 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10237 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10238 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10239 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10240 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10241 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10242 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10243
10244 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10245 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
10246 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10247 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10248 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10249 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10250
10251 @item M-^ (Summary)
10252 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10253 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10254 @cindex Message-ID
10255 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10256 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10257 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10258 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10259 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10260 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10261
10262 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10263 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10264 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10265 @end table
10266
10267 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10268 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10269 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10270 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10271 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10272 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10273 necessary.
10274
10275 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10276 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10277 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10278 match.
10279
10280 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10281 then ask Google if that fails:
10282
10283 @lisp
10284 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10285 '(current
10286 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10287 @end lisp
10288
10289 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10290 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10291 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10292 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10293 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10294 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10295
10296 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10297 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10298 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10299 registry}).
10300
10301 @node Alternative Approaches
10302 @section Alternative Approaches
10303
10304 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10305 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10306
10307 @menu
10308 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10309 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10310 @end menu
10311
10312
10313 @node Pick and Read
10314 @subsection Pick and Read
10315 @cindex pick and read
10316
10317 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10318 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10319 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10320 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10321
10322 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10323 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10324 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10325 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10326 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10327 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10328
10329 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10330
10331 @table @kbd
10332 @item .
10333 @kindex . (Pick)
10334 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10335 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10336 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10337 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10338 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10339 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10340 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10341 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10342
10343 @item SPACE
10344 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10345 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10346 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10347 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10348
10349 @item u
10350 @kindex u (Pick)
10351 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10352 Unpick the thread or article
10353 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10354 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10355 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10356 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10357 the thread or article at that line.
10358
10359 @item RET
10360 @kindex RET (Pick)
10361 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10362 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10363 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10364 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10365 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10366 will still be visible when you are reading.
10367
10368 @end table
10369
10370 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10371 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10372 which is mapped to the same function
10373 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10374
10375 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10376
10377 @lisp
10378 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10379 @end lisp
10380
10381 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10382 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10383
10384 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10385 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10386 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10387
10388 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10389 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10390 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10391 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10392 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10393 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10394 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10395
10396
10397 @node Binary Groups
10398 @subsection Binary Groups
10399 @cindex binary groups
10400
10401 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10402 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10403 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10404 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10405 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10406 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10407 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10408
10409 @kindex g (Binary)
10410 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10411 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10412 command, when you have turned on this mode
10413 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10414
10415 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10416 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10417
10418
10419 @node Tree Display
10420 @section Tree Display
10421 @cindex trees
10422
10423 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10424 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10425 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10426 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10427 in the tree buffer.
10428
10429 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10430
10431 @table @code
10432 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10433 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10434 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10435
10436 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10437 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10438 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10439 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10440 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10441
10442 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10443 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10444 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10445 default is @code{modeline}.
10446
10447 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10448 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10449 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10450 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10451 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10452 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10453 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10454
10455 Valid specs are:
10456
10457 @table @samp
10458 @item n
10459 The name of the poster.
10460 @item f
10461 The @code{From} header.
10462 @item N
10463 The number of the article.
10464 @item [
10465 The opening bracket.
10466 @item ]
10467 The closing bracket.
10468 @item s
10469 The subject.
10470 @end table
10471
10472 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10473
10474 Variables related to the display are:
10475
10476 @table @code
10477 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10478 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10479 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10480 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10481 @example
10482 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10483 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10484 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10485 @end example
10486 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10487
10488 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10489 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10490 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10491 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10492
10493 @end table
10494
10495 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10496 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10497 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10498 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10499 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10500 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10501 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10502 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10503 other windows displayed next to it.
10504
10505 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10506 at all times:
10507
10508 @lisp
10509 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10510 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10511 @end lisp
10512
10513 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10514 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10515 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10516 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10517 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10518 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10519 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10520
10521 @end table
10522
10523 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10524
10525 @example
10526 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10527 | \[Jan]
10528 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10529 | \(***)-[Eri]
10530 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10531 \[Bjo]
10532 \[Gun]
10533 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10534 @end example
10535
10536 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10537
10538 @example
10539 @group
10540 @{***@}
10541 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10542 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10543 |--\-----\-----\ |
10544 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10545 | | |--\
10546 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10547 |
10548 [Paa]
10549 @end group
10550 @end example
10551
10552 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10553 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10554 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10555
10556 @lisp
10557 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10558 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10559 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10560 (gnus-add-configuration
10561 '(article
10562 (vertical 1.0
10563 (horizontal 0.25
10564 (summary 0.75 point)
10565 (tree 1.0))
10566 (article 1.0))))
10567 @end lisp
10568
10569 @xref{Window Layout}.
10570
10571
10572 @node Mail Group Commands
10573 @section Mail Group Commands
10574 @cindex mail group commands
10575
10576 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10577 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10578
10579 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10580 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10581
10582 @table @kbd
10583
10584 @item B e
10585 @kindex B e (Summary)
10586 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10587 @cindex expiring mail
10588 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10589 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10590 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10591 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10592
10593 @item B C-M-e
10594 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10595 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10596 @cindex expiring mail
10597 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10598 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10599 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10600 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10601
10602 @item B DEL
10603 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10604 @cindex deleting mail
10605 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10606 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10607 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10608 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10609 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10610
10611 @item B m
10612 @kindex B m (Summary)
10613 @cindex move mail
10614 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10615 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10616 Move the article from one mail group to another
10617 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10618 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10619
10620 @item B c
10621 @kindex B c (Summary)
10622 @cindex copy mail
10623 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10624 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10625 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10626 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10627 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10628
10629 @item B B
10630 @kindex B B (Summary)
10631 @cindex crosspost mail
10632 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10633 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10634 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10635 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10636 be properly updated.
10637
10638 @item B i
10639 @kindex B i (Summary)
10640 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10641 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10642 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10643 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10644
10645 @item B I
10646 @kindex B I (Summary)
10647 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10648 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10649 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10650 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10651
10652 @item B r
10653 @kindex B r (Summary)
10654 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10655 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10656 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10657 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10658 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10659 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10660 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10661 (which is the default).
10662
10663 @item B w
10664 @itemx e
10665 @kindex B w (Summary)
10666 @kindex e (Summary)
10667 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10668 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10669 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10670 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10671 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10672 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10673 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10674
10675 @item B q
10676 @kindex B q (Summary)
10677 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10678 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10679 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10680 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10681
10682 @item B t
10683 @kindex B t (Summary)
10684 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10685 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10686 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10687
10688 @item B p
10689 @kindex B p (Summary)
10690 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10691 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10692 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10693 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10694 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10695 article from your news server (or rather, from
10696 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10697 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10698 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10699 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10700 just not have arrived yet.
10701
10702 @item K E
10703 @kindex K E (Summary)
10704 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10705 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10706 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10707 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10708 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10709
10710 @end table
10711
10712 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10713 @cindex moving articles
10714 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10715 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10716 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10717 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10718 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10719 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10720 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10721
10722 @lisp
10723 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10724 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10725 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10726 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10727 @end lisp
10728
10729
10730 @node Various Summary Stuff
10731 @section Various Summary Stuff
10732
10733 @menu
10734 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10735 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10736 * Summary Generation Commands::
10737 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10738 @end menu
10739
10740 @table @code
10741 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10742 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10743 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10744 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10745 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10746 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10747
10748 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10749 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10750 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10751 current article.
10752
10753 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10754 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10755 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10756
10757 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10758 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10759 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10760 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10761 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10762 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10763 have been set.
10764
10765 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10766 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10767 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10768 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10769 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10770
10771 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10772 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10773 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10774 generated.
10775
10776 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10777 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10778 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10779 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10780 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10781 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10782 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10783 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10784 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10785 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10786
10787 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10788 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10789 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10790 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10791 list of articles to be selected.
10792
10793 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10794 the list in one particular group:
10795
10796 @lisp
10797 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10798 (if (string= group "some.group")
10799 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10800 articles))
10801 @end lisp
10802
10803 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10804 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10805 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10806 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10807 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10808 buffer is active.
10809
10810 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10811 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10812 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10813 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10814 variable will be used instead.
10815
10816 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10817 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10818 buffers. For example:
10819
10820 @lisp
10821 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10822 '(message-use-followup-to
10823 (gnus-visible-headers .
10824 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10825 @end lisp
10826
10827 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10828
10829 @end table
10830
10831
10832 @node Summary Group Information
10833 @subsection Summary Group Information
10834
10835 @table @kbd
10836
10837 @item H d
10838 @kindex H d (Summary)
10839 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10840 Give a brief description of the current group
10841 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10842 rereading the description from the server.
10843
10844 @item H h
10845 @kindex H h (Summary)
10846 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10847 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10848 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10849
10850 @item H i
10851 @kindex H i (Summary)
10852 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10853 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10854 @end table
10855
10856
10857 @node Searching for Articles
10858 @subsection Searching for Articles
10859
10860 @table @kbd
10861
10862 @item M-s
10863 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10864 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10865 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10866 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10867
10868 @item M-r
10869 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10870 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10871 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10872 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10873
10874 @item M-S
10875 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10876 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10877 Repeat the previous search forwards
10878 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10879
10880 @item M-R
10881 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10882 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10883 Repeat the previous search backwards
10884 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10885
10886 @item &
10887 @kindex & (Summary)
10888 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10889 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10890 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10891 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10892 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10893 search backward instead.
10894
10895 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10896 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10897
10898 @item M-&
10899 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10900 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10901 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10902 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10903 @end table
10904
10905 @node Summary Generation Commands
10906 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10907
10908 @table @kbd
10909
10910 @item Y g
10911 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10912 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10913 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10914
10915 @item Y c
10916 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10917 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10918 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10919 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10920
10921 @item Y d
10922 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10923 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10924 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10925 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10926
10927 @item Y t
10928 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10929 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10930 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10931 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10932
10933 @end table
10934
10935
10936 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10937 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10938
10939 @table @kbd
10940
10941 @item A D
10942 @itemx C-d
10943 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10944 @kindex A D (Summary)
10945 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10946 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10947 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10948 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10949 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10950 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10951 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10952 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10953 fashion.
10954
10955 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10956 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10957 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10958 include:
10959
10960 @table @code
10961 @item next
10962 Select the next article.
10963
10964 @item next-unread
10965 Select the next unread article.
10966
10967 @item next-noselect
10968 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10969
10970 @item next-unread-noselect
10971 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10972 @end table
10973
10974 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10975 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10976
10977 @item C-M-d
10978 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10979 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10980 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10981 several documents into one biiig group
10982 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10983 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10984 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10985 command understands the process/prefix convention
10986 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10987
10988 @item C-t
10989 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10990 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10991 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10992 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10993 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10994 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10995
10996 @item =
10997 @kindex = (Summary)
10998 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10999 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11000 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
11001
11002 @item C-M-e
11003 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11004 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11005 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11006 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
11007
11008 @item C-M-a
11009 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11010 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11011 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11012 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11013
11014 @end table
11015
11016
11017 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11018 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11019 @cindex summary exit
11020 @cindex exiting groups
11021
11022 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11023 group and return you to the group buffer.
11024
11025 @table @kbd
11026
11027 @item Z Z
11028 @itemx Z Q
11029 @itemx q
11030 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11031 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11032 @kindex q (Summary)
11033 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11034 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11035 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11036 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11037 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11038 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11039 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11040 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11041 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11042 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11043 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11044 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11045
11046 @item Z E
11047 @itemx Q
11048 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11049 @kindex Q (Summary)
11050 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11051 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11052 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11053
11054 @item Z c
11055 @itemx c
11056 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11057 @kindex c (Summary)
11058 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11059 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11060 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11061 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11062
11063 @item Z C
11064 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11065 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11066 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11067 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11068
11069 @item Z n
11070 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11071 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11072 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11073 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11074
11075 @item Z p
11076 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11077 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11078 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11079 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11080
11081 @item Z R
11082 @itemx C-x C-s
11083 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11084 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11085 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11086 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11087 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11088 all articles, both read and unread.
11089
11090 @item Z G
11091 @itemx M-g
11092 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11093 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11094 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11095 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11096 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11097 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11098 articles, both read and unread.
11099
11100 @item Z N
11101 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11102 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11103 Exit the group and go to the next group
11104 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11105
11106 @item Z P
11107 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11108 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11109 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11110 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11111
11112 @item Z s
11113 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11114 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11115 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11116 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11117 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11118 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11119 @end table
11120
11121 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11122 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11123 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11124 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11125
11126 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11127 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11128 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11129 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11130 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11131 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11132 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11133 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11134 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11135 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11136 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11137 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11138
11139 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11140
11141 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11142 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11143 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.)@: when you exit the
11144 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11145 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11146 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11147 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11148 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11149 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11150
11151
11152 @node Crosspost Handling
11153 @section Crosspost Handling
11154
11155 @cindex velveeta
11156 @cindex spamming
11157 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11158 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11159 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11160 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11161 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11162 heinous crime.
11163
11164 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11165 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11166 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11167 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11168 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11169
11170 @cindex cross-posting
11171 @cindex Xref
11172 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11173 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11174 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11175 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11176 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11177 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11178 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11179 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11180 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11181 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11182 the cross reference mechanism.
11183
11184 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11185 @cindex overview.fmt
11186 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11187 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11188 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11189 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11190 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11191 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11192 overview files.
11193
11194 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11195 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11196 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11197
11198 C'est la vie.
11199
11200 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11201
11202
11203 @node Duplicate Suppression
11204 @section Duplicate Suppression
11205
11206 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11207 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11208 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11209 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11210 reasons.
11211
11212 @enumerate
11213 @item
11214 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11215 is evil and not very common.
11216
11217 @item
11218 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11219 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11220
11221 @item
11222 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11223 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11224
11225 @item
11226 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11227 @end enumerate
11228
11229 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11230 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11231
11232 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11233 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11234 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11235 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11236 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11237 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11238 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11239 once.
11240
11241 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11242 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11243 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11244 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11245 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11246 saw the article in.
11247
11248 @table @code
11249 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11250 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11251 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11252
11253 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11254 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11255 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11256 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11257 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11258 session are suppressed.
11259
11260 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11261 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11262 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11263 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11264
11265 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11266 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11267 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11268 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11269 @end table
11270
11271 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11272 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11273 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11274 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11275 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11276 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11277 to you to figure out, I think.
11278
11279 @node Security
11280 @section Security
11281
11282 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11283 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11284 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11285 things to work:
11286
11287 @enumerate
11288 @item
11289 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11290 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
11291 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11292 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11293 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11294
11295 @item
11296 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11297 or newer is recommended.
11298
11299 @end enumerate
11300
11301 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11302 messages include:
11303
11304 @table @code
11305 @item mm-verify-option
11306 @vindex mm-verify-option
11307 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11308 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11309 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11310
11311 @item mm-decrypt-option
11312 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11313 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11314 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11315 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11316
11317 @item mm-sign-option
11318 @vindex mm-sign-option
11319 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11320 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11321
11322 @item mm-encrypt-option
11323 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11324 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11325 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11326 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11327
11328 @item mml1991-use
11329 @vindex mml1991-use
11330 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11331 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11332 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11333 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11334 this order.
11335
11336 @item mml2015-use
11337 @vindex mml2015-use
11338 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11339 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11340 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11341 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11342 interface in this order.
11343
11344 @end table
11345
11346 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11347 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11348 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11349 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11350 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11351 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11352 how to customize these variables to always display security
11353 information.
11354
11355 @cindex snarfing keys
11356 @cindex importing PGP keys
11357 @cindex PGP key ring import
11358 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11359 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11360 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11361 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11362 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11363 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11364 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11365 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11366 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11367
11368 @example
11369 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11370 @end example
11371 @noindent
11372 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11373 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11374
11375 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11376 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11377 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11378
11379 @node Mailing List
11380 @section Mailing List
11381 @cindex mailing list
11382 @cindex RFC 2396
11383
11384 @kindex A M (summary)
11385 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11386 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11387 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11388 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11389 summary buffer.
11390
11391 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11392
11393 @table @kbd
11394
11395 @item C-c C-n h
11396 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11397 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11398 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11399
11400 @item C-c C-n s
11401 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11402 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11403 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11404
11405 @item C-c C-n u
11406 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11407 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11408 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11409 field exists.
11410
11411 @item C-c C-n p
11412 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11413 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11414 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11415
11416 @item C-c C-n o
11417 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11418 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11419 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11420
11421 @item C-c C-n a
11422 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11423 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11424 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11425
11426 @end table
11427
11428
11429 @node Article Buffer
11430 @chapter Article Buffer
11431 @cindex article buffer
11432
11433 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11434 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11435 tell Gnus otherwise.
11436
11437 @menu
11438 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11439 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11440 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11441 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11442 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11443 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11444 @end menu
11445
11446
11447 @node Hiding Headers
11448 @section Hiding Headers
11449 @cindex hiding headers
11450 @cindex deleting headers
11451
11452 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11453 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11454
11455 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11456 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11457 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11458 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11459 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11460 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11461 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11462 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11463 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11464
11465 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11466
11467 @table @code
11468
11469 @item gnus-visible-headers
11470 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11471 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11472 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11473 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11474
11475 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11476 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11477
11478 @lisp
11479 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11480 @end lisp
11481
11482 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11483 remain visible.
11484
11485 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11486 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11487 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11488 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11489 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11490 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11491
11492 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11493 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11494
11495 @lisp
11496 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11497 @end lisp
11498
11499 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11500 be removed.
11501
11502 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11503 variable will have no effect.
11504
11505 @end table
11506
11507 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11508 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11509 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11510 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11511 the headers are to be displayed.
11512
11513 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11514 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11515
11516 @lisp
11517 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11518 @end lisp
11519
11520 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11521 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11522
11523 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11524 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11525 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11526 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11527 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11528 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11529 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11530 from sight.
11531
11532 These conditions are:
11533 @table @code
11534 @item empty
11535 Remove all empty headers.
11536 @item followup-to
11537 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11538 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11539 @item reply-to
11540 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11541 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11542 parameter is set.
11543 @item newsgroups
11544 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11545 name.
11546 @item to-address
11547 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11548 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11549 @item to-list
11550 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11551 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11552 @item cc-list
11553 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11554 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11555 @item date
11556 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11557 old.
11558 @item long-to
11559 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11560 @item many-to
11561 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11562 @end table
11563
11564 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11565
11566 @lisp
11567 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11568 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11569 @end lisp
11570
11571 This is also the default value for this variable.
11572
11573
11574 @node Using MIME
11575 @section Using MIME
11576 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11577
11578 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11579 while people stand around yawning.
11580
11581 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11582 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11583
11584 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11585 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11586 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11587
11588 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11589 @findex gnus-display-mime
11590 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11591 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11592 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11593 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11594
11595 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11596 @acronym{MIME} button:
11597
11598 @table @kbd
11599 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11600 @item RET (Article)
11601 @kindex RET (Article)
11602 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11603 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11604 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11605 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11606 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11607 object is displayed inline.
11608
11609 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11610 @item M-RET (Article)
11611 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11612 @itemx v (Article)
11613 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11614 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11615
11616 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11617 @item t (Article)
11618 @kindex t (Article)
11619 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11620 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11621
11622 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11623 @item C (Article)
11624 @kindex C (Article)
11625 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11626 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11627
11628 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11629 @item o (Article)
11630 @kindex o (Article)
11631 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11632 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11633
11634 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11635 @item C-o (Article)
11636 @kindex C-o (Article)
11637 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11638 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11639 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11640 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11641 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11642 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11643
11644 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11645 @item r (Article)
11646 @kindex r (Article)
11647 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11648 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11649 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11650
11651 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11652 @item d (Article)
11653 @kindex d (Article)
11654 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11655 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11656 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11657
11658 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11659
11660 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11661 @item c (Article)
11662 @kindex c (Article)
11663 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11664 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11665 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11666 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11667 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11668 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11669 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11670 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11671
11672 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11673 @item p (Article)
11674 @kindex p (Article)
11675 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11676 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11677 @file{.mailcap} file.
11678
11679 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11680 @item i (Article)
11681 @kindex i (Article)
11682 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11683 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11684 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11685 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11686 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11687 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11688 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11689 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11690 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11691
11692 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11693 @item E (Article)
11694 @kindex E (Article)
11695 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11696 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11697 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11698
11699 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11700 @item e (Article)
11701 @kindex e (Article)
11702 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11703 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11704
11705 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11706 @item | (Article)
11707 @kindex | (Article)
11708 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11709
11710 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11711 @item . (Article)
11712 @kindex . (Article)
11713 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11714 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11715
11716 @end table
11717
11718 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11719 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11720 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11721
11722 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11723 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11724 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11725 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11726 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11727 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11728 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11729 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11730 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11731
11732 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11733
11734 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11735
11736
11737 @node HTML
11738 @section @acronym{HTML}
11739 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11740
11741 If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11742 @acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11743 add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11744 (sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
11745
11746 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11747 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11748 section only describes the default method.
11749
11750 @table @code
11751 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11752 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11753 If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11754 that's based on @code{w3m}.
11755
11756 @item gnus-blocked-images
11757 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11758 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11759 be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11760 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11761
11762 @lisp
11763 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11764 @end lisp
11765
11766 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11767 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11768 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11769 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11770 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11771 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11772
11773 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11774
11775 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11776 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11777 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11778 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11779 this directory.
11780
11781 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11782 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11783 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11784 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11785
11786 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11787 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11788 The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
11789
11790 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11791 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11792 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11793 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11794 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11795 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11796 fit these criteria.
11797
11798 @end table
11799
11800 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11801 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11802 automatically.
11803
11804
11805
11806 @node Customizing Articles
11807 @section Customizing Articles
11808 @cindex article customization
11809
11810 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11811 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11812 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11813 called automatically when you select the articles.
11814
11815 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11816 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11817 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11818 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11819
11820 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11821 for sensible values.
11822
11823 @enumerate
11824 @item
11825 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11826
11827 @item
11828 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11829
11830 @item
11831 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11832
11833 @item
11834 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11835
11836 @item
11837 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11838
11839 @item
11840 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11841 than this number.
11842
11843 @item
11844 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11845 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11846 regexps in the list.
11847
11848 @item
11849 A list where the first element is not a string:
11850
11851 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11852 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11853 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11854
11855 @lisp
11856 (or last
11857 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11858 @end lisp
11859
11860 @end enumerate
11861
11862 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11863 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11864 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11865 considered to contain just a single part.
11866
11867 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11868 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11869 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11870 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11871 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11872 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11873 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11874
11875 @ifinfo
11876 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11877 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11878 @c `i foo-bar'.
11879 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11880 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11881 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11882 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11883 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11884 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11885 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11886 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11887 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11888 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11889 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11890 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11891 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11892 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11893 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11894 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11895 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11896 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11897 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11898 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11899 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11900 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11901 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11902 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11903 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11904 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11905 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11906 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11907 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11908 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11909 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11910 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11911 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11912 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11913 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11914 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11915 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11916 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11917 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11918 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11919 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11920 @end ifinfo
11921
11922 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11923 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11924 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11925 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11926
11927 @table @code
11928 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11929 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11930
11931 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11932
11933 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11934 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11935 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11936 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11937 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11938 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11939 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11940 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11941 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11942 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11943
11944 @xref{Article Washing}.
11945
11946 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11947
11948 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11949 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11950 headers to display. The formats available are:
11951
11952 @table @code
11953 @item ut
11954 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11955
11956 @item local
11957 The user's local time zone.
11958
11959 @item english
11960 A semi-readable English sentence.
11961
11962 @item lapsed
11963 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11964
11965 @item combined-lapsed
11966 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11967
11968 @item original
11969 The original date header.
11970
11971 @item iso8601
11972 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11973
11974 @item user-defined
11975 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11976 variable.
11977
11978 @end table
11979
11980 @xref{Article Date}.
11981
11982 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11983 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11984 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11985
11986 @xref{Picons}.
11987
11988 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
11989 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
11990
11991 @xref{Gravatars}.
11992
11993 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11994
11995 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11996
11997 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11998 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11999 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
12000
12001 @xref{Smileys}.
12002
12003 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12004 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
12005
12006 @xref{X-Face}.
12007
12008 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12009 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12010
12011 @xref{Face}.
12012
12013 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12014 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12015 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12016 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12017 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12018 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12019 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12020 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12021 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12022 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12023 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12024 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12025 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12026 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12027 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12028 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12029 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12030 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12031 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12032 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12033
12034 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12035
12036 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12037 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12038 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12039 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12040 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12041 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12042
12043 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12044
12045 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12046 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12047 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12048 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12049 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12050
12051 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12052 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12053 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12054 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12055 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12056 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12057 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12058 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12059
12060 @xref{Article Header}.
12061
12062
12063 @end table
12064
12065 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12066 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12067 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12068 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12069 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12070 everything.
12071
12072
12073 @node Article Keymap
12074 @section Article Keymap
12075
12076 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12077 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12078 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12079 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12080 buffer.
12081
12082 @kindex v (Article)
12083 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12084 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12085 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12086
12087 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12088
12089 @table @kbd
12090
12091 @item SPACE
12092 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12093 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12094 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12095 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12096
12097 @item DEL
12098 @kindex DEL (Article)
12099 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12100 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12101 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12102
12103 @item C-c ^
12104 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12105 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12106 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12107 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12108 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12109
12110 @item C-c C-m
12111 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12112 @findex gnus-article-mail
12113 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12114 given a prefix, include the mail.
12115
12116 @item s
12117 @kindex s (Article)
12118 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12119 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12120 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12121
12122 @item ?
12123 @kindex ? (Article)
12124 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12125 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12126 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12127
12128 @item TAB
12129 @kindex TAB (Article)
12130 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12131 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12132 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12133
12134 @item M-TAB
12135 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12136 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12137 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12138
12139 @item R
12140 @kindex R (Article)
12141 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12142 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12143 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12144 only yank the text in the region.
12145
12146 @item S W
12147 @kindex S W (Article)
12148 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12149 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12150 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12151 active, only yank the text in the region.
12152
12153 @item F
12154 @kindex F (Article)
12155 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12156 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12157 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12158 only yank the text in the region.
12159
12160
12161 @end table
12162
12163
12164 @node Misc Article
12165 @section Misc Article
12166
12167 @table @code
12168
12169 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12170 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12171 @cindex article buffers, several
12172 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12173 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12174 article buffer.
12175
12176 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12177 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12178 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12179 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12180
12181 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12182 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12183 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12184 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12185 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12186
12187 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12188 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12189 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12190 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12191 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12192 the contents of the article buffer.
12193
12194 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12195 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12196 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12197
12198 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12199 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12200 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12201 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12202
12203 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12204 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12205 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12206 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12207
12208 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12209 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12210 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12211 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12212 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12213 with two extensions:
12214
12215 @table @samp
12216
12217 @item w
12218 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12219 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12220 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12221
12222 @table @samp
12223
12224 @item c
12225 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12226
12227 @item h
12228 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12229
12230 @item p
12231 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12232 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12233 security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
12234
12235 @item s
12236 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12237
12238 @item o
12239 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12240
12241 @item e
12242 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12243
12244 @end table
12245
12246 @item m
12247 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12248
12249 @end table
12250
12251 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12252
12253 @item gnus-break-pages
12254 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12255 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12256 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12257 paging will not be done.
12258
12259 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12260 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12261 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12262 (formfeed).
12263
12264 @cindex IDNA
12265 @cindex internationalized domain names
12266 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12267 @item gnus-use-idna
12268 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12269 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12270 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12271 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12272 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12273 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12274
12275 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12276 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12277 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12278 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12279 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12280 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12281 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12282 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12283
12284 @end table
12285
12286
12287 @node Composing Messages
12288 @chapter Composing Messages
12289 @cindex composing messages
12290 @cindex messages
12291 @cindex mail
12292 @cindex sending mail
12293 @cindex reply
12294 @cindex followup
12295 @cindex post
12296 @cindex using gpg
12297 @cindex using s/mime
12298 @cindex using smime
12299
12300 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12301 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12302 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12303 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12304 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12305 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12306
12307 @menu
12308 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12309 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12310 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12311 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12312 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12313 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12314 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12315 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12316 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12317 @end menu
12318
12319 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12320 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12321
12322
12323 @node Mail
12324 @section Mail
12325
12326 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12327
12328 @table @code
12329 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12330 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12331 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12332 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12333 @code{nil} include all headers.
12334
12335 @item gnus-add-to-list
12336 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12337 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12338 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12339
12340 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12341 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12342 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12343 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12344 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12345 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12346 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12347 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12348
12349 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12350 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12351
12352 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12353 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12354 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12355 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12356 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12357
12358 @end table
12359
12360
12361 @node Posting Server
12362 @section Posting Server
12363
12364 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12365 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12366
12367 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12368
12369 It can be quite complicated.
12370
12371 @vindex gnus-post-method
12372 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12373 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12374 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12375 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12376 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12377 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12378 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12379 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12380 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12381
12382 @lisp
12383 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12384 @end lisp
12385
12386 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12387 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12388 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12389 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12390
12391 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12392 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12393
12394 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12395 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12396 for posting.
12397
12398 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12399 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12400
12401 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12402 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12403 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12404 value suitable for your system.
12405 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12406 information.
12407
12408
12409 @node POP before SMTP
12410 @section POP before SMTP
12411 @cindex pop before smtp
12412 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12413
12414 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12415 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12416 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12417 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12418
12419 @lisp
12420 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12421 @end lisp
12422
12423 @noindent
12424 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12425 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12426 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12427
12428 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12429 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12430 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12431 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12432 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12433 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12434
12435 @lisp
12436 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12437 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12438 :password "secret"))
12439 @end lisp
12440
12441 @noindent
12442 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12443 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12444
12445 @lisp
12446 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12447 (lambda ()
12448 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12449 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12450 :password "secret")))
12451 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12452 @end lisp
12453
12454
12455 @node Mail and Post
12456 @section Mail and Post
12457
12458 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12459 posting:
12460
12461 @table @code
12462 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12463 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12464 @cindex mailing lists
12465
12466 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12467 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12468 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12469 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12470 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12471 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12472 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12473 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12474 still a pain, though.
12475
12476 @item gnus-user-agent
12477 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12478 @cindex User-Agent
12479
12480 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12481 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12482 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12483 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12484 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12485 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12486 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12487
12488 @end table
12489
12490 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12491 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12492 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12493
12494 @cindex ispell
12495 @findex ispell-message
12496 @lisp
12497 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12498 @end lisp
12499
12500 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12501 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12502
12503 @lisp
12504 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12505 (lambda ()
12506 (cond
12507 ((string-match
12508 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12509 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12510 (t
12511 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12512 @end lisp
12513
12514 Modify to suit your needs.
12515
12516 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12517 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12518 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12519 mode buffers.
12520
12521 @node Archived Messages
12522 @section Archived Messages
12523 @cindex archived messages
12524 @cindex sent messages
12525
12526 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12527 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12528 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12529 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12530 default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
12531
12532 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12533 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12534 Group Commands}).
12535
12536 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12537 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12538 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12539 actually being used it is expanded into:
12540
12541 @lisp
12542 (nnfolder "archive"
12543 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12544 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12545 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12546 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12547 @end lisp
12548
12549 @quotation
12550 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12551 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12552 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12553 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12554 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12555 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12556 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12557 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12558 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12559 saved method to reflect always the value of
12560 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12561 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12562 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12563 @end quotation
12564
12565 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12566 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12567 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12568 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12569
12570 @lisp
12571 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12572 '(nnfolder "archive"
12573 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12574 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12575 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12576 @end lisp
12577
12578 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12579 @cindex Gcc
12580 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12581 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12582 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12583
12584 This variable can be used to do the following:
12585
12586 @table @asis
12587 @item a string
12588 Messages will be saved in that group.
12589
12590 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12591 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12592 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12593 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12594 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12595 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12596 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12597 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12598 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12599
12600 @item a list of strings
12601 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12602
12603 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12604 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12605
12606 @item @code{nil}
12607 No message archiving will take place.
12608 @end table
12609
12610 Let's illustrate:
12611
12612 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12613 @lisp
12614 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12615 @end lisp
12616
12617 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12618 @lisp
12619 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12620 @end lisp
12621
12622 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12623 @lisp
12624 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12625 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12626 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12627 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12628 @end lisp
12629
12630 More complex stuff:
12631 @lisp
12632 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12633 '((if (message-news-p)
12634 "misc-news"
12635 "misc-mail")))
12636 @end lisp
12637
12638 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12639 messages in one file per month:
12640
12641 @lisp
12642 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12643 '((if (message-news-p)
12644 "misc-news"
12645 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12646 @end lisp
12647
12648 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12649 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12650 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12651 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12652 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12653 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12654 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12655 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12656 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12657 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12658
12659 @table @code
12660 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12661 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12662 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12663
12664 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12665 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12666 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12667 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12668 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12669 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12670 changed in the future.
12671
12672 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12673 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12674 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12675 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12676 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12677 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12678
12679 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12680 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12681 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12682 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12683 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12684 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12685 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12686 except for the current group.
12687
12688 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12689 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12690 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12691 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12692
12693 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12694 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12695 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12696 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12697 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12698 subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
12699 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12700
12701 @end table
12702
12703
12704 @node Posting Styles
12705 @section Posting Styles
12706 @cindex posting styles
12707 @cindex styles
12708
12709 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12710
12711 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12712 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12713 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12714 on?
12715
12716 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12717 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12718 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12719 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12720 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12721 variable:
12722
12723 @lisp
12724 ((".*"
12725 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12726 (organization "What me?"))
12727 ("^comp"
12728 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12729 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12730 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12731 @end lisp
12732
12733 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12734 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12735 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12736 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12737 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12738 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12739 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12740 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12741
12742 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12743 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12744 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12745 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12746 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12747 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12748 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12749 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12750 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12751 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12752 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12753 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12754 said to @dfn{match}.
12755
12756 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12757 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12758 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12759 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12760 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12761 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12762 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12763 name can be one of:
12764
12765 @itemize @bullet
12766 @item @code{signature}
12767 @item @code{signature-file}
12768 @item @code{x-face-file}
12769 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12770 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12771 @item @code{body}
12772 @end itemize
12773
12774 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12775 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12776
12777 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12778 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12779 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12780 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12781 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12782
12783 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12784 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12785 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12786 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12787 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12788 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12789 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12790 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12791
12792 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12793 expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12794 the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
12795 corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12796 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
12797
12798 @vindex message-reply-headers
12799
12800 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12801 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12802 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12803
12804 @findex message-mail-p
12805 @findex message-news-p
12806
12807 So here's a new example:
12808
12809 @lisp
12810 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12811 '((".*"
12812 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12813 (name "User Name")
12814 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12815 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12816 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12817 ("^rec.humor"
12818 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12819 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12820 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12821 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12822 (signature my-news-signature))
12823 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12824 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12825 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12826 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12827 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12828 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12829 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12830 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12831 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12832 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12833 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12834 ("nnml:.*"
12835 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12836 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12837 ("^nn.+:"
12838 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12839 @end lisp
12840
12841 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12842 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12843 if you fill many roles.
12844 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12845 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12846
12847 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12848 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12849 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12850 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12851 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12852
12853
12854 @node Drafts
12855 @section Drafts
12856 @cindex drafts
12857
12858 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12859 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12860 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12861 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12862 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12863
12864 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12865 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12866 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12867 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12868 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12869 group.)
12870
12871 @cindex nndraft
12872 @vindex nndraft-directory
12873 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12874 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12875 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12876 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12877 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12878 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12879
12880 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12881 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12882 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12883 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12884 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12885 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12886 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12887 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12888 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12889
12890 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12891 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12892 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12893 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12894 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12895 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12896 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12897 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12898 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12899 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12900 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12901 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12902 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12903 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12904 @c
12905 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12906 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12907 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12908
12909 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12910 @kindex D e (Draft)
12911 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12912 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12913 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12914
12915 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12916 Articles}).
12917
12918 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12919 @kindex D s (Draft)
12920 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12921 @kindex D S (Draft)
12922 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12923 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12924 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12925 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12926 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12927 in the buffer.
12928
12929 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12930 @kindex D t (Draft)
12931 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12932 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12933 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12934
12935 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12936 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12937
12938
12939 @node Rejected Articles
12940 @section Rejected Articles
12941 @cindex rejected articles
12942
12943 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12944 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12945 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12946 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12947
12948 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12949 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12950 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12951 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12952 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12953
12954 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12955 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12956 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12957
12958 @node Signing and encrypting
12959 @section Signing and encrypting
12960 @cindex using gpg
12961 @cindex using s/mime
12962 @cindex using smime
12963
12964 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12965 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12966 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12967 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12968
12969 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12970 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12971 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12972 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12973 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12974 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12975 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12976 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12977 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12978 automatically encrypted messages.
12979
12980 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12981 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12982 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12983
12984 @table @kbd
12985
12986 @item C-c C-m s s
12987 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12988 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12989
12990 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12991
12992 @item C-c C-m s o
12993 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12994 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12995
12996 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12997
12998 @item C-c C-m s p
12999 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13000 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13001
13002 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13003
13004 @item C-c C-m c s
13005 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13006 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
13007
13008 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13009
13010 @item C-c C-m c o
13011 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13012 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13013
13014 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13015
13016 @item C-c C-m c p
13017 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13018 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13019
13020 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13021
13022 @item C-c C-m C-n
13023 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13024 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13025 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13026
13027 @end table
13028
13029 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13030
13031 @node Select Methods
13032 @chapter Select Methods
13033 @cindex foreign groups
13034 @cindex select methods
13035
13036 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13037 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13038 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13039 personal mail group.
13040
13041 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13042 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13043 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
13044 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13045 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13046 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13047
13048 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13049 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13050
13051 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13052 group as.
13053
13054 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13055 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13056 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13057 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13058 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13059
13060 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13061
13062 @menu
13063 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13064 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13065 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13066 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13067 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13068 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13069 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13070 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13071 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13072 @end menu
13073
13074
13075 @node Server Buffer
13076 @section Server Buffer
13077
13078 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13079 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13080 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13081 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13082 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13083 back end represents a virtual server.
13084
13085 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13086 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13087 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13088 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13089
13090 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13091 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13092 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13093 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13094 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13095 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13096 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13097
13098 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13099 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13100
13101 @menu
13102 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13103 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13104 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13105 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13106 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13107 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13108 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13109 @end menu
13110
13111 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13112 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13113
13114
13115 @node Server Buffer Format
13116 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13117 @cindex server buffer format
13118
13119 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13120 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13121 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13122 variable, with some simple extensions:
13123
13124 @table @samp
13125
13126 @item h
13127 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13128
13129 @item n
13130 The name of this server.
13131
13132 @item w
13133 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13134
13135 @item s
13136 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13137
13138 @item a
13139 Whether this server is agentized.
13140 @end table
13141
13142 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13143 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13144 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13145 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13146
13147 @table @samp
13148 @item S
13149 Server name.
13150
13151 @item M
13152 Server method.
13153 @end table
13154
13155 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13156
13157
13158 @node Server Commands
13159 @subsection Server Commands
13160 @cindex server commands
13161
13162 @table @kbd
13163
13164 @item v
13165 @kindex v (Server)
13166 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13167 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13168 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13169
13170 @item a
13171 @kindex a (Server)
13172 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13173 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13174
13175 @item e
13176 @kindex e (Server)
13177 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13178 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13179
13180 @item S
13181 @kindex S (Server)
13182 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13183 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13184
13185 @item SPACE
13186 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13187 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13188 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13189
13190 @item q
13191 @kindex q (Server)
13192 @findex gnus-server-exit
13193 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13194
13195 @item k
13196 @kindex k (Server)
13197 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13198 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13199
13200 @item y
13201 @kindex y (Server)
13202 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13203 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13204
13205 @item c
13206 @kindex c (Server)
13207 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13208 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13209
13210 @item l
13211 @kindex l (Server)
13212 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13213 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13214
13215 @item s
13216 @kindex s (Server)
13217 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13218 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13219 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13220 servers.
13221
13222 @item g
13223 @kindex g (Server)
13224 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13225 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13226 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13227 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13228
13229 @item z
13230 @kindex z (Server)
13231 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13232
13233 Compact all groups in the server under point
13234 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13235 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13236 hence getting a correct total article count.
13237
13238 @end table
13239
13240 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13241 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13242
13243
13244 @node Example Methods
13245 @subsection Example Methods
13246
13247 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13248
13249 @lisp
13250 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13251 @end lisp
13252
13253 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13254
13255 @lisp
13256 (nnspool "")
13257 @end lisp
13258
13259 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13260 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13261 will.
13262
13263 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13264 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13265
13266 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13267 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13268 look like then:
13269
13270 @lisp
13271 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13272 @end lisp
13273
13274 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13275 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13276
13277 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13278 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13279 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13280 your private mail:
13281
13282 @lisp
13283 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13284 @end lisp
13285
13286 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13287 that.)
13288
13289 Here's the method for a public spool:
13290
13291 @lisp
13292 (nnmh "public"
13293 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13294 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13295 @end lisp
13296
13297 @cindex proxy
13298 @cindex firewall
13299
13300 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13301 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13302 on the firewall machine and connect with
13303 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13304 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13305 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13306 should probably look something like this:
13307
13308 @lisp
13309 (nntp "firewall"
13310 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13311 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13312 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13313 @end lisp
13314
13315 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13316 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13317 configuration to the example above:
13318
13319 @lisp
13320 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13321 @end lisp
13322
13323 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13324 an indirect connection:
13325
13326 @lisp
13327 (setq gnus-select-method
13328 '(nntp "indirect"
13329 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13330 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13331 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13332 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13333 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13334 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13335 @end lisp
13336
13337 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13338 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13339
13340 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13341 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13342 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13343
13344 @lisp
13345 (nntp "outside"
13346 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13347 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13348 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13349 @end lisp
13350
13351
13352 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13353 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13354
13355 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13356 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13357
13358 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13359 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13360 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13361
13362 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13363
13364 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13365 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13366 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13367 will contain the following:
13368
13369 @lisp
13370 (nnml "cache")
13371 @end lisp
13372
13373 Change that to:
13374
13375 @lisp
13376 (nnml "cache"
13377 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13378 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13379 @end lisp
13380
13381 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13382 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13383 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13384
13385
13386 @node Server Variables
13387 @subsection Server Variables
13388 @cindex server variables
13389 @cindex server parameters
13390
13391 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13392 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13393 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13394 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13395 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13396
13397 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13398 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13399 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13400 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13401 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13402 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13403 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13404 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13405 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13406
13407 @lisp
13408 (nnml "public"
13409 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13410 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13411 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13412 @end lisp
13413
13414 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13415
13416 @node Servers and Methods
13417 @subsection Servers and Methods
13418
13419 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13420 (e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13421 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13422 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13423 over.
13424
13425
13426 @node Unavailable Servers
13427 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13428
13429 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13430 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13431 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13432 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13433 actually the case or not.
13434
13435 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13436 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13437 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13438 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13439 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13440 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13441 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13442 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13443
13444 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13445 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13446
13447 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13448 with the following commands:
13449
13450 @table @kbd
13451
13452 @item O
13453 @kindex O (Server)
13454 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13455 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13456 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13457
13458 @item C
13459 @kindex C (Server)
13460 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13461 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13462 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13463
13464 @item D
13465 @kindex D (Server)
13466 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13467 Mark the current server as unreachable
13468 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13469
13470 @item M-o
13471 @kindex M-o (Server)
13472 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13473 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13474 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13475
13476 @item M-c
13477 @kindex M-c (Server)
13478 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13479 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13480 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13481
13482 @item R
13483 @kindex R (Server)
13484 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13485 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13486 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13487
13488 @item c
13489 @kindex c (Server)
13490 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13491 Copy a server and give it a new name
13492 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13493 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13494 a different (physical) server.
13495
13496 @item L
13497 @kindex L (Server)
13498 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13499 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13500
13501 @end table
13502
13503
13504 @node Getting News
13505 @section Getting News
13506 @cindex reading news
13507 @cindex news back ends
13508
13509 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13510 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13511 or it can read from a local spool.
13512
13513 @menu
13514 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13515 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13516 @end menu
13517
13518
13519 @node NNTP
13520 @subsection NNTP
13521 @cindex nntp
13522
13523 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13524 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13525 server as the, uhm, address.
13526
13527 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13528 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13529 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13530 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13531
13532 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13533 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13534 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13535
13536 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13537 server:
13538
13539 @table @code
13540
13541 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13542 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13543 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13544 @cindex authinfo
13545 @cindex authentication
13546 @cindex nntp authentication
13547 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13548 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13549 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13550 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13551 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13552 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13553 present in this hook.
13554
13555 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13556 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13557 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13558 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13559 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13560 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13561 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13562 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13563 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13564 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13565 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13566 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13567
13568 @enumerate
13569 @item
13570 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13571
13572 @item
13573 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13574
13575 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13576 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13577 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13578 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13579 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13580 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13581 @samp{force} is explained below.
13582
13583 @end enumerate
13584
13585 Here's an example file:
13586
13587 @example
13588 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13589 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13590 @end example
13591
13592 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13593 have to be first, for instance.
13594
13595 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13596 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13597 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13598 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13599 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13600 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13601 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13602
13603 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13604 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13605
13606 @example
13607 default force yes
13608 @end example
13609
13610 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13611 previously mentioned.
13612
13613 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13614
13615 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13616 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13617 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13618 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13619 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13620
13621 @lisp
13622 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13623 '(("innd" (ding))))
13624 @end lisp
13625
13626 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13627
13628 The default value is
13629
13630 @lisp
13631 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13632 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13633 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13634 @end lisp
13635
13636 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13637 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13638
13639 @item nntp-maximum-request
13640 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13641 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13642 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13643 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13644 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13645 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13646 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13647
13648 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13649 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13650 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13651 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13652 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13653 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13654 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13655 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13656 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13657 no timeouts are done.
13658
13659 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13660 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13661 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13662 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13663 can be used.
13664
13665 @item nntp-xover-commands
13666 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13667 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13668 @cindex XOVER
13669 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13670 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13671 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13672
13673 @item nntp-nov-gap
13674 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13675 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13676 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13677 if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
13678 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13679 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13680 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13681 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13682 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13683 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13684 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13685
13686 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13687 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13688 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13689 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13690 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13691 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13692 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13693 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13694 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13695 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13696 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13697 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13698 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13699 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13700 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13701 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13702 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13703
13704 @lisp
13705 (setq gnus-select-method
13706 '(nntp "newszilla"
13707 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13708 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13709 @dots{}))
13710 @end lisp
13711
13712 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13713
13714 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13715 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13716 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13717
13718 @item nntp-record-commands
13719 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13720 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13721 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13722 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13723 that doesn't seem to work.
13724
13725 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13726 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13727 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13728 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13729 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13730 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13731 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13732 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13733
13734 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13735 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13736 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13737 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13738 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13739 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13740 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13741 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13742 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13743
13744 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13745 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13746 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13747 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13748 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13749 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13750 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13751
13752 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13753 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13754 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13755 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13756 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13757 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13758 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13759
13760 @lisp
13761 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13762 @end lisp
13763
13764 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
13765 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13766
13767 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13768 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13769 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13770 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13771
13772
13773 @end table
13774
13775 @menu
13776 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13777 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13778 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13779 @end menu
13780
13781
13782 @node Direct Functions
13783 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13784 @cindex direct connection functions
13785
13786 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13787 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13788 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13789 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13790
13791 @table @code
13792 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13793 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13794 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13795 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13796 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13797 connection automatically.
13798
13799 @item network-only
13800 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13801
13802 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13803 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13804 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13805 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13806 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13807
13808 @lisp
13809 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13810 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13811 ;;
13812 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13813 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13814 (nntp-port-number 563)
13815 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13816 @end lisp
13817
13818 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13819 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13820 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13821 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13822 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13823 then define a server as follows:
13824
13825 @lisp
13826 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13827 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13828 ;;
13829 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13830 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13831 (nntp-port-number 563)
13832 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13833 @end lisp
13834
13835 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13836 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13837 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13838 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13839 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13840 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13841 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13842 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13843
13844 @lisp
13845 (nntp "socksified"
13846 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13847 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13848 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13849 @end lisp
13850
13851 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13852 session, which is not a good idea.
13853
13854 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13855 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13856 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13857 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13858 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13859 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13860
13861 @lisp
13862 (nntp "socksified"
13863 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13864 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13865 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13866 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13867 @end lisp
13868 @end table
13869
13870
13871 @node Indirect Functions
13872 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13873 @cindex indirect connection functions
13874
13875 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13876 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13877 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13878 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13879 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13880 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13881
13882 @table @code
13883 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13884 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13885 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13886 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13887 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13888
13889 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13890
13891 @table @code
13892 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13893 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13894 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13895 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13896
13897 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13898 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13899 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13900 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13901 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13902 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13903 @end table
13904
13905 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13906 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13907 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13908 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13909 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13910 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13911
13912 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13913
13914 @table @code
13915 @item nntp-telnet-command
13916 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13917 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13918 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13919
13920 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13921 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13922 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13923 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13924
13925 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13926 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13927 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13928 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13929
13930 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13931 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13932 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13933 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13934 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13935 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13936 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13937 @end table
13938
13939 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13940 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13941
13942 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13943 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13944 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13945 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13946
13947 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13948
13949 @table @code
13950 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13951 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13952 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13953 @samp{telnet}.
13954
13955 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13956 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13957 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13958 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13959
13960 @item nntp-via-user-password
13961 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13962 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13963
13964 @item nntp-via-envuser
13965 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13966 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13967 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13968 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13969
13970 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13971 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13972 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13973 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13974
13975 @end table
13976
13977 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13978 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13979 @end table
13980
13981
13982 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13983 functions:
13984
13985 @table @code
13986
13987 @item nntp-via-user-name
13988 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13989 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13990
13991 @item nntp-via-address
13992 @vindex nntp-via-address
13993 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13994
13995 @end table
13996
13997
13998 @node Common Variables
13999 @subsubsection Common Variables
14000
14001 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14002 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14003 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14004 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14005 variables individually).
14006
14007 @table @code
14008
14009 @item nntp-pre-command
14010 @vindex nntp-pre-command
14011 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14012 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14013 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14014 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14015
14016 @item nntp-address
14017 @vindex nntp-address
14018 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14019
14020 @item nntp-port-number
14021 @vindex nntp-port-number
14022 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14023 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14024 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14025 than named ports (i.e., use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14026 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14027 not work with named ports.
14028
14029 @item nntp-end-of-line
14030 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14031 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14032 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14033 using a non native telnet connection function.
14034
14035 @item nntp-netcat-command
14036 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14037 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14038 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14039 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14040 @samp{nc}.
14041
14042 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14043 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14044 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14045 is @samp{()}.
14046
14047 @end table
14048
14049 @node News Spool
14050 @subsection News Spool
14051 @cindex nnspool
14052 @cindex news spool
14053
14054 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14055 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14056 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14057 instance.
14058
14059 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14060 anything else) as the address.
14061
14062 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14063 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14064 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14065 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14066
14067 @table @code
14068
14069 @item nnspool-inews-program
14070 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14071 Program used to post an article.
14072
14073 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14074 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14075 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14076
14077 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14078 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14079 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14080 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14081
14082 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14083 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14084 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14085 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14086
14087 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14088 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14089 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14090
14091 @item nnspool-active-file
14092 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14093 The name of the active file.
14094
14095 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14096 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14097 The name of the group descriptions file.
14098
14099 @item nnspool-history-file
14100 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14101 The name of the news history file.
14102
14103 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14104 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14105 The name of the active date file.
14106
14107 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14108 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14109 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14110 that it finds.
14111
14112 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14113 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14114 @cindex sed
14115 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14116 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14117 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14118 there.
14119
14120 @end table
14121
14122
14123 @node Using IMAP
14124 @section Using IMAP
14125 @cindex imap
14126
14127 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14128 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14129 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14130 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14131 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14132
14133 @menu
14134 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14135 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14136 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14137 @end menu
14138
14139
14140 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14141 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14142
14143 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14144 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14145 something like:
14146
14147 @example
14148 (setq gnus-select-method
14149 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14150 @end example
14151
14152 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14153 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14154
14155 @example
14156 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14157 @end example
14158
14159 That should basically be it for most users.
14160
14161
14162 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14163 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14164
14165 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14166
14167 @example
14168 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14169 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14170 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14171 (nnimap-expunge t)
14172 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14173 @end example
14174
14175 @table @code
14176 @item nnimap-address
14177 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14178
14179 @item nnimap-server-port
14180 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14181 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14182
14183 @item nnimap-stream
14184 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14185
14186 @table @code
14187 @item undecided
14188 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14189 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14190
14191 @item ssl
14192 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14193
14194 @item network
14195 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14196 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14197 supports it.
14198
14199 @item starttls
14200 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14201
14202 @item shell
14203 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14204 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14205 what you need.
14206
14207 @end table
14208
14209 @item nnimap-authenticator
14210 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14211 this should be set to @code{anonymous}. If this variable isn't set,
14212 the normal login methods will be used. If you wish to specify a
14213 specific login method to be used, you can set this variable to either
14214 @code{login} (the traditional @acronym{IMAP} login method),
14215 @code{plain} or @code{cram-md5}.
14216
14217 @item nnimap-expunge
14218 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14219 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14220 servers that doesn't support that command.
14221
14222 @item nnimap-streaming
14223 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14224 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14225 @code{nil}.
14226
14227 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14228 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14229 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14230 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14231 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14232
14233 @item nnimap-record-commands
14234 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14235 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14236
14237 @end table
14238
14239
14240 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14241 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14242
14243 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14244 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14245 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14246
14247 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14248 variables are relevant:
14249
14250 @table @code
14251 @item nnimap-inbox
14252 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new mail.
14253
14254 @item nnimap-split-methods
14255 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14256 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14257 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14258
14259 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14260 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14261
14262 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14263 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14264 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14265 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14266
14267 @end table
14268
14269 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14270 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14271
14272 @example
14273 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14274 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14275 (nnimap-split-methods
14276 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14277 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14278 "undecided")))
14279 @end example
14280
14281
14282 @node Getting Mail
14283 @section Getting Mail
14284 @cindex reading mail
14285 @cindex mail
14286
14287 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
14288 course.
14289
14290 @menu
14291 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14292 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14293 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14294 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14295 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14296 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14297 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14298 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14299 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14300 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14301 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14302 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14303 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14304 @end menu
14305
14306
14307 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14308 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14309
14310 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14311 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14312 of a culture shock.
14313
14314 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14315 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14316
14317 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14318 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14319 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14320 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14321
14322 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14323
14324 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14325 deleted? How awful!
14326
14327 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14328 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14329 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14330 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14331 Mail}.
14332
14333 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14334 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14335 they want to treat a message.
14336
14337 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14338 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14339 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14340 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14341 archived somewhere else.
14342
14343 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14344 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14345 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14346 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14347 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14348
14349 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14350 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14351 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14352
14353 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14354 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14355 differently.
14356
14357 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14358 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14359 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14360 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14361 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14362
14363 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14364 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14365 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14366 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14367 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14368 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14369 You Do.)
14370
14371
14372 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14373 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14374
14375 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14376 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14377 and things will happen automatically.
14378
14379 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14380 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14381
14382 @lisp
14383 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14384 @end lisp
14385
14386 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14387 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14388 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14389 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14390 like any other group.
14391
14392 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14393
14394 @lisp
14395 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14396 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14397 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14398 ("other" "")))
14399 @end lisp
14400
14401 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14402 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14403 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14404 last group.
14405
14406 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14407 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14408 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14409
14410
14411 @node Splitting Mail
14412 @subsection Splitting Mail
14413 @cindex splitting mail
14414 @cindex mail splitting
14415 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14416
14417 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14418 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14419 to be split into groups.
14420
14421 @lisp
14422 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14423 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14424 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14425 ("mail.other" "")))
14426 @end lisp
14427
14428 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14429 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14430 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14431 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14432 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14433 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14434 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14435
14436 @lisp
14437 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14438 @end lisp
14439
14440 @noindent
14441 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14442 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14443
14444 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14445 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14446 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14447 mail belongs in that group.
14448
14449 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14450 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14451 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14452 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14453 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14454 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14455 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14456 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14457 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14458 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14459
14460 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14461 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14462 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14463 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14464 thinks should carry this mail message.
14465
14466 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14467 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14468
14469 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14470 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14471 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14472 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14473
14474 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14475 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14476 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14477 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14478 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14479
14480 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14481 @cindex crosspost
14482 @cindex links
14483 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14484 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14485 links. If that's the case for you, set
14486 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14487 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14488
14489 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14490 @findex nnmail-split-history
14491 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14492 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14493 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14494 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14495 Group Commands}).
14496
14497 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14498 Header lines longer than the value of
14499 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14500 function.
14501
14502 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14503 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14504 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14505 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14506 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14507 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14508 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14509 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14510 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14511 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14512 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14513 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14514
14515 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14516 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14517 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14518 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14519 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14520 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14521 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14522 other kinds of entries.)
14523
14524 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14525 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14526 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14527 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14528 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14529 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14530 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14531 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14532 month's rent money.
14533
14534
14535 @node Mail Sources
14536 @subsection Mail Sources
14537
14538 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14539 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14540 maildir, for instance.
14541
14542 @menu
14543 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14544 * Mail Source Functions::
14545 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14546 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14547 @end menu
14548
14549
14550 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14551 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14552 @cindex POP
14553 @cindex mail server
14554 @cindex procmail
14555 @cindex mail spool
14556 @cindex mail source
14557
14558 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14559 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14560
14561 Here's an example:
14562
14563 @lisp
14564 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14565 @end lisp
14566
14567 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14568 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14569 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14570 default values.
14571
14572 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14573 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14574 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14575 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14576 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14577 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14578 group might look like this:
14579
14580 @lisp
14581 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14582 @end lisp
14583
14584 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14585 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14586
14587 The following mail source types are available:
14588
14589 @table @code
14590 @item file
14591 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14592
14593 Keywords:
14594
14595 @table @code
14596 @item :path
14597 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14598 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14599 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14600
14601 @item :prescript
14602 @itemx :postscript
14603 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14604 @end table
14605
14606 An example file mail source:
14607
14608 @lisp
14609 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14610 @end lisp
14611
14612 Or using the default file name:
14613
14614 @lisp
14615 (file)
14616 @end lisp
14617
14618 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14619 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14620 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14621 mail spool while moving the mail.
14622
14623 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14624
14625 @lisp
14626 (setq mail-sources
14627 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14628 @end lisp
14629
14630 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14631
14632 @example
14633 #!/bin/sh
14634 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14635 # flu@@iki.fi
14636
14637 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14638 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14639 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14640 @end example
14641
14642 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14643 file you want to use.
14644
14645
14646 @item directory
14647 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14648 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14649 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14650 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14651 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14652 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14653 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14654 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14655 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14656 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14657
14658 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14659 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14660 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14661 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14662
14663 Keywords:
14664
14665 @table @code
14666 @item :path
14667 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14668 value.
14669
14670 @item :suffix
14671 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14672 @samp{.spool}.
14673
14674 @item :predicate
14675 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14676 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14677 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14678 predicate are considered.
14679
14680 @item :prescript
14681 @itemx :postscript
14682 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14683
14684 @end table
14685
14686 An example directory mail source:
14687
14688 @lisp
14689 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14690 :suffix ".prcml")
14691 @end lisp
14692
14693 @item pop
14694 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14695
14696 Keywords:
14697
14698 @table @code
14699 @item :server
14700 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14701 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14702
14703 @item :port
14704 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14705 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14706 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14707 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14708 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14709
14710 @item :user
14711 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14712 name.
14713
14714 @item :password
14715 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14716 the user is prompted.
14717
14718 @item :program
14719 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14720 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14721
14722 @example
14723 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14724 @end example
14725
14726 The valid format specifier characters are:
14727
14728 @table @samp
14729 @item t
14730 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14731 included in this string.
14732
14733 @item s
14734 The name of the server.
14735
14736 @item P
14737 The port number of the server.
14738
14739 @item u
14740 The user name to use.
14741
14742 @item p
14743 The password to use.
14744 @end table
14745
14746 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14747 corresponding keywords.
14748
14749 @item :prescript
14750 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14751 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14752
14753 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14754 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14755
14756 @lisp
14757 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14758 :port 1234
14759 :user "foo"
14760 :password "secret"
14761 :prescript
14762 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14763 @end lisp
14764
14765 @item :postscript
14766 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14767 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14768
14769 @item :function
14770 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14771 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14772 mail should be moved to.
14773
14774 @item :authentication
14775 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14776 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14777 @code{password}.
14778
14779 @item :leave
14780 Non-@code{nil} if the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14781 after fetching. Mails once fetched will never be fetched again by the
14782 @acronym{UIDL} control. Only the built-in @code{pop3-movemail} program
14783 (the default) supports this keyword.
14784
14785 If this is neither @code{nil} nor a number, all mails will be left on
14786 the server. If this is a number, leave mails on the server for this
14787 many days since you first checked new mails. If this is @code{nil}
14788 (the default), mails will be deleted on the server right after fetching.
14789
14790 @vindex pop3-uidl-file
14791 The @code{pop3-uidl-file} variable specifies the file to which the
14792 @acronym{UIDL} data are locally stored. The default value is
14793 @file{~/.pop3-uidl}.
14794
14795 Note that @acronym{POP} servers maintain no state information between
14796 sessions, so what the client believes is there and what is actually
14797 there may not match up. If they do not, then you may get duplicate
14798 mails or the whole thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt
14799 mailbox.
14800
14801 @end table
14802
14803 @findex pop3-movemail
14804 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14805 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14806 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
14807
14808 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14809
14810 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14811 name, and default fetcher:
14812
14813 @lisp
14814 (pop)
14815 @end lisp
14816
14817 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14818
14819 @lisp
14820 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14821 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14822 @end lisp
14823
14824 Leave mails on the server for 14 days:
14825
14826 @lisp
14827 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14828 :user "user-name" :password "secret"
14829 :leave 14)
14830 @end lisp
14831
14832 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14833
14834 @lisp
14835 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14836 @end lisp
14837
14838 @item maildir
14839 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14840 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14841 contains exactly one mail.
14842
14843 Keywords:
14844
14845 @table @code
14846 @item :path
14847 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14848 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14849 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14850 @item :subdirs
14851 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14852 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14853
14854 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14855 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14856 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14857 @c below.
14858
14859 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14860 from locking problems).
14861
14862 @end table
14863
14864 Two example maildir mail sources:
14865
14866 @lisp
14867 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14868 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14869 @end lisp
14870
14871 @lisp
14872 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14873 :subdirs ("new"))
14874 @end lisp
14875
14876 @item imap
14877 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14878 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
14879 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14880 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14881 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14882
14883 Keywords:
14884
14885 @table @code
14886 @item :server
14887 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14888 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14889
14890 @item :port
14891 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14892 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14893
14894 @item :user
14895 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14896 name.
14897
14898 @item :password
14899 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14900 prompted.
14901
14902 @item :stream
14903 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14904 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14905 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14906 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14907
14908 @item :authentication
14909 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14910 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14911 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14912 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14913
14914 @item :program
14915 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14916 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14917 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14918
14919 @example
14920 ssh %s imapd
14921 @end example
14922
14923 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14924 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14925 specifier characters are:
14926
14927 @table @samp
14928 @item s
14929 The name of the server.
14930
14931 @item l
14932 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14933
14934 @item p
14935 The port number of the server.
14936 @end table
14937
14938 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14939 corresponding keywords.
14940
14941 @item :mailbox
14942 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14943 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
14944
14945 @item :predicate
14946 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14947 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14948 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14949 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14950 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14951 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14952
14953 @item :fetchflag
14954 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14955 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14956 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14957 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14958
14959 @item :dontexpunge
14960 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14961 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14962
14963 @end table
14964
14965 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14966
14967 @lisp
14968 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14969 :stream kerberos4
14970 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14971 @end lisp
14972
14973 @item group
14974 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14975 @xref{Group Parameters}.
14976
14977 @end table
14978
14979 @table @dfn
14980 @item Common Keywords
14981 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14982
14983 Keywords:
14984
14985 @table @code
14986 @item :plugged
14987 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14988 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14989 example:
14990
14991 @lisp
14992 (setq mail-sources
14993 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14994 :suffix ""
14995 :plugged t)))
14996 @end lisp
14997
14998 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14999 useful when you use local mail and news.
15000
15001 @end table
15002 @end table
15003
15004 @node Mail Source Functions
15005 @subsubsection Function Interface
15006
15007 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15008 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15009 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15010 consider the following mail-source setting:
15011
15012 @lisp
15013 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15014 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15015 @end lisp
15016
15017 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15018 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15019 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15020 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15021 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15022
15023 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15024
15025
15026 @node Mail Source Customization
15027 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15028
15029 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15030 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15031 variables.
15032
15033 @table @code
15034 @item mail-source-crash-box
15035 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
15036 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15037 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15038
15039 @cindex Incoming*
15040 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15041 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15042 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15043 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15044 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15045 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15046 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15047 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15048 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15049 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15050
15051 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15052 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15053 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15054 files. This variable only applies when
15055 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15056
15057 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15058 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15059 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15060
15061 @item mail-source-directory
15062 @vindex mail-source-directory
15063 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15064 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15065 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15066 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15067
15068 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15069 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15070 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15071 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15072 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15073 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15074 number.
15075
15076 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15077 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15078 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15079
15080 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15081 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15082 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15083 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15084
15085 @end table
15086
15087
15088 @node Fetching Mail
15089 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15090
15091 @vindex mail-sources
15092 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15093 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15094 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15095
15096 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15097 fetch mail by themselves.
15098
15099 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15100 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15101
15102 @lisp
15103 (setq mail-sources
15104 '((file)
15105 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15106 :password "secret")))
15107 @end lisp
15108
15109 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15110
15111 @lisp
15112 (setq mail-sources
15113 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15114 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15115 :user "user-name"
15116 :port "pop3"
15117 :password "secret")))
15118 @end lisp
15119
15120
15121 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15122 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15123 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15124 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15125 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15126 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15127
15128
15129
15130 @node Mail Back End Variables
15131 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15132
15133 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15134 mail back ends.
15135
15136 @table @code
15137 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15138 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15139 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15140 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15141
15142 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15143 @item nnmail-split-hook
15144 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15145 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15146 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15147 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15148 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15149 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15150 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15151 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15152 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15153 to this hook.
15154
15155 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15156 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15157 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15158 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15159 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15160 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15161 starting to handle the new mail) and
15162 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15163 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15164 default file modes the new mail files get:
15165
15166 @lisp
15167 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15168 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15169
15170 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15171 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15172 @end lisp
15173
15174 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15175 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15176 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15177 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15178 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15179 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15180 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15181
15182 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15183 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15184 @findex delete-file
15185 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15186
15187 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15188 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15189 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15190 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15191 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15192
15193 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15194 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15195 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15196 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15197 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15198
15199 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15200 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15201 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15202
15203 @end table
15204
15205
15206 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15207 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15208 @cindex mail splitting
15209 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15210
15211 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15212 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15213 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15214 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15215 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15216 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15217
15218 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15219
15220 @lisp
15221 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15222 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15223 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15224 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15225 "mail.misc"))
15226 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15227 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15228 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15229 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15230 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15231 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15232 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15233 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15234 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15235 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15236 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15237 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15238 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15239 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15240 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15241 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15242 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15243 "misc.misc")
15244 @end lisp
15245
15246 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15247 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15248 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15249
15250 @table @code
15251
15252 @item group
15253 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15254 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15255
15256 @c Don't fold this line.
15257 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15258 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15259 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15260 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15261 @var{split}.
15262
15263 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15264 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15265 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15266 @var{split} is processed.
15267
15268 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15269 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15270 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15271 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15272
15273 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15274 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15275 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15276 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15277 stored in one or more groups.
15278
15279 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15280 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15281 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15282
15283 @item junk
15284 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15285 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15286
15287 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15288 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15289 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15290 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15291
15292 @cindex body split
15293 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15294 body of the messages:
15295
15296 @lisp
15297 (defun split-on-body ()
15298 (save-excursion
15299 (save-restriction
15300 (widen)
15301 (goto-char (point-min))
15302 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15303 "string.group"))))
15304 @end lisp
15305
15306 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15307 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15308 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15309 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15310 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15311 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15312 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15313
15314 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15315 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15316 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15317 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15318 should return a split.
15319
15320 @item nil
15321 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15322
15323 @end table
15324
15325 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15326
15327 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15328 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15329 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15330 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15331 for example,
15332
15333 @example
15334 (any "joe" "joemail")
15335 @end example
15336
15337 @noindent
15338 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15339 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15340 of the following three ways:
15341
15342 @enumerate
15343 @item
15344 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15345 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15346 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15347 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15348 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15349 @code{nil}.
15350
15351 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15352
15353 @item
15354 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15355 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15356 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15357 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15358 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15359
15360 @item
15361 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15362 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15363 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15364 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15365 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15366 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15367 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15368 @end enumerate
15369
15370 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15371 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15372 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15373 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15374 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15375 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15376 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15377
15378 @table @code
15379 @item from
15380 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15381 @item to
15382 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15383 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15384 @item any
15385 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15386 @end table
15387
15388 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15389 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15390 when all this splitting is performed.
15391
15392 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15393 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15394 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15395
15396 @example
15397 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15398 @end example
15399
15400 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15401 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15402
15403 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15404 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15405 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15406 groupings 1 through 9.
15407
15408 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15409 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15410 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15411 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15412 groups when users send to an address using different case
15413 (i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15414 is @code{t}.
15415
15416 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15417 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15418 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15419 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15420 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15421 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15422 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15423 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15424 it once per thread.
15425
15426 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15427 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15428 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15429 using the colon feature, like so:
15430 @lisp
15431 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15432 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15433 nnmail-split-fancy
15434 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15435 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15436 ))
15437 @end lisp
15438
15439 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15440 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15441 in the file specified by the variable
15442 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15443 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15444 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15445 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15446 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15447 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15448 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15449 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15450 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15451 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15452 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15453 300 kBytes in size.)
15454 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15455 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15456 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15457 messages goes into the new group.
15458
15459 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15460 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15461 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15462 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15463 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15464 ``outgoing'' group.
15465
15466
15467 @node Group Mail Splitting
15468 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15469 @cindex mail splitting
15470 @cindex group mail splitting
15471
15472 @findex gnus-group-split
15473 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15474 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15475 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15476 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15477 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15478 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15479 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15480 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15481
15482 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15483 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15484 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15485 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15486
15487 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15488 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15489 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15490 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15491 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15492 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15493 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15494
15495 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15496 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15497 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15498 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15499 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15500 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15501 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15502
15503 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15504 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15505 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15506 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15507 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15508 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15509 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15510 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15511 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15512 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15513 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15514 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15515 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15516
15517 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15518 been defined:
15519
15520 @example
15521 nnml:mail.bar:
15522 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15523 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15524 nnml:mail.foo:
15525 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15526 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15527 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15528 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15529 nnml:mail.others:
15530 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15531 @end example
15532
15533 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15534 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15535 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15536
15537 @lisp
15538 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15539 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15540 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15541 "mail.others")
15542 @end lisp
15543
15544 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15545 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15546 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15547 splits like this:
15548
15549 @lisp
15550 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15551 @end lisp
15552
15553 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15554 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15555 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15556 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15557 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15558 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15559 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15560 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15561 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15562
15563 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15564 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15565 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15566 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15567 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15568 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15569 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15570 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15571 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15572
15573 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15574 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15575 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15576 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15577 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15578 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15579
15580 @lisp
15581 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15582 @end lisp
15583
15584 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15585 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15586 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15587 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15588 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15589 value.
15590
15591 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15592 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15593 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15594 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15595
15596 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15597 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15598 @cindex incorporating old mail
15599 @cindex import old mail
15600
15601 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15602 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15603 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15604 your mail groups.
15605
15606 Doing so can be quite easy.
15607
15608 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15609 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15610 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15611 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15612 your @code{nnml} groups.
15613
15614 Here's how:
15615
15616 @enumerate
15617 @item
15618 Go to the group buffer.
15619
15620 @item
15621 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15622 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15623
15624 @item
15625 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15626
15627 @item
15628 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15629 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15630
15631 @item
15632 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15633 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15634 @end enumerate
15635
15636 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15637 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15638 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15639 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15640 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15641
15642 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15643 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15644 using the new mail back end.
15645
15646
15647 @node Expiring Mail
15648 @subsection Expiring Mail
15649 @cindex article expiry
15650 @cindex expiring mail
15651
15652 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15653 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15654 different approach to mail reading.
15655
15656 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15657 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15658 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15659 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15660 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15661 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15662 course.
15663
15664 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15665 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15666 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15667 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15668 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15669 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15670 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15671 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15672 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15673
15674 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15675 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15676 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15677 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15678 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15679 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15680 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15681 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15682 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15683 these marks.
15684
15685 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15686 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15687 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15688 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15689 into its own group.)
15690
15691 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15692 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15693 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15694 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15695 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15696 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15697 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15698 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15699 scoring.
15700
15701 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15702 Groups that match the regular expression
15703 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15704 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15705 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15706
15707 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15708 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15709 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15710 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15711 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15712
15713 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15714 @lisp
15715 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15716 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15717 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15718 @end lisp
15719
15720 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15721 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15722 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15723 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15724 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15725
15726 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15727 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15728
15729 @lisp
15730 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15731 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15732 @end lisp
15733
15734 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15735 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15736
15737 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15738 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15739 don't really mix very well.
15740
15741 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15742 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15743 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15744 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15745 days.
15746
15747 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15748 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15749 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15750 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15751 everywhere else:
15752
15753 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15754 @lisp
15755 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15756 (lambda (group)
15757 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15758 31)
15759 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15760 1)
15761 ((string= group "important")
15762 'never)
15763 (t
15764 6))))
15765 @end lisp
15766
15767 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15768 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15769
15770 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15771 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15772 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15773 @code{never}.
15774
15775 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15776 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15777
15778 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15779 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15780 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15781 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15782 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15783 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15784 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15785 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15786 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15787 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15788 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15789 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15790 name or @code{delete}.
15791
15792 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15793 @lisp
15794 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15795 @end lisp
15796
15797 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15798 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15799 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15800 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15801 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15802
15803 @lisp
15804 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15805 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15806 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15807 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15808 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15809 @end lisp
15810
15811 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15812 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15813 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15814 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15815 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15816 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15817
15818 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15819 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15820 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15821 easier for procmail users.
15822
15823 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15824 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15825 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15826 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15827 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15828 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15829 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15830 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15831 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15832 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15833 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15834 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15835 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15836 with! So there!
15837
15838 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15839
15840 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15841 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15842 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15843 auto-expire turned on.
15844
15845 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15846 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15847 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15848 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15849 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15850 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15851 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15852 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15853 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15854 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15855 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15856 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15857 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15858 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15859 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15860 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15861
15862
15863 @node Washing Mail
15864 @subsection Washing Mail
15865 @cindex mail washing
15866 @cindex list server brain damage
15867 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15868
15869 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15870 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15871 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15872 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15873 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15874 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15875
15876 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15877 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15878 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15879 laugh.
15880
15881 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15882 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15883 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15884 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15885
15886 @table @code
15887 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15888 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15889 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15890 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15891 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15892
15893 @table @code
15894 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15895 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15896 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15897 Emacs running on MS machines.
15898
15899 @end table
15900
15901 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15902 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15903 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15904 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15905
15906 @table @code
15907 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15908 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15909 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15910 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15911
15912 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15913 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15914 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15915 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15916 into a feature by documenting it.)
15917
15918 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15919 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15920 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15921 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15922 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15923 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15924 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15925 @code{\\(..\\)}.
15926
15927 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15928 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15929
15930 @lisp
15931 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15932 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15933 @end lisp
15934
15935 This can also be done non-destructively with
15936 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15937
15938 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
15939 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15940 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15941
15942 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15943 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15944 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15945 @cindex Eudora
15946 @cindex Pegasus
15947 Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15948 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15949 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15950 contain a line matching the regular expression
15951 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
15952
15953 @end table
15954
15955 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15956 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15957 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15958 include:
15959
15960 @table @code
15961 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15962 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15963 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15964
15965 @end table
15966 @end table
15967
15968
15969 @node Duplicates
15970 @subsection Duplicates
15971
15972 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15973 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15974 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15975 @cindex duplicate mails
15976 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15977 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15978 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15979 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
15980 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15981 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15982 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15983 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15984 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15985 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15986 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15987 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15988 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15989
15990 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15991 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15992 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15993 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15994
15995 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15996 @code{nil}.
15997
15998 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15999 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16000 methods:
16001
16002 @lisp
16003 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
16004 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16005 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16006 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16007 (any mail "mail.misc")
16008 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16009 [...] ))
16010 @end lisp
16011 @noindent
16012 Or something like:
16013 @lisp
16014 (setq nnmail-split-methods
16015 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16016 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16017 [...]))
16018 @end lisp
16019
16020 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16021 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16022 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16023 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16024 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16025
16026
16027 @node Not Reading Mail
16028 @subsection Not Reading Mail
16029
16030 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16031 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16032 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16033
16034 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16035 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16036 mail, which should help.
16037
16038 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16039 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16040 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16041 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16042 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16043 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16044 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16045 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16046 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16047 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16048 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16049
16050 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16051 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16052 incoming mail.
16053
16054
16055 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16056 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16057
16058 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16059 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16060 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16061
16062 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16063 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16064 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16065 Spool}).
16066
16067 @menu
16068 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16069 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16070 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16071 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16072 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16073 * nnmaildir Group Parameters::
16074 * Article Identification::
16075 * NOV Data::
16076 * Article Marks::
16077 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16078 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16079 @end menu
16080
16081
16082
16083 @node Unix Mail Box
16084 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16085 @cindex nnmbox
16086 @cindex unix mail box
16087
16088 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16089 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16090 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16091 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16092 which group it belongs in.
16093
16094 Virtual server settings:
16095
16096 @table @code
16097 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16098 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16099 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16100 @file{~/mbox}.
16101
16102 @item nnmbox-active-file
16103 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16104 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16105 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16106
16107 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16108 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16109 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16110 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16111 @end table
16112
16113
16114 @node Babyl
16115 @subsubsection Babyl
16116 @cindex nnbabyl
16117
16118 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16119 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16120 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16121 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16122 group it belongs in.
16123
16124 Virtual server settings:
16125
16126 @table @code
16127 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16128 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16129 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16130
16131 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16132 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16133 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16134 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16135
16136 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16137 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16138 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16139 @code{t}
16140 @end table
16141
16142
16143 @node Mail Spool
16144 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16145 @cindex nnml
16146 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16147
16148 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16149 format. It should be used with some caution.
16150
16151 @vindex nnml-directory
16152 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16153 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16154 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16155 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16156
16157 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16158 care of all that.
16159
16160 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16161 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16162 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16163 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16164 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16165 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16166 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16167 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16168
16169 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16170 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16171 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16172 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16173
16174 Virtual server settings:
16175
16176 @table @code
16177 @item nnml-directory
16178 @vindex nnml-directory
16179 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16180 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16181 is @file{~/Mail}).
16182
16183 @item nnml-active-file
16184 @vindex nnml-active-file
16185 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16186 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16187
16188 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16189 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16190 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16191 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16192
16193 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16194 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16195 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16196 @code{t}.
16197
16198 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16199 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16200 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16201 default is @code{nil}.
16202
16203 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16204 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16205 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16206
16207 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16208 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16209 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16210
16211 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16212 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16213 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16214 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16215 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16216 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16217 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16218 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16219 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16220
16221 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16222 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16223 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16224 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16225 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16226
16227 @end table
16228
16229 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16230 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16231 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16232 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16233 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16234 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16235 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16236 Commands}).
16237
16238
16239 @node MH Spool
16240 @subsubsection MH Spool
16241 @cindex nnmh
16242 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16243
16244 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16245 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16246 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16247 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16248 for.
16249
16250 Virtual server settings:
16251
16252 @table @code
16253 @item nnmh-directory
16254 @vindex nnmh-directory
16255 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16256 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16257 @file{~/Mail})
16258
16259 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16260 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16261 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16262 @code{t}.
16263
16264 @item nnmh-be-safe
16265 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16266 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16267 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16268 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16269 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16270 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16271 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16272 @end table
16273
16274
16275 @node Maildir
16276 @subsubsection Maildir
16277 @cindex nnmaildir
16278 @cindex maildir
16279
16280 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16281 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16282 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16283 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16284 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16285 within a maildir.
16286
16287 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16288 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16289 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16290 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16291 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16292 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16293 that appear as group in Gnus.
16294
16295 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16296 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16297 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16298
16299 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16300 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16301 another, and you will keep your marks.
16302
16303 Virtual server settings:
16304
16305 @table @code
16306 @item directory
16307 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16308 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16309 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16310 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16311 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16312 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16313 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16314 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16315 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16316 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16317
16318 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16319 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16320 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16321 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16322 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16323 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16324 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16325 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16326 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16327 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16328 value.
16329
16330 @item target-prefix
16331 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16332 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16333 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16334 closed.
16335
16336 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16337 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16338 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16339 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16340 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16341 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16342 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16343 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16344 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16345
16346 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16347 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16348 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16349 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16350 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16351
16352 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16353 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16354 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16355 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16356 @code{force} argument.
16357
16358 @item directory-files
16359 This should be a function with the same interface as
16360 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16361 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16362 parameter is optional; the default is
16363 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16364 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16365 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16366 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16367 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16368 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16369
16370 @item get-new-mail
16371 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16372 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16373 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16374 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16375 value is @code{nil}.
16376
16377 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16378 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16379 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16380 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16381 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16382 @end table
16383
16384 @node nnmaildir Group Parameters
16385 @subsubsection Group parameters
16386
16387 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16388 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16389 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16390 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16391 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16392 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16393 another back end.
16394
16395 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16396 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16397 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16398 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16399 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16400 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16401 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16402 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16403 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16404
16405 @table @code
16406 @item expire-age
16407 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16408 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16409 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16410 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16411 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16412 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16413 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16414 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16415 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16416 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16417 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16418 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16419 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16420
16421 @item expire-group
16422 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16423 @example
16424 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16425 @end example
16426 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16427 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16428 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16429 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16430 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16431 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16432 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16433 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16434 article. So that form can refer to
16435 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16436 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16437 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16438 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16439
16440 @item read-only
16441 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16442 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16443 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16444 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16445 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16446 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16447 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16448 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16449 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16450 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16451 contain extra copies of the articles.
16452
16453 @item directory-files
16454 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16455 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16456 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16457 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16458
16459 @item distrust-Lines:
16460 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16461 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16462 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16463
16464 @item always-marks
16465 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16466 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16467 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16468 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16469 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16470 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16471
16472 @item never-marks
16473 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16474 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16475 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16476 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16477 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16478 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16479 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16480
16481 @item nov-cache-size
16482 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16483 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16484 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16485 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16486 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16487 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16488 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16489 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16490 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16491 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16492 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16493 @end table
16494
16495 @node Article Identification
16496 @subsubsection Article identification
16497 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16498 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16499 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16500 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16501 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16502 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16503 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16504 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16505 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16506 request the article in the summary buffer.
16507
16508 @node NOV Data
16509 @subsubsection NOV data
16510 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16511 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16512 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16513 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16514 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16515 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16516 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16517 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16518 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16519 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16520 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16521
16522 @node Article Marks
16523 @subsubsection Article marks
16524 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16525 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16526 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16527 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16528 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16529 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16530 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16531 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16532
16533 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16534 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16535 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16536 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16537 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16538 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16539 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16540 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16541 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16542
16543
16544 @node Mail Folders
16545 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16546 @cindex nnfolder
16547 @cindex mbox folders
16548 @cindex mail folders
16549
16550 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16551 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16552 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16553 numbers and arrival dates.
16554
16555 Virtual server settings:
16556
16557 @table @code
16558 @item nnfolder-directory
16559 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16560 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16561 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16562 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16563
16564 @item nnfolder-active-file
16565 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16566 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16567
16568 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16569 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16570 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16571 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16572
16573 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16574 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16575 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16576 default is @code{t}
16577
16578 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16579 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16580 @cindex backup files
16581 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16582 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16583 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16584 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16585
16586 @lisp
16587 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16588 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16589
16590 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16591 @end lisp
16592
16593 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16594 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16595 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16596 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16597 extract some information from it before removing it.
16598
16599 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16600 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16601 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16602 default is @code{nil}.
16603
16604 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16605 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16606 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16607
16608 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16609 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16610 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16611 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16612
16613 @end table
16614
16615
16616 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16617 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16618 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16619 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16620 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16621 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16622 though.
16623
16624 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16625 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16626
16627 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16628 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16629 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16630 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16631 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16632
16633 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16634 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16635 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16636 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16637 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16638 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16639 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16640 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16641 via NFS).
16642
16643 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16644 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16645 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16646 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16647
16648 @table @code
16649 @item nnmbox
16650
16651 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16652 format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16653 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16654 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16655 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16656 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16657 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16658 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16659 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16660 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16661 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16662 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16663 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16664 what's where.
16665
16666 @item nnbabyl
16667
16668 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16669 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16670 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16671 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16672 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16673 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16674 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16675 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16676 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16677 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16678 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16679 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16680 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16681 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16682 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16683
16684 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16685 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16686 look at your mail.
16687
16688 @item nnml
16689
16690 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16691 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16692 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16693 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16694 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16695 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16696 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16697 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16698 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16699 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16700 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16701 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16702 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16703 provided by the active file and overviews.
16704
16705 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16706 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16707 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16708 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16709 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16710 wins big.
16711
16712 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16713 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16714 tiny files.
16715
16716 @item nnmh
16717
16718 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16719 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16720 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16721 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16722 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16723 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16724 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16725
16726 @item nnfolder
16727
16728 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16729 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16730 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16731 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16732 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16733 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16734 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16735 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16736 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16737
16738 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16739 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16740 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16741 friendly mail back end all over.
16742
16743 @item nnmaildir
16744
16745 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16746 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16747 mail back ends.
16748
16749 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16750 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16751 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16752 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16753 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16754 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16755 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16756 file system.
16757
16758 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16759 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16760 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16761 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16762 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16763 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16764 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16765 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16766 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16767 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16768 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16769
16770 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16771 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16772 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16773 else, and still have your marks.
16774
16775 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16776 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16777 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16778 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16779 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16780 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16781 removed in the future.
16782
16783 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16784 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16785 on your file system.
16786
16787 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16788 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16789
16790 @end table
16791
16792
16793 @node Browsing the Web
16794 @section Browsing the Web
16795 @cindex web
16796 @cindex browsing the web
16797 @cindex www
16798 @cindex http
16799
16800 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16801 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16802 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16803 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16804 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16805 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16806 even know what a news group is.
16807
16808 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16809 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16810 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16811 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16812 you mad in the end.
16813
16814 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16815 to do it instead?
16816
16817 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16818 interfaces to these sources.
16819
16820 @menu
16821 * Archiving Mail::
16822 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16823 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16824 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16825 @end menu
16826
16827 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16828 alternatives to work.
16829
16830 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16831 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16832 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16833 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16834 though, you should be ok.
16835
16836 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16837 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16838 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16839 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16840 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16841
16842 @node Archiving Mail
16843 @subsection Archiving Mail
16844 @cindex archiving mail
16845 @cindex backup of mail
16846
16847 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16848 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16849 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16850 marks is fairly simple.
16851
16852 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16853 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16854 though.)
16855
16856 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16857 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16858 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16859 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16860 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16861 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16862 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16863 before you restore the data.
16864
16865 @node Web Searches
16866 @subsection Web Searches
16867 @cindex nnweb
16868 @cindex Google
16869 @cindex dejanews
16870 @cindex gmane
16871 @cindex Usenet searches
16872 @cindex searching the Usenet
16873
16874 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16875 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16876 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16877 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16878 searches without having to use a browser.
16879
16880 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16881 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16882 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16883 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16884 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16885
16886 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16887 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16888 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16889 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16890 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16891 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16892 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16893 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16894 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16895 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16896 group as read.
16897
16898 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16899 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16900 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16901 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16902 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16903 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16904
16905 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16906 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16907 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16908
16909 Virtual server variables:
16910
16911 @table @code
16912 @item nnweb-type
16913 @vindex nnweb-type
16914 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16915 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16916 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16917
16918 @item nnweb-search
16919 @vindex nnweb-search
16920 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16921
16922 @item nnweb-max-hits
16923 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16924 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16925 999.
16926
16927 @item nnweb-type-definition
16928 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16929 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16930 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16931 present:
16932
16933 @table @code
16934 @item article
16935 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16936 understands.
16937
16938 @item map
16939 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16940
16941 @item search
16942 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16943
16944 @item address
16945 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16946 to.
16947
16948 @item id
16949 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16950 @end table
16951
16952 @end table
16953
16954
16955 @node RSS
16956 @subsection RSS
16957 @cindex nnrss
16958 @cindex RSS
16959
16960 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16961 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16962 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16963 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16964 changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16965
16966 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16967 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16968
16969 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16970 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16971 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16972 group names.
16973
16974 @kindex G R (Group)
16975 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16976 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16977 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16978 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16979
16980 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16981 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16982 subscribe to groups.
16983
16984 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16985 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16986 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16987 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16988 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
16989 information.
16990
16991 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16992 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16993 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16994
16995 @cindex OPML
16996 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16997 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16998 Markup Language).
16999
17000 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
17001 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17002 file.
17003 @end defun
17004
17005 @defun nnrss-opml-export
17006 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17007 @acronym{OPML} format.
17008 @end defun
17009
17010 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
17011
17012 @table @code
17013 @item nnrss-directory
17014 @vindex nnrss-directory
17015 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17016 @file{~/News/rss/}.
17017
17018 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
17019 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17020 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17021 data files. The default is the value of
17022 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17023 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17024
17025 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17026 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17027 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17028 e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17029 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17030 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17031 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17032 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
17033
17034 @item nnrss-use-local
17035 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17036 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17037 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17038 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17039 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17040 download script using @command{wget}.
17041 @end table
17042
17043 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17044 the summary buffer.
17045
17046 @lisp
17047 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17048 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17049
17050 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17051 (let ((descr
17052 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17053 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17054 @end lisp
17055
17056 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17057 summary buffer.
17058
17059 @lisp
17060 (require 'browse-url)
17061
17062 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17063 (interactive "p")
17064 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17065 (mail-header-extra
17066 (gnus-data-header
17067 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17068 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17069 (if url
17070 (progn
17071 (browse-url (cdr url))
17072 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17073 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17074
17075 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17076 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17077 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17078 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17079 @end lisp
17080
17081 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17082 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17083 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17084 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17085 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17086 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17087 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17088 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17089 @code{nnrss} groups:
17090
17091 @lisp
17092 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17093 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17094 '(add-to-list
17095 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17096 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17097 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17098
17099 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17100 (add-to-list
17101 'gnus-parameters
17102 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17103 @end lisp
17104
17105
17106 @node Customizing W3
17107 @subsection Customizing W3
17108 @cindex W3
17109 @cindex html
17110 @cindex url
17111 @cindex Netscape
17112
17113 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17114 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17115 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17116 users.
17117
17118 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17119 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17120 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17121
17122 @lisp
17123 (eval-after-load "w3"
17124 '(progn
17125 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17126 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17127 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17128 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17129 (browse-url url)
17130 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17131 @end lisp
17132
17133 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17134 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17135 follow the link.
17136
17137
17138 @node Other Sources
17139 @section Other Sources
17140
17141 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17142 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17143 newsgroups.
17144
17145 @menu
17146 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17147 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17148 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17149 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17150 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17151 @end menu
17152
17153
17154 @node Directory Groups
17155 @subsection Directory Groups
17156 @cindex nndir
17157 @cindex directory groups
17158
17159 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17160 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17161 names, of course.
17162
17163 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17164 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17165 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17166 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17167
17168 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17169 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17170 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17171 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17172 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17173
17174 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17175
17176 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17177 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17178 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17179 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17180
17181
17182 @node Anything Groups
17183 @subsection Anything Groups
17184 @cindex nneething
17185
17186 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17187 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17188 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17189 true.
17190
17191 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17192 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17193 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17194 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17195 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17196 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17197 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17198 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
17199 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17200 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17201 elements.
17202
17203 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17204 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17205 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17206 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17207
17208 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17209 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17210 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17211 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17212
17213 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17214 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17215 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17216 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17217 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17218 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17219 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17220 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17221
17222 Some variables:
17223
17224 @table @code
17225 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17226 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17227 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17228 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17229
17230 @item nneething-exclude-files
17231 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17232 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17233 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17234
17235 @item nneething-include-files
17236 @vindex nneething-include-files
17237 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17238 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17239
17240 @item nneething-map-file
17241 @vindex nneething-map-file
17242 Name of the map files.
17243 @end table
17244
17245
17246 @node Document Groups
17247 @subsection Document Groups
17248 @cindex nndoc
17249 @cindex documentation group
17250 @cindex help group
17251
17252 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17253 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17254
17255 @table @code
17256 @cindex Babyl
17257 @item babyl
17258 The Babyl format.
17259
17260 @cindex mbox
17261 @cindex Unix mbox
17262 @item mbox
17263 The standard Unix mbox file.
17264
17265 @cindex MMDF mail box
17266 @item mmdf
17267 The MMDF mail box format.
17268
17269 @item news
17270 Several news articles appended into a file.
17271
17272 @cindex rnews batch files
17273 @item rnews
17274 The rnews batch transport format.
17275
17276 @item nsmail
17277 Netscape mail boxes.
17278
17279 @item mime-parts
17280 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17281
17282 @item standard-digest
17283 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17284
17285 @item mime-digest
17286 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17287
17288 @item lanl-gov-announce
17289 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17290
17291 @cindex git commit messages
17292 @item git
17293 @code{git} commit messages.
17294
17295 @cindex forwarded messages
17296 @item rfc822-forward
17297 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17298
17299 @item outlook
17300 The Outlook mail box.
17301
17302 @item oe-dbx
17303 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17304
17305 @item exim-bounce
17306 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17307
17308 @item forward
17309 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17310
17311 @item rfc934
17312 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17313
17314 @item mailman
17315 A mailman digest.
17316
17317 @item clari-briefs
17318 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17319
17320 @item slack-digest
17321 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17322
17323 @item mail-in-mail
17324 The last resort.
17325 @end table
17326
17327 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17328 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17329 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17330 file is.
17331
17332 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17333 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17334 group. And that's it.
17335
17336 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17337 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17338 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17339 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17340 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17341 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17342 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17343 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17344 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17345 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17346
17347 Virtual server variables:
17348
17349 @table @code
17350 @item nndoc-article-type
17351 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17352 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17353 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17354 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17355 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17356 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17357
17358 @item nndoc-post-type
17359 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17360 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17361 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17362 and @code{news}.
17363 @end table
17364
17365 @menu
17366 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17367 @end menu
17368
17369
17370 @node Document Server Internals
17371 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17372
17373 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17374 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17375 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17376 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17377
17378 First, here's an example document type definition:
17379
17380 @example
17381 (mmdf
17382 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17383 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17384 @end example
17385
17386 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17387 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17388 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17389 types can be defined with very few settings:
17390
17391 @table @code
17392 @item first-article
17393 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17394 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17395 totally ignored.
17396
17397 @item article-begin
17398 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17399 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17400 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17401 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17402
17403 @item article-begin-function
17404 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17405 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17406
17407 @item head-begin
17408 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17409 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17410 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17411
17412 @item head-begin-function
17413 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17414 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17415
17416 @item head-end
17417 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17418 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17419
17420 @item body-begin
17421 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17422 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17423 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17424
17425 @item body-begin-function
17426 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17427 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17428
17429 @item body-end
17430 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17431 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17432 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17433
17434 @item body-end-function
17435 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17436 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17437
17438 @item file-begin
17439 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17440 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17441
17442 @item file-end
17443 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17444 regexp will be totally ignored.
17445
17446 @end table
17447
17448 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17449 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17450 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17451 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17452 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17453
17454 @table @code
17455 @item prepare-body-function
17456 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17457 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17458 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17459
17460 @item article-transform-function
17461 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17462 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17463 body of the article.
17464
17465 @item generate-head-function
17466 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17467 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17468 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17469 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17470
17471 @item generate-article-function
17472 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17473 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17474 parameter when requesting all articles.
17475
17476 @item dissection-function
17477 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17478 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17479 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17480 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17481 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17482 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17483
17484 @end table
17485
17486 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17487 digests:
17488
17489 @example
17490 (standard-digest
17491 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17492 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17493 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17494 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17495 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17496 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17497 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17498 (subtype digest guess))
17499 @end example
17500
17501 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17502 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17503 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17504 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17505 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17506
17507 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17508 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17509 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17510 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17511 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17512 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17513 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17514 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17515 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17516 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17517 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17518 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17519
17520
17521 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17522 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17523 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17524 @cindex gateways
17525
17526 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17527 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17528 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17529
17530 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17531 used to post with.
17532
17533 Server variables:
17534
17535 @table @code
17536 @item nngateway-address
17537 @vindex nngateway-address
17538 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17539
17540 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17541 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17542 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17543 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17544 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17545 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17546 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17547 gateway address.
17548
17549 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17550 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17551 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17552
17553 @example
17554 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17555 @end example
17556
17557 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17558
17559 @example
17560 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17561 @end example
17562
17563 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17564
17565 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17566 @table @code
17567
17568 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17569 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17570 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17571
17572 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17573
17574 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17575 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17576 @code{nngateway-address}.
17577 @end table
17578
17579 @end table
17580
17581 Here's an example:
17582
17583 @lisp
17584 (setq gnus-post-method
17585 '(nngateway
17586 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17587 (nngateway-header-transformation
17588 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17589 @end lisp
17590
17591 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17592
17593 @lisp
17594 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17595 @end lisp
17596
17597
17598 @node The Empty Backend
17599 @subsection The Empty Backend
17600 @cindex nnnil
17601
17602 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17603 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17604 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17605 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17606
17607 @lisp
17608 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17609 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17610 '((nnimap "foo")
17611 (nnml "")))
17612 @end lisp
17613
17614
17615 @node Combined Groups
17616 @section Combined Groups
17617
17618 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17619 groups.
17620
17621 @menu
17622 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17623 @end menu
17624
17625
17626 @node Virtual Groups
17627 @subsection Virtual Groups
17628 @cindex nnvirtual
17629 @cindex virtual groups
17630 @cindex merging groups
17631
17632 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17633 other groups.
17634
17635 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17636 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17637 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17638
17639 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17640 regexp to match component groups.
17641
17642 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17643 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17644 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17645 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17646 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17647 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17648 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17649 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17650
17651 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17652 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17653
17654 @lisp
17655 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17656 @end lisp
17657
17658 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17659 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17660
17661 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17662 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17663 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17664 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17665
17666 @example
17667 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17668 @end example
17669
17670 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17671 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17672 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17673
17674 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17675 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17676 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17677 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17678 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17679
17680 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17681 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17682 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17683
17684 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17685 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17686 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17687 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17688 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17689 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17690 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17691 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17692 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17693 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17694 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17695
17696 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17697 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17698 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17699 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17700 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17701 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17702 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17703
17704 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17705 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17706
17707 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17708 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17709 inherited.
17710
17711
17712 @node Email Based Diary
17713 @section Email Based Diary
17714 @cindex diary
17715 @cindex email based diary
17716 @cindex calendar
17717
17718 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17719 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17720 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17721 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17722 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17723 namely, as event reminders.
17724
17725 Here is a typical scenario:
17726
17727 @itemize @bullet
17728 @item
17729 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17730 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17731 @item
17732 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17733 @item
17734 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17735 @item
17736 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17737 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17738 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17739 @item
17740 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17741 of the night you're gonna have.
17742 @item
17743 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17744 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17745 @end itemize
17746
17747 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17748 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17749 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17750 explained in the sections below.
17751
17752 @menu
17753 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17754 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17755 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17756 @end menu
17757
17758
17759 @node The NNDiary Back End
17760 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17761 @cindex nndiary
17762 @cindex the nndiary back end
17763
17764 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17765 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17766 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17767 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17768 directory per group.
17769
17770 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17771 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17772 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17773 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17774
17775 @menu
17776 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17777 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17778 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17779 @end menu
17780
17781 @node Diary Messages
17782 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17783 @cindex nndiary messages
17784 @cindex nndiary mails
17785
17786 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17787 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17788 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17789 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17790 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17791 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17792 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17793
17794 @itemize @bullet
17795 @item
17796 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17797 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17798 (separated by a comma).
17799 @item
17800 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17801 @item
17802 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17803 @item
17804 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17805 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17806 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17807 @item
17808 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17809 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17810 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17811 @item
17812 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17813 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17814 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17815 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17816 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17817 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17818 @end itemize
17819
17820 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17821 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17822 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17823 what to do then):
17824
17825 @example
17826 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17827 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17828 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17829 X-Diary-Month: *
17830 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17831 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17832 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17833 @end example
17834
17835 @node Running NNDiary
17836 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17837 @cindex running nndiary
17838 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17839
17840 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17841 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17842 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17843 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17844 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17845 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17846
17847 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17848 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17849 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17850 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17851 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17852 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17853 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17854 mode.
17855
17856 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17857 things to do:
17858
17859 @itemize @bullet
17860 @item
17861 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17862 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17863
17864 @lisp
17865 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17866 @end lisp
17867 @item
17868 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17869 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17870 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17871 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17872 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17873
17874 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17875 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17876
17877 @example
17878 :0 HD :
17879 * ^X-Diary
17880 .nndiary
17881 @end example
17882 @end itemize
17883
17884 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17885 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17886
17887 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17888 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17889 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17890 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17891 @end defvar
17892
17893 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17894 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17895 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17896 @end defvar
17897
17898 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17899 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17900 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17901
17902 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17903 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17904 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17905 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17906 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17907
17908 @node Customizing NNDiary
17909 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17910 @cindex customizing nndiary
17911 @cindex nndiary customization
17912
17913 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17914 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17915 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17916 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17917
17918 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17919 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17920 appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17921 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17922 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17923 mail.
17924 @end defvar
17925
17926 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17927 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17928 default).
17929 @end defvar
17930
17931
17932 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17933 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17934 @cindex gnus-diary
17935 @cindex the gnus diary library
17936
17937 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17938 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17939 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17940 useful things for you.
17941
17942 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17943
17944 @lisp
17945 (require 'gnus-diary)
17946 @end lisp
17947
17948 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17949 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17950 (sorry if you used them before).
17951
17952
17953 @menu
17954 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17955 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17956 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17957 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17958 @end menu
17959
17960 @node Diary Summary Line Format
17961 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17962 @cindex diary summary buffer line
17963 @cindex diary summary line format
17964
17965 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17966 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17967 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17968 see the event's date.
17969
17970 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17971 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
17972 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
17973 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
17974 next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
17975
17976 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17977 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17978 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
17979
17980 @example
17981 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
17982 @end example
17983
17984 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
17985 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
17986
17987 @lisp
17988 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
17989 @end lisp
17990
17991 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
17992 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
17993 with the following user options:
17994
17995 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
17996 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
17997 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
17998 diary groups'parameters.
17999 @end defvar
18000
18001 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18002 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18003 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18004 @end defvar
18005
18006 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18007 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18008 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18009 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18010 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18011 @end defvar
18012
18013 @node Diary Articles Sorting
18014 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18015 @cindex diary articles sorting
18016 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
18017 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18018 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18019 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18020
18021 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18022 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18023 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18024 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18025 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18026
18027 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18028 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18029 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18030 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18031 Parameters}).
18032
18033 @node Diary Headers Generation
18034 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18035 @cindex diary headers generation
18036 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18037
18038 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18039 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18040 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18041 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18042 needed.
18043
18044 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18045 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18046 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18047 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18048 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18049
18050 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18051 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18052 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18053 instance.
18054
18055 @node Diary Group Parameters
18056 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18057 @cindex diary group parameters
18058
18059 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18060 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18061 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18062 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18063 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18064 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18065 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18066 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18067
18068 @node Sending or Not Sending
18069 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18070
18071 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18072 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18073
18074 @itemize @bullet
18075 @item
18076 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18077 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18078 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18079 sending the diary message to them as well.
18080 @item
18081 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18082 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18083 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18084 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18085 @end itemize
18086
18087 @node Gnus Unplugged
18088 @section Gnus Unplugged
18089 @cindex offline
18090 @cindex unplugged
18091 @cindex agent
18092 @cindex Gnus agent
18093 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18094
18095 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18096 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18097 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18098 read news. Believe it or not.
18099
18100 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18101 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18102 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18103 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18104 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18105
18106 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18107 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18108 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18109 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18110 reading news on a machine.
18111
18112 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18113 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18114 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18115
18116 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18117
18118 @menu
18119 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18120 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18121 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18122 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18123 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18124 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18125 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18126 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18127 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18128 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18129 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18130 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18131 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18132 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18133 @end menu
18134
18135
18136 @node Agent Basics
18137 @subsection Agent Basics
18138
18139 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18140
18141 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18142 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18143 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18144 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18145
18146 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18147 connected to the net continuously.
18148
18149 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18150 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18151
18152 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18153 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18154 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18155 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18156 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18157
18158 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18159 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18160 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18161 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18162 they're kinda like plugged always).
18163
18164 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18165 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18166 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18167 the culprit.
18168
18169 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18170 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18171 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18172 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18173 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18174
18175 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18176
18177 @itemize @bullet
18178
18179 @item
18180 @findex gnus-unplugged
18181 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18182 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18183 already fetched while in this mode.
18184
18185 @item
18186 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18187 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18188 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18189 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18190 Source Specifiers}).
18191
18192 @item
18193 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18194 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18195 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18196 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18197 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18198
18199 @item
18200 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18201 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18202 then you read the news offline.
18203
18204 @item
18205 And then you go to step 2.
18206 @end itemize
18207
18208 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18209 the Agent.
18210
18211 @itemize @bullet
18212
18213 @item
18214 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18215 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18216 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18217 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18218 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18219 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18220 no servers are agentized.
18221
18222 @item
18223 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18224 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18225 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18226 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18227
18228 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18229 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18230 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18231 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18232 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18233 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18234 configure them.
18235
18236 @item
18237 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18238 @end itemize
18239
18240
18241 @node Agent Categories
18242 @subsection Agent Categories
18243
18244 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18245 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18246 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18247 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18248 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18249 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18250 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18251
18252 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18253 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18254 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18255 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18256 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18257
18258 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18259 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18260 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18261 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18262 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18263 sink.
18264
18265 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18266 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18267 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18268 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18269 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18270 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18271 your settings.
18272
18273 @menu
18274 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18275 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18276 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18277 @end menu
18278
18279
18280 @node Category Syntax
18281 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18282
18283 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18284 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18285 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18286 listed below.
18287
18288 @cindex Agent Parameters
18289 @table @code
18290 @item agent-groups
18291 The list of groups that are in this category.
18292
18293 @item agent-predicate
18294 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18295 are eligible for downloading; and
18296
18297 @item agent-score
18298 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18299 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18300 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18301
18302 @item agent-enable-expiration
18303 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18304 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18305 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18306 only groups that should not be expired.
18307
18308 @item agent-days-until-old
18309 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18310 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18311
18312 @item agent-low-score
18313 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18314
18315 @item agent-high-score
18316 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18317
18318 @item agent-short-article
18319 an integer that overrides the value of
18320 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18321
18322 @item agent-long-article
18323 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18324
18325 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18326 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18327 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18328 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18329 undownloaded faces.
18330 @end table
18331
18332 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18333 created.
18334
18335 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18336 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18337 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18338 category.
18339
18340 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18341 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18342 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18343 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18344
18345 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18346 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18347 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18348
18349 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18350 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18351 operators sprinkled in between.
18352
18353 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18354
18355 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18356 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18357
18358 @lisp
18359 short
18360 @end lisp
18361
18362 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18363 short (for some value of ``short'').
18364
18365 Here's a more complex predicate:
18366
18367 @lisp
18368 (or high
18369 (and
18370 (not low)
18371 (not long)))
18372 @end lisp
18373
18374 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18375 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18376 drift.
18377
18378 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18379 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18380 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18381
18382 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18383 you want to do, you can write your own.
18384
18385 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18386 bound to the value determined by calling
18387 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18388 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18389 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18390 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18391 predicate to individual groups.
18392
18393 @table @code
18394 @item short
18395 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18396 lines; default 100.
18397
18398 @item long
18399 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18400 lines; default 200.
18401
18402 @item low
18403 True if the article has a download score less than
18404 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18405
18406 @item high
18407 True if the article has a download score greater than
18408 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18409
18410 @item spam
18411 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18412 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18413 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18414
18415 @item true
18416 Always true.
18417
18418 @item false
18419 Always false.
18420 @end table
18421
18422 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18423 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18424 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18425 useful values.
18426
18427 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18428 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
18429 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18430 something along the lines of the following:
18431
18432 @lisp
18433 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18434 "Say whether an article is old."
18435 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18436 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18437 @end lisp
18438
18439 with the predicate then defined as:
18440
18441 @lisp
18442 (not my-article-old-p)
18443 @end lisp
18444
18445 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18446 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18447 wherever.
18448
18449 @lisp
18450 (require 'gnus-agent)
18451 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18452 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18453 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18454 @end lisp
18455
18456 and simply specify your predicate as:
18457
18458 @lisp
18459 (not old)
18460 @end lisp
18461
18462 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18463 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18464 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18465 just don't give a damn.
18466
18467 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18468 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18469 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18470 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18471 parameters like so:
18472
18473 @lisp
18474 (agent-predicate . short)
18475 @end lisp
18476
18477 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18478 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18479 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18480
18481 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18482
18483 @lisp
18484 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18485 @end lisp
18486
18487 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18488 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18489 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18490
18491
18492 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18493 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18494 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18495 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18496 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18497 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18498
18499 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18500 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18501 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18502 if it's to be specific to that group.
18503
18504 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18505 three forms:
18506
18507 @enumerate
18508 @item
18509 Score rule
18510
18511 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18512 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18513
18514 example:
18515
18516 @itemize @bullet
18517 @item
18518 Category specification
18519
18520 @lisp
18521 (("from"
18522 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18523 ("lines"
18524 (500 -100 nil <)))
18525 @end lisp
18526
18527 @item
18528 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18529
18530 @lisp
18531 (agent-score ("from"
18532 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18533 ("lines"
18534 (500 -100 nil <)))
18535 @end lisp
18536
18537 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18538 @end itemize
18539
18540 @item
18541 Agent score file
18542
18543 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18544 keywords stated above.
18545
18546 example:
18547
18548 @itemize @bullet
18549 @item
18550 Category specification
18551
18552 @lisp
18553 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18554 @end lisp
18555
18556 or perhaps
18557
18558 @lisp
18559 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18560 @end lisp
18561
18562 @item
18563 Group Parameter specification
18564
18565 @lisp
18566 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18567 @end lisp
18568
18569 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18570 about parenthesis?
18571 @end itemize
18572
18573 @item
18574 Use @code{normal} score files
18575
18576 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18577 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18578 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18579 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18580
18581 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18582 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18583 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18584 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18585
18586 @itemize @bullet
18587 @item
18588 Category Specification
18589
18590 @lisp
18591 file
18592 @end lisp
18593
18594 @item
18595 Group Parameter specification
18596
18597 @lisp
18598 (agent-score . file)
18599 @end lisp
18600 @end itemize
18601 @end enumerate
18602
18603 @node Category Buffer
18604 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18605
18606 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18607 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18608 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18609
18610 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18611
18612 @table @kbd
18613 @item q
18614 @kindex q (Category)
18615 @findex gnus-category-exit
18616 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18617
18618 @item e
18619 @kindex e (Category)
18620 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18621 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18622 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18623
18624 @item k
18625 @kindex k (Category)
18626 @findex gnus-category-kill
18627 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18628
18629 @item c
18630 @kindex c (Category)
18631 @findex gnus-category-copy
18632 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18633
18634 @item a
18635 @kindex a (Category)
18636 @findex gnus-category-add
18637 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18638
18639 @item p
18640 @kindex p (Category)
18641 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18642 Edit the predicate of the current category
18643 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18644
18645 @item g
18646 @kindex g (Category)
18647 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18648 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18649 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18650
18651 @item s
18652 @kindex s (Category)
18653 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18654 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18655 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18656
18657 @item l
18658 @kindex l (Category)
18659 @findex gnus-category-list
18660 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18661 @end table
18662
18663
18664 @node Category Variables
18665 @subsubsection Category Variables
18666
18667 @table @code
18668 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18669 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18670 Hook run in category buffers.
18671
18672 @item gnus-category-line-format
18673 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18674 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18675 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18676
18677 @table @samp
18678 @item c
18679 The name of the category.
18680
18681 @item g
18682 The number of groups in the category.
18683 @end table
18684
18685 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18686 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18687 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18688
18689 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18690 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18691 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18692
18693 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18694 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18695 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18696
18697 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18698 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18699 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18700 0.
18701
18702 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18703 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18704 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18705 0.
18706
18707 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18708 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18709 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18710 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18711 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18712 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18713 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18714 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18715 read.
18716 Default 7.
18717
18718 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18719 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18720 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18721 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18722 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18723 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18724 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18725
18726 @end table
18727
18728
18729 @node Agent Commands
18730 @subsection Agent Commands
18731 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18732 @kindex J j (Agent)
18733
18734 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18735 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18736 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18737
18738
18739 @menu
18740 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18741 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18742 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18743 @end menu
18744
18745
18746
18747
18748 @node Group Agent Commands
18749 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18750
18751 @table @kbd
18752 @item J u
18753 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18754 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18755 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18756 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18757
18758 @item J c
18759 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18760 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18761 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18762
18763 @item J s
18764 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18765 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18766 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18767 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18768
18769 @item J S
18770 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18771 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18772 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18773 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18774
18775 @item J a
18776 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18777 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18778 Add the current group to an Agent category
18779 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18780 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18781
18782 @item J r
18783 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18784 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18785 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18786 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18787 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18788
18789 @item J Y
18790 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18791 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18792 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18793
18794
18795 @end table
18796
18797
18798 @node Summary Agent Commands
18799 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18800
18801 @table @kbd
18802 @item J #
18803 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18804 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18805 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18806
18807 @item J M-#
18808 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18809 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18810 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18811 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18812
18813 @cindex %
18814 @item @@
18815 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18816 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18817 Toggle whether to download the article
18818 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18819 default.
18820
18821 @item J c
18822 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18823 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18824 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18825
18826 @item J S
18827 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18828 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18829 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18830 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18831
18832 @item J s
18833 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18834 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18835 Download all processable articles in this group.
18836 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18837
18838 @item J u
18839 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18840 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18841 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18842 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18843
18844 @end table
18845
18846
18847 @node Server Agent Commands
18848 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18849
18850 @table @kbd
18851 @item J a
18852 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18853 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18854 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18855 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18856
18857 @item J r
18858 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18859 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18860 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18861 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18862
18863 @end table
18864
18865
18866 @node Agent Visuals
18867 @subsection Agent Visuals
18868
18869 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18870 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18871 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18872 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18873 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18874 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18875 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18876 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18877 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18878 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18879
18880 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18881 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18882 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18883 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18884 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18885 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18886 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18887 articles will be available when unplugged.
18888
18889 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18890 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18891 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18892 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18893 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18894 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18895 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18896 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18897
18898 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18899 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18900 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18901 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18902 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18903 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18904 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18905 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18906 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18907
18908 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18909 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18910 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18911 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18912 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18913 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18914 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18915 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18916 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18917 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18918
18919 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18920 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18921 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18922 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18923 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18924 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18925
18926 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18927 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18928 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18929 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18930 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18931 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18932 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18933 expiring'' articles.
18934
18935 @node Agent as Cache
18936 @subsection Agent as Cache
18937
18938 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18939 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18940 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18941 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18942 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18943 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18944 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18945 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18946 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18947
18948 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18949 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18950 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18951 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18952 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18953
18954 @node Agent Expiry
18955 @subsection Agent Expiry
18956
18957 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18958 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18959 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18960 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18961 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18962 @cindex agent expiry
18963 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18964 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18965
18966 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18967 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18968 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18969 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18970 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18971 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18972 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18973 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18974
18975 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18976 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
18977
18978 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18979 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18980
18981 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18982 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18983 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18984 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18985 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18986 be kept indefinitely.
18987
18988 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18989 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18990 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18991 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18992
18993 @node Agent Regeneration
18994 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18995
18996 @cindex agent regeneration
18997 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18998 @cindex regeneration
18999
19000 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19001 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19002 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19003 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19004 internal inconsistencies.
19005
19006 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19007 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19008 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19009 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19010 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19011 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19012
19013 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19014 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19015 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19016 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19017 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19018 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19019
19020 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19021 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19022 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19023 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19024 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19025 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19026 agent as unread.
19027
19028 @node Agent and flags
19029 @subsection Agent and flags
19030
19031 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
19032 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc.)@: on the server. Sadly,
19033 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19034 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19035 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19036 to the flags in its own files.
19037
19038 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19039 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19040 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19041
19042 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19043 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19044 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19045 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19046 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19047 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19048
19049 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19050 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19051 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19052 in the group buffer.
19053
19054 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19055 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19056 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19057 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19058 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19059 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19060 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19061 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19062
19063 @node Agent and IMAP
19064 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19065
19066 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19067 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19068 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19069 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19070
19071 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19072 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19073
19074 @itemize @bullet
19075
19076 @item
19077 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19078
19079 @item
19080 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19081
19082 @end itemize
19083
19084 @node Outgoing Messages
19085 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19086
19087 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19088 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19089 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19090
19091 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19092 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19093 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19094
19095 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19096 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19097 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19098 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19099 mail at any time.
19100
19101 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19102 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19103 ask you to confirm your action (see
19104 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19105
19106 @node Agent Variables
19107 @subsection Agent Variables
19108
19109 @table @code
19110 @item gnus-agent
19111 @vindex gnus-agent
19112 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19113 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19114 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19115 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19116
19117 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19118 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19119
19120
19121 @item gnus-agent-directory
19122 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19123 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19124 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19125
19126 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19127 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19128 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19129 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19130 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19131 by default.
19132
19133 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19134 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19135 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19136
19137 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19138 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19139 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19140
19141 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19142 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19143 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19144
19145 @item gnus-agent-cache
19146 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19147 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19148 articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19149 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19150
19151 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19152 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19153 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19154 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19155 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19156 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19157 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19158 online status.
19159
19160 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19161 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19162 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19163 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19164 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19165 read. The default is @code{t}.
19166
19167 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19168 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19169 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19170 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19171 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19172 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19173 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19174
19175 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19176 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19177 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19178 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19179 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19180 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19181 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19182 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19183 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19184 over and over again.
19185
19186 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19187 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19188 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19189 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19190 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19191 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19192 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19193 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19194 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19195 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19196 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19197 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19198 see any cycling.
19199
19200 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19201 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19202 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19203 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19204 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19205 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19206 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19207 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19208 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19209
19210 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19211 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19212 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19213 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19214 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19215 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19216
19217 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19218 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19219 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19220 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19221 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19222
19223 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19224 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19225 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19226 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19227 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19228 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19229
19230 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19231 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19232 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19233 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19234 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19235
19236 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19237 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19238 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19239 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19240 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19241 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19242 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19243 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19244 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19245 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19246 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19247
19248 @end table
19249
19250
19251 @node Example Setup
19252 @subsection Example Setup
19253
19254 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19255 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19256 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19257
19258 @lisp
19259 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19260 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19261 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19262
19263 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19264 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19265 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19266
19267 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19268 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19269
19270 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19271 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19272 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19273 @end lisp
19274
19275 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19276 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19277 gnus}.
19278
19279 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19280 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19281 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19282 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19283 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19284 once.
19285
19286 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19287 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19288 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19289 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19290 back all the killed groups.)
19291
19292 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19293 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19294 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19295
19296
19297 @node Batching Agents
19298 @subsection Batching Agents
19299 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19300
19301 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19302 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19303 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19304
19305 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19306 following incantation:
19307
19308 @example
19309 #!/bin/sh
19310 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19311 @end example
19312
19313
19314 @node Agent Caveats
19315 @subsection Agent Caveats
19316
19317 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19318 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19319 may ask:
19320
19321 @table @dfn
19322 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19323
19324 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19325 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19326 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19327
19328 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19329 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19330
19331 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19332
19333 @end table
19334
19335 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19336 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19337 locally stored articles.
19338
19339
19340 @node Scoring
19341 @chapter Scoring
19342 @cindex scoring
19343
19344 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19345 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19346 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19347 attention!
19348
19349 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19350 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19351 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19352 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19353 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19354
19355 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19356 before generating the summary buffer.
19357
19358 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19359 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19360 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19361
19362 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19363 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19364 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19365 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19366
19367 @menu
19368 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19369 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19370 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19371 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19372 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19373 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19374 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19375 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19376 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19377 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19378 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19379 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19380 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19381 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19382 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19383 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19384 @end menu
19385
19386
19387 @node Summary Score Commands
19388 @section Summary Score Commands
19389 @cindex score commands
19390
19391 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19392 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19393 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19394 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19395 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19396
19397 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19398 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19399 some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19400 score file the current one.
19401
19402 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19403
19404 @table @kbd
19405
19406 @item V s
19407 @kindex V s (Summary)
19408 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19409 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19410
19411 @item V S
19412 @kindex V S (Summary)
19413 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19414 Display the score of the current article
19415 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19416
19417 @item V t
19418 @kindex V t (Summary)
19419 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19420 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19421 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19422 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19423 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19424 score file and edit it.
19425
19426 @item V w
19427 @kindex V w (Summary)
19428 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19429 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19430
19431 @item V R
19432 @kindex V R (Summary)
19433 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19434 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19435 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19436 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19437 effect you're having.
19438
19439 @item V c
19440 @kindex V c (Summary)
19441 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19442 Make a different score file the current
19443 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19444
19445 @item V e
19446 @kindex V e (Summary)
19447 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19448 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19449 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19450 File Editing}).
19451
19452 @item V f
19453 @kindex V f (Summary)
19454 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19455 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19456 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19457
19458 @item V F
19459 @kindex V F (Summary)
19460 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19461 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19462 after editing score files.
19463
19464 @item V C
19465 @kindex V C (Summary)
19466 @findex gnus-score-customize
19467 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19468 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19469
19470 @end table
19471
19472 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19473
19474 @table @kbd
19475
19476 @item V m
19477 @kindex V m (Summary)
19478 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19479 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19480 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19481
19482 @item V x
19483 @kindex V x (Summary)
19484 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19485 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19486 expunge all articles below this score
19487 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19488 @end table
19489
19490 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19491 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19492 them.)
19493
19494 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19495 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19496
19497 @enumerate
19498 @item
19499 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19500 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19501 @item
19502 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19503 keys are available:
19504 @table @kbd
19505
19506 @item a
19507 Score on the author name.
19508
19509 @item s
19510 Score on the subject line.
19511
19512 @item x
19513 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19514
19515 @item r
19516 Score on the @code{References} line.
19517
19518 @item d
19519 Score on the date.
19520
19521 @item l
19522 Score on the number of lines.
19523
19524 @item i
19525 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19526
19527 @item e
19528 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19529 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19530
19531 @item f
19532 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19533 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19534 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19535
19536 @item b
19537 Score on the body.
19538
19539 @item h
19540 Score on the head.
19541
19542 @item t
19543 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19544 files.)
19545
19546 @end table
19547
19548 @item
19549 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19550 what headers you are scoring on.
19551
19552 @table @code
19553
19554 @item strings
19555
19556 @table @kbd
19557
19558 @item e
19559 Exact matching.
19560
19561 @item s
19562 Substring matching.
19563
19564 @item f
19565 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19566
19567 @item r
19568 Regexp matching
19569 @end table
19570
19571 @item date
19572 @table @kbd
19573
19574 @item b
19575 Before date.
19576
19577 @item a
19578 After date.
19579
19580 @item n
19581 This date.
19582 @end table
19583
19584 @item number
19585 @table @kbd
19586
19587 @item <
19588 Less than number.
19589
19590 @item =
19591 Equal to number.
19592
19593 @item >
19594 Greater than number.
19595 @end table
19596 @end table
19597
19598 @item
19599 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19600 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19601 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19602 file.
19603 @table @kbd
19604
19605 @item t
19606 Temporary score entry.
19607
19608 @item p
19609 Permanent score entry.
19610
19611 @item i
19612 Immediately scoring.
19613 @end table
19614
19615 @item
19616 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19617 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19618 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19619
19620 @end enumerate
19621
19622 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19623 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19624 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19625 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19626
19627 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19628 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19629 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19630 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19631 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19632
19633 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19634 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19635 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19636 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19637 current score file.
19638
19639 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19640 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19641 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19642
19643
19644 @node Group Score Commands
19645 @section Group Score Commands
19646 @cindex group score commands
19647
19648 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19649
19650 @table @kbd
19651
19652 @item W e
19653 @kindex W e (Group)
19654 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19655 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19656 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19657
19658 @item W f
19659 @kindex W f (Group)
19660 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19661 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19662 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19663 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19664
19665 @end table
19666
19667 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19668
19669 @findex gnus-batch-score
19670 @cindex batch scoring
19671 @example
19672 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19673 @end example
19674
19675
19676 @node Score Variables
19677 @section Score Variables
19678 @cindex score variables
19679
19680 @table @code
19681
19682 @item gnus-use-scoring
19683 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19684 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19685 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19686
19687 @item gnus-kill-killed
19688 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19689 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19690 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19691 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19692 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19693 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19694 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19695
19696 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19697 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19698 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19699 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19700 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19701
19702 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19703 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19704 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19705 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19706
19707 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19708 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19709 @cindex score cache
19710 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19711 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19712 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19713 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19714 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19715 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19716 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19717 be cached.
19718
19719 @item gnus-save-score
19720 @vindex gnus-save-score
19721 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19722 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19723 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19724
19725 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19726 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19727 across group visits.
19728
19729 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19730 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19731 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19732 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19733 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19734 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19735 manually entered data.
19736
19737 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19738 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19739 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19740
19741 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19742 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19743 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19744 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19745 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19746 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19747
19748 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19749 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19750 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19751 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19752
19753 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19754 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19755 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19756 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19757
19758 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19759 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19760 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19761 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19762
19763 Predefined functions available are:
19764 @table @code
19765
19766 @item gnus-score-find-single
19767 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19768 Only apply the group's own score file.
19769
19770 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19771 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19772 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19773 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19774 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19775 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19776 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19777 then a regexp match is done.
19778
19779 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19780 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19781
19782 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19783 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19784 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19785 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19786
19787 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19788 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19789 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19790 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19791 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19792 server.
19793
19794 @end table
19795 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19796 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19797 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19798 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19799 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19800 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19801 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19802 Phu.
19803
19804 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19805 overall score file, you could use the value
19806 @example
19807 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19808 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19809 @end example
19810
19811 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19812 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19813 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19814 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19815 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19816
19817 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19818 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19819 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19820 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19821 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19822 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19823 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19824 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19825
19826 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19827 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19828 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19829
19830 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19831 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19832 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19833 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19834 threading---according to the current value of
19835 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19836 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19837 simplified in this manner.
19838
19839 @end table
19840
19841
19842 @node Score File Format
19843 @section Score File Format
19844 @cindex score file format
19845
19846 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19847 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19848 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19849
19850 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19851
19852 @lisp
19853 (("from"
19854 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19855 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19856 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19857 ("subject"
19858 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19859 ("xref"
19860 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19861 ("lines"
19862 (2 -100 nil <))
19863 (mark 0)
19864 (expunge -1000)
19865 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19866 (read-only nil)
19867 (orphan -10)
19868 (adapt t)
19869 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19870 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19871 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19872 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19873 (eval (ding)))
19874 @end lisp
19875
19876 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19877 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19878
19879 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19880 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19881 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19882
19883 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19884
19885 @table @code
19886
19887 @item STRING
19888 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19889 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19890 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19891 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19892 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19893 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19894 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19895 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19896 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19897 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19898 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19899 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19900 to articles that matches these score entries.
19901
19902 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19903 score entry has one to four elements.
19904 @enumerate
19905
19906 @item
19907 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19908 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19909 integer.
19910
19911 @item
19912 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19913 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19914 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19915 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19916 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19917 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19918
19919 @item
19920 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19921 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19922 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19923 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19924 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19925
19926 @item
19927 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19928 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19929 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19930 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19931 @table @dfn
19932
19933 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19934 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19935 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19936 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19937 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19938 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19939 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19940 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19941 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19942 instead, if you feel like.
19943
19944 @item Extra
19945 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19946 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19947 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19948 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19949 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19950 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19951 overviews:
19952
19953 @lisp
19954 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19955 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19956 @end lisp
19957
19958 @item Lines, Chars
19959 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19960 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19961
19962 These predicates are true if
19963
19964 @example
19965 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19966 @end example
19967
19968 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19969 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19970 following form:
19971
19972 @lisp
19973 (< header-value 4)
19974 @end lisp
19975
19976 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19977 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19978 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19979 it's not. I think.)
19980
19981 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19982 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19983 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19984 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19985
19986 @item Date
19987 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19988 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19989 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19990 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19991 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19992 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19993 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19994
19995 @cindex ISO8601
19996 @cindex date
19997 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19998 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19999 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20000 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20001 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20002 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20003 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20004 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20005 whole family, eh?)
20006
20007 @item Head, Body, All
20008 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc.)@:
20009 header uses.
20010
20011 @item Followup
20012 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20013 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20014 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20015 you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20016 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20017 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20018 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20019 files.)
20020
20021 @item Thread
20022 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20023 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20024 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20025 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20026 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20027 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20028 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20029 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20030 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20031 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20032 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20033 @end table
20034 @end enumerate
20035
20036 @cindex score file atoms
20037 @item mark
20038 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20039 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20040
20041 @item expunge
20042 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20043 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20044
20045 @item mark-and-expunge
20046 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20047 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20048 summary buffer.
20049
20050 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20051 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20052 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20053 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20054 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20055
20056 @item files
20057 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20058 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20059 this one was.
20060
20061 @item exclude-files
20062 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20063 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20064 other.
20065
20066 @item eval
20067 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20068 ignored when handling global score files.
20069
20070 @item read-only
20071 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20072 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20073 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20074 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20075
20076 @item orphan
20077 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20078 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20079 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20080 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20081
20082 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20083
20084 @example
20085 (orphan -500)
20086 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20087 @end example
20088
20089 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20090 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20091 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20092 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20093 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20094
20095 I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20096 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20097 scoring rules exist.
20098
20099 @item adapt
20100 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20101 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20102 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20103 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20104 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20105 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20106 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20107 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20108 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20109 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20110 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20111 it.
20112
20113 @item adapt-file
20114 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20115 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20116 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20117 file for a number of groups.
20118
20119 @item local
20120 @cindex local variables
20121 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20122 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20123 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20124 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20125 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20126 be evaluated.
20127 @end table
20128
20129
20130 @node Score File Editing
20131 @section Score File Editing
20132
20133 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20134 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20135 with a mode for that.
20136
20137 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20138 additional commands:
20139
20140 @table @kbd
20141
20142 @item C-c C-c
20143 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20144 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20145 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20146 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20147
20148 @item C-c C-d
20149 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20150 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20151 Insert the current date in numerical format
20152 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20153 you were wondering.
20154
20155 @item C-c C-p
20156 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20157 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20158 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20159 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20160 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20161 you.
20162
20163 @end table
20164
20165 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20166
20167 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20168 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20169
20170 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20171 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20172
20173
20174 @node Adaptive Scoring
20175 @section Adaptive Scoring
20176 @cindex adaptive scoring
20177
20178 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20179 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20180 stupidity, to be precise.
20181
20182 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20183 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20184 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20185 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20186 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20187 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20188 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20189 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20190 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20191
20192 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20193 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20194 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20195 might look something like this:
20196
20197 @lisp
20198 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20199 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20200 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20201 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20202 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20203 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20204 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20205 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20206 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20207 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20208 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20209 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20210 @end lisp
20211
20212 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20213 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20214 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20215 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20216 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20217 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20218 entries.
20219
20220 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20221 will be applied to each article.
20222
20223 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20224 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20225 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20226 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20227
20228 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20229 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20230 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20231 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20232
20233 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20234 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20235 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20236 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20237
20238 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20239 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20240 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20241 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20242 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20243 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20244
20245 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20246 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20247 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20248
20249 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20250 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20251 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20252
20253 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20254 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20255 let you use different rules in different groups.
20256
20257 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20258 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20259 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20260 is @file{ADAPT}.
20261
20262 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20263 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20264 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20265 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20266
20267 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20268 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20269 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20270 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20271 the length of the match is less than
20272 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20273 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20274 this problem.
20275
20276 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20277 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20278 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20279 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20280 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20281
20282 @lisp
20283 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20284 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20285 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20286 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20287 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20288 @end lisp
20289
20290 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20291 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20292 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20293 score with 30 points.
20294
20295 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20296 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20297 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20298 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20299 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20300
20301 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20302 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20303 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20304 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20305 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20306
20307 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20308 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20309 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20310 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20311
20312 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20313 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20314 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20315 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20316
20317 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20318 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20319 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20320 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20321 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20322
20323 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20324 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20325 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20326
20327 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20328 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20329 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20330 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20331
20332
20333 @node Home Score File
20334 @section Home Score File
20335
20336 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20337 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20338 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20339 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20340
20341 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20342 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20343 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20344
20345 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20346 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20347 be:
20348
20349 @enumerate
20350 @item
20351 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20352 groups.
20353
20354 @item
20355 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20356 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20357 parameter.
20358
20359 @item
20360 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20361
20362 @enumerate
20363 @item
20364 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20365 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20366
20367 @item
20368 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20369 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20370 name of the group as the parameter.
20371
20372 @item
20373 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20374 @end enumerate
20375
20376 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20377 for matches.
20378
20379 @end enumerate
20380
20381 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20382
20383 @lisp
20384 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20385 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20386 @end lisp
20387
20388 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20389 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20390
20391 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20392 @lisp
20393 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20394 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20395 @end lisp
20396
20397 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20398 Other functions include
20399
20400 @table @code
20401 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20402 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20403 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20404 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20405
20406 @end table
20407
20408 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20409 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20410 their own home score files:
20411
20412 @lisp
20413 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20414 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20415 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20416 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20417 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20418 @end lisp
20419
20420 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20421 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20422 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20423 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20424 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20425
20426 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20427 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20428 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20429 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20430 precedence over this variable.
20431
20432
20433 @node Followups To Yourself
20434 @section Followups To Yourself
20435
20436 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20437 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20438 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20439 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20440 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20441 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20442
20443 @table @code
20444
20445 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20446 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20447 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20448 article.
20449
20450 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20451 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20452 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20453 your own article.
20454 @end table
20455
20456 @vindex message-sent-hook
20457 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20458 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20459 @lisp
20460 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20461 @end lisp
20462
20463
20464 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20465 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20466 mine:
20467
20468 @example
20469 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20470 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20471 @end example
20472
20473 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20474 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20475 myself:
20476
20477 @lisp
20478 ("references"
20479 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20480 1000 nil r))
20481 @end lisp
20482
20483 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20484 is system-dependent.
20485
20486
20487 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20488 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20489 @cindex scoring on other headers
20490
20491 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20492 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20493 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20494 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20495 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20496
20497 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20498 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20499 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20500 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20501 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20502 inhibited for all groups.
20503
20504 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20505 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20506 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20507 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20508 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20509
20510 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20511
20512 @lisp
20513 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20514 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20515 @end lisp
20516
20517 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20518 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20519 time if you have much mail.
20520
20521 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20522 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20523
20524 See? Simple.
20525
20526
20527 @node Scoring Tips
20528 @section Scoring Tips
20529 @cindex scoring tips
20530
20531 @table @dfn
20532
20533 @item Crossposts
20534 @cindex crossposts
20535 @cindex scoring crossposts
20536 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20537 the @code{Xref} header.
20538 @lisp
20539 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20540 @end lisp
20541
20542 @item Multiple crossposts
20543 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20544 more than, say, 3 groups:
20545 @lisp
20546 ("xref"
20547 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20548 -1000 nil r))
20549 @end lisp
20550
20551 @item Matching on the body
20552 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20553 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20554 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20555 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20556 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20557 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20558 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20559 the matches.
20560
20561 @item Marking as read
20562 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20563 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20564 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20565 @lisp
20566 ((mark -100))
20567 @end lisp
20568 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20569
20570 @item Negated character classes
20571 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20572 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20573 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20574 @end table
20575
20576
20577 @node Reverse Scoring
20578 @section Reverse Scoring
20579 @cindex reverse scoring
20580
20581 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20582 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20583 like this in your score file:
20584
20585 @lisp
20586 (("subject"
20587 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20588 (mark 1)
20589 (expunge 1))
20590 @end lisp
20591
20592 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20593 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20594
20595
20596 @node Global Score Files
20597 @section Global Score Files
20598 @cindex global score files
20599
20600 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20601 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20602 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20603
20604 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20605 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20606 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20607
20608 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20609 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20610 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20611 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20612 files are applicable to which group.
20613
20614 To use the score file
20615 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20616 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20617 say this:
20618
20619 @lisp
20620 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20621 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20622 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20623 @end lisp
20624
20625 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20626 @noindent
20627 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20628 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20629 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20630 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20631
20632 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20633 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20634
20635 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20636 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20637 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20638 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20639 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20640 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20641
20642 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20643 head:
20644
20645 @itemize @bullet
20646
20647 @item
20648 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20649 @item
20650 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20651 @item
20652 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20653 @item
20654 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20655 lowered out of existence.
20656 @item
20657 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20658 articles completely.
20659
20660 @item
20661 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20662 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20663 old articles for a long time.
20664 @end itemize
20665
20666 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20667 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20668 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20669 holding our breath yet?
20670
20671
20672 @node Kill Files
20673 @section Kill Files
20674 @cindex kill files
20675
20676 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20677 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20678 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20679
20680 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20681 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20682 files into score files.
20683
20684 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20685 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20686 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20687 that isn't a very good idea.
20688
20689 Normal kill files look like this:
20690
20691 @lisp
20692 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20693 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20694 (gnus-expunge "X")
20695 @end lisp
20696
20697 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20698 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20699
20700 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20701 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20702 interpreting it.
20703
20704 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20705
20706 @table @kbd
20707
20708 @item M-k
20709 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20710 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20711 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20712
20713 @item M-K
20714 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20715 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20716 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20717 @end table
20718
20719 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20720
20721 @table @kbd
20722
20723 @item M-k
20724 @kindex M-k (Group)
20725 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20726 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20727
20728 @item M-K
20729 @kindex M-K (Group)
20730 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20731 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20732 @end table
20733
20734 Kill file variables:
20735
20736 @table @code
20737 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20738 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20739 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20740 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20741 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20742 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20743 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20744
20745 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20746 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20747 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20748 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20749 kills.
20750
20751 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20752 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20753 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20754 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20755 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20756 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20757 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20758 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20759 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20760
20761 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20762 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20763 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20764
20765 @end table
20766
20767
20768 @node Converting Kill Files
20769 @section Converting Kill Files
20770 @cindex kill files
20771 @cindex converting kill files
20772
20773 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20774 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20775 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20776 by hand.
20777
20778 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20779 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20780 from
20781 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20782
20783 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20784 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20785 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20786 before.
20787
20788
20789 @node Advanced Scoring
20790 @section Advanced Scoring
20791
20792 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20793 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20794 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20795 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20796 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20797
20798 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20799 scoring patterns.
20800
20801 @menu
20802 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20803 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20804 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20805 @end menu
20806
20807
20808 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20809 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20810
20811 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20812 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20813 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20814 non-@code{nil} value.
20815
20816 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20817 operator, and various match operators.
20818
20819 Logical operators:
20820
20821 @table @code
20822 @item &
20823 @itemx and
20824 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20825 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20826 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20827 @code{true}.
20828
20829 @item |
20830 @itemx or
20831 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20832 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20833 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20834
20835 @item !
20836 @itemx not
20837 @itemx ¬
20838 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20839 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20840
20841 @end table
20842
20843 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20844 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20845 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20846 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20847 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20848 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20849 the ancestry you want to go.
20850
20851 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20852 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20853 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20854 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20855 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20856
20857
20858 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20859 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20860
20861 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20862 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20863 of parentheses.
20864
20865 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20866 when he's talking about Gnus:
20867
20868 @example
20869 @group
20870 ((&
20871 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20872 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20873 1000)
20874 @end group
20875 @end example
20876
20877 Quite simple, huh?
20878
20879 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20880
20881 @example
20882 ((&
20883 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20884 (|
20885 ("subject" "Gnus")
20886 ("lines" 100 >)))
20887 1000)
20888 @end example
20889
20890 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20891 really don't want to read what he's written:
20892
20893 @example
20894 ((&
20895 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20896 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20897 -100000)
20898 @end example
20899
20900 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20901 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20902 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20903 very interesting:
20904
20905 @example
20906 ((&
20907 (1-
20908 (&
20909 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20910 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20911 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20912 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20913 1000)
20914 @end example
20915
20916 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20917 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20918 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20919 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20920
20921 @example
20922 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20923 -200)
20924 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20925 200)
20926 @end example
20927
20928 The possibilities are endless.
20929
20930 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20931 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20932
20933 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20934 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20935 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20936 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20937 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20938 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20939 @samp{subject}) first.
20940
20941 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20942 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20943 something like:
20944
20945 @example
20946 ...
20947 (1-
20948 (1-
20949 ("from" "lars")))
20950 ...
20951 @end example
20952
20953 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20954 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20955
20956 @example
20957 (1-
20958 (&
20959 ("from" "Lars")
20960 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20961 @end example
20962
20963 than it is to say:
20964
20965 @example
20966 (&
20967 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20968 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20969 @end example
20970
20971
20972 @node Score Decays
20973 @section Score Decays
20974 @cindex score decays
20975 @cindex decays
20976
20977 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20978 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20979 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20980 use them in any sensible way.
20981
20982 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20983 @findex gnus-decay-score
20984 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20985 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20986 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20987 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20988 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20989 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
20990 regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
20991 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
20992 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
20993 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
20994 function:
20995
20996 @lisp
20997 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20998 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20999 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21000 (let ((n (- score
21001 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21002 (min (abs score)
21003 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21004 (* (abs score)
21005 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21006 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
21007 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
21008 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21009 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21010 (string-to-number
21011 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21012 (floor n))))
21013 @end lisp
21014
21015 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21016 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21017 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21018 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
21019
21020 @enumerate
21021 @item
21022 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21023
21024 @item
21025 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21026
21027 @item
21028 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21029 score.
21030 @end enumerate
21031
21032 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21033 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21034 the new score, which should be an integer.
21035
21036 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21037 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21038
21039 @node Searching
21040 @chapter Searching
21041 @cindex searching
21042
21043 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21044 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21045 as well.
21046
21047 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21048 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
21049 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21050 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21051
21052 @menu
21053 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21054 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21055 @end menu
21056
21057 @node nnir
21058 @section nnir
21059 @cindex nnir
21060
21061 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21062 within gnus.
21063
21064 @menu
21065 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21066 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21067 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21068 @end menu
21069
21070 @node What is nnir?
21071 @subsection What is nnir?
21072
21073 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21074 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21075 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21076 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21077 interface.
21078
21079 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21080 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21081 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21082
21083
21084 @node Basic Usage
21085 @subsection Basic Usage
21086
21087 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21088 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21089 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21090 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21091 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21092 using the usual commands.
21093
21094 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group, and
21095 some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21096 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21097 alternative: you can @emph{warp} to the original group for the article
21098 on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21099 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21100 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers to
21101 @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works its
21102 magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you can
21103 read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article marks,
21104 whatever. Go nuts.
21105
21106 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21107 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21108 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21109 will search all the groups under that heading.
21110
21111 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21112 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21113 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21114 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21115 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21116
21117 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21118 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21119 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21120 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21121 special search features for each engine separately.
21122
21123
21124 @node Setting up nnir
21125 @subsection Setting up nnir
21126
21127 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21128 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21129 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21130 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21131 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21132 a backend.
21133
21134 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21135 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21136 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21137 query language anyway.
21138
21139 @menu
21140 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21141 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21142 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21143 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21144 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21145 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21146 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21147 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21148 @end menu
21149
21150 @node Associating Engines
21151 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21152
21153
21154 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21155 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21156 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21157 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21158 named @code{home} you can use
21159
21160 @lisp
21161 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21162 '((nnml "home"
21163 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21164 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21165 @end lisp
21166
21167 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21168 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21169 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21170 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21171 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21172 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21173 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21174 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21175 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21176 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21177 could change this to
21178
21179 @lisp
21180 '((nnimap . namazu)
21181 (nntp . gmane))
21182 @end lisp
21183
21184 @node The imap Engine
21185 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21186
21187 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21188
21189 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21190 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21191 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21192
21193 @table @samp
21194
21195 @item Boolean query operators
21196 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21197 operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21198 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21199 recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent to NOT
21200 term.
21201
21202 @item Automatic AND queries
21203 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21204 expression intended to match all components.
21205
21206 @item Phrase searches
21207 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21208 literal string.
21209
21210 @end table
21211
21212 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21213 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21214 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21215 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21216 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21217 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21218 the query to the Message-ID header.
21219
21220 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21221 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21222 RFC3501.
21223
21224 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21225 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21226 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21227
21228 @lisp
21229 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21230 @end lisp
21231
21232 @node The gmane Engine
21233 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21234
21235 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21236
21237 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21238
21239 @table @samp
21240 @item Boolean query operators
21241 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21242 used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21243 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21244 recognized.
21245
21246 @item Required and excluded terms
21247 + and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21248 @minus{}american
21249
21250 @item Unicode handling
21251 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21252 in any language.
21253
21254 @item Stopwords
21255 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21256 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21257 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
21258
21259 @end table
21260
21261 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21262 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21263 name (or part of a name) to match.
21264
21265 @node The swish++ Engine
21266 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21267
21268 FIXME: Say something more here.
21269
21270 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21271 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21272
21273 @table @code
21274
21275 @item nnir-swish++-program
21276 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21277
21278 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21279 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21280 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21281
21282 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21283 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21284 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21285
21286 @end table
21287
21288 @node The swish-e Engine
21289 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21290
21291 FIXME: Say something more here.
21292
21293 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21294 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21295
21296 @table @code
21297
21298 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21299 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21300
21301 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21302 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21303 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21304
21305 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21306 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21307 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21308
21309 @end table
21310
21311 @node The namazu Engine
21312 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21313
21314 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21315 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21316 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21317 variable.
21318
21319 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21320 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21321 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21322 instead of `.').
21323
21324 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21325 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21326 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21327 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21328 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21329 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21330 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21331
21332 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21333 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21334 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21335 output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21336 `--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21337 information on valid switches.
21338
21339 Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21340 for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
21341
21342 @cartouche
21343 @example
21344 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21345
21346 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21347 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21348
21349 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21350 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21351
21352 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21353 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21354
21355 # The max length of a word.
21356 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21357
21358 # The max length of a field.
21359 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21360 @end example
21361 @end cartouche
21362
21363 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21364 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21365 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21366 the following command:
21367
21368 @example
21369 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21370 @end example
21371
21372 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21373 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21374
21375 @node The hyrex Engine
21376 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21377 This engine is obsolete.
21378
21379 @node Customizations
21380 @subsubsection Customizations
21381
21382 @table @code
21383
21384 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21385 Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default associations
21386 are
21387 @example
21388 (nnimap . imap)
21389 (nntp . gmane)
21390 @end example
21391
21392 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21393 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21394 when searching all groups on a server.
21395
21396 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21397 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21398 All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21399 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21400
21401 @example
21402 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21403 %G Article original full group name (string)
21404 %g Article original short group name (string)
21405 @end example
21406
21407 If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21408
21409 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21410 If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21411 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21412 group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21413 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21414 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21415 should return @code{nil}
21416
21417 If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21418 search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
21419
21420
21421 @end table
21422
21423
21424 @node nnmairix
21425 @section nnmairix
21426
21427 @cindex mairix
21428 @cindex nnmairix
21429 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21430 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21431 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21432 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21433
21434 @menu
21435 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21436 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21437 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21438 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21439 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21440 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21441 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21442 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21443 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21444 @end menu
21445
21446 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21447 @c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21448 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21449
21450 @node About mairix
21451 @subsection About mairix
21452
21453 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21454 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21455 GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21456 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21457 be found at
21458 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21459
21460 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21461 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21462 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21463 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21464 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21465 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21466 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21467 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21468 up.
21469
21470 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21471 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21472 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21473 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21474 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21475 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21476 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21477 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21478 searches.
21479
21480 @node nnmairix requirements
21481 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21482
21483 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21484 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21485 server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21486 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
21487
21488 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21489 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21490 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21491 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21492
21493 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21494 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21495 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21496 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21497 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21498 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21499
21500 @node What nnmairix does
21501 @subsection What nnmairix does
21502
21503 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21504 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21505 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21506 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
21507 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21508 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21509 mails are in different folders.
21510
21511 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21512 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21513 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21514 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21515 new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21516 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21517
21518 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21519 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21520 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21521 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21522 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21523 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21524 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21525 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
21526 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21527 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21528 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21529
21530 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21531 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21532 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21533 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21534 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21535 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21536 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21537 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21538 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21539 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21540 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
21541 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21542 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21543 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21544 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21545 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21546
21547 @node Setting up mairix
21548 @subsection Setting up mairix
21549
21550 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21551
21552 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21553 (at least) the following entries:
21554
21555 @example
21556 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21557 base=~/Maildir
21558 @end example
21559
21560 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21561 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21562 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21563 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21564
21565 @example
21566 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21567 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21568 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21569 @end example
21570
21571 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21572 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21573 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21574 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21575 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21576
21577 @example
21578 omit=zz_mairix-*
21579 @end example
21580
21581 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21582 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21583 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21584 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21585
21586 @example
21587 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21588 database= ... location of database file ...
21589 @end example
21590
21591 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21592 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21593 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21594
21595 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21596
21597 @example
21598 base=~/Maildir
21599 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21600 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21601 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21602 mformat=maildir
21603 omit=zz_mairix-*
21604 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21605 @end example
21606
21607 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21608 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21609 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21610 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21611 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21612 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21613 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21614 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21615 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21616 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21617 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21618 The other lines should be obvious.
21619
21620 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21621 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21622 than you are used to.
21623
21624 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21625 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21626 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21627
21628 @node Configuring nnmairix
21629 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21630
21631 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21632 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21633 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21634 server. You will have to specify the following:
21635
21636 @itemize @bullet
21637
21638 @item
21639 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21640 want.
21641
21642 @item
21643 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21644 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21645 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21646 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21647 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21648 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21649 However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21650 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21651 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21652 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21653 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21654 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21655 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21656 @code{nnimap} server here.
21657
21658 @item
21659 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21660 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21661 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21662 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
21663 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21664 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21665 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21666
21667 @item
21668 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21669 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
21670 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21671 like.
21672
21673 @item
21674 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21675 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
21676 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21677 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21678 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21679
21680 @end itemize
21681
21682 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21683 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21684
21685 In group mode:
21686
21687 @table @kbd
21688
21689 @item G b c
21690 @kindex G b c (Group)
21691 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21692 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21693 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21694 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21695
21696 @item G b s
21697 @kindex G b s (Group)
21698 @findex nnmairix-search
21699 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21700 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21701 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21702
21703 @item G b m
21704 @kindex G b m (Group)
21705 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21706 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21707 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21708 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21709
21710 @item G b i
21711 @kindex G b i (Group)
21712 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21713 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21714 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21715
21716 @item G b g
21717 @kindex G b g (Group)
21718 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21719 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21720 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21721 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21722 @kbd{M-g}.
21723
21724 @item G b q
21725 @kindex G b q (Group)
21726 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21727 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21728 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21729
21730 @item G b t
21731 @kindex G b t (Group)
21732 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21733 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21734 i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21735 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21736
21737 @item G b u
21738 @kindex G b u (Group)
21739 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21740 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21741 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21742 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21743 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21744 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21745 options).
21746
21747 @item G b r
21748 @kindex G b r (Group)
21749 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21750 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21751 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21752
21753 @item G b d
21754 @kindex G b d (Group)
21755 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21756 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21757 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21758 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21759
21760 @item G b a
21761 @kindex G b a (Group)
21762 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21763 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21764 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21765 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21766 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21767 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21768 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21769 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21770 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21771
21772 @item G b p
21773 @kindex G b p (Group)
21774 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21775 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21776 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21777 marks}).
21778
21779 @item G b o
21780 @kindex G b o (Group)
21781 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21782 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21783 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21784
21785 @end table
21786
21787 In summary mode:
21788
21789 @table @kbd
21790
21791 @item $ m
21792 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21793 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21794 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21795 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21796 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21797
21798 @item $ g
21799 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21800 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21801 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21802 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21803 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21804
21805 @item $ t
21806 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21807 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21808 Searches thread for the current article
21809 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21810 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21811 current article and enabled threads.
21812
21813 @item $ f
21814 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21815 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21816 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21817 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21818 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21819
21820 @item $ o
21821 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21822 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21823 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21824 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21825 e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21826 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21827 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21828 article file name as a fallback method.
21829
21830 @item $ u
21831 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21832 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21833 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21834 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21835 tips and tricks}).
21836
21837 @end table
21838
21839 @node Propagating marks
21840 @subsection Propagating marks
21841
21842 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21843 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21844 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21845
21846 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21847
21848 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21849 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21850 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21851 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21852 be useful to you.
21853
21854 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21855 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21856 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21857 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21858 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21859 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21860 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21861 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21862 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21863 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21864
21865 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21866 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21867 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21868 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21869 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21870 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21871 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21872
21873 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21874 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21875 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21876 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21877 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21878 even more cumbersome.
21879
21880 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21881 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21882 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21883
21884 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21885 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21886 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21887 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21888 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21889 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21890 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21891
21892 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21893 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21894 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21895 magically be set for the original article, too.
21896
21897 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21898
21899 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21900 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21901 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21902 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21903 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21904 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21905 details).
21906
21907 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21908 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21909 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21910 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21911 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21912 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21913 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21914
21915 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21916 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21917 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21918 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21919 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21920 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21921 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
21922
21923 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
21924 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21925 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21926 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21927 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21928 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21929 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21930 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21931 maildir as its file format.
21932
21933 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21934 If you work with this setup, just set
21935 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21936 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21937 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21938 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21939 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21940 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
21941
21942 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
21943 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21944
21945 @itemize
21946 @item
21947 Checking Mail
21948
21949 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
21950 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21951 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21952 Levels}).
21953
21954 I use the following to check for mails:
21955
21956 @lisp
21957 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21958 (interactive "P")
21959 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
21960 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
21961 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
21962 (gnus-group-list-groups))
21963
21964 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
21965 @end lisp
21966
21967 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
21968 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
21969 details.
21970
21971 @item
21972 Example: search group for ticked articles
21973
21974 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
21975 articles always stay unread:
21976
21977 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
21978 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
21979
21980 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
21981 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
21982
21983 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
21984 group? There are two options: You may simply use
21985 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
21986 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
21987 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
21988 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
21989 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
21990 e.g., by marking an article as read.
21991
21992 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
21993 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
21994 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
21995 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
21996 snippet and the doc string for details.
21997
21998 @item
21999 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
22000
22001 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
22002 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
22003 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
22004 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
22005 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
22006 @code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
22007 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
22008 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
22009 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
22010 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
22011 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
22012 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
22013
22014 @lisp
22015 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
22016 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
22017 @end lisp
22018
22019 @end itemize
22020
22021 @node nnmairix caveats
22022 @subsection nnmairix caveats
22023
22024 @itemize
22025 @item
22026 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22027 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22028 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22029 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22030 an example server definition:
22031
22032 @lisp
22033 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22034 @end lisp
22035
22036 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
22037 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22038 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22039 mairix.)
22040
22041 @item
22042 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22043 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
22044 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22045 @emph{extra careful} if you use
22046 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22047 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22048 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
22049
22050 @item
22051 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22052 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22053
22054 @item
22055 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22056 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22057
22058 @item
22059 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22060
22061 @item
22062 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22063 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22064 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22065 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22066 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22067 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22068 folders.
22069
22070 @item
22071 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22072 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22073 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22074 it is gone for good.
22075
22076 @item
22077 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22078 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22079 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22080 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22081 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22082 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22083 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22084 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22085 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22086
22087 @item
22088 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22089 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22090
22091 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22092 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22093 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22094 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22095 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22096 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22097 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22098 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22099 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22100 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22101 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22102 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22103
22104 @end itemize
22105
22106 @iftex
22107 @iflatex
22108 @chapter Message
22109 @include message.texi
22110 @chapter Emacs MIME
22111 @include emacs-mime.texi
22112 @chapter Sieve
22113 @include sieve.texi
22114 @chapter EasyPG
22115 @include epa.texi
22116 @chapter SASL
22117 @include sasl.texi
22118 @end iflatex
22119 @end iftex
22120
22121 @node Various
22122 @chapter Various
22123
22124 @menu
22125 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22126 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22127 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22128 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22129 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22130 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22131 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22132 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22133 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22134 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22135 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22136 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22137 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22138 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22139 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22140 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22141 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22142 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22143 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22144 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22145 @end menu
22146
22147
22148 @node Process/Prefix
22149 @section Process/Prefix
22150 @cindex process/prefix convention
22151
22152 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22153 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22154
22155 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22156 command to be performed on.
22157
22158 It goes like this:
22159
22160 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22161 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22162 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22163 with the current one.
22164
22165 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22166 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22167 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22168
22169 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22170 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22171 the process mark.
22172
22173 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22174 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22175
22176 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22177 are avoided.
22178
22179 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22180 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22181 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22182 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22183
22184 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22185 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22186 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22187 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22188 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22189 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22190 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22191 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22192
22193 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22194 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22195 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22196 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22197 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22198
22199
22200 @node Interactive
22201 @section Interactive
22202 @cindex interaction
22203
22204 @table @code
22205
22206 @item gnus-novice-user
22207 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22208 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22209 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22210 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22211 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22212 default.
22213
22214 @item gnus-expert-user
22215 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22216 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22217 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22218 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22219 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22220 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22221 confirmation.
22222
22223 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22224 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22225 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22226 is @code{t} by default.
22227
22228 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22229 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22230 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22231 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22232 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22233 @end table
22234
22235
22236 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22237 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22238 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22239
22240 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22241 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22242 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22243 rule of 900 to the current article.
22244
22245 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22246 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22247 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22248 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22249 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22250 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22251 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22252
22253 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22254 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22255 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22256 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22257 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22258 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22259 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22260 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22261 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22262
22263 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22264 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22265 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22266
22267 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22268 Interactive}.
22269
22270
22271 @node Formatting Variables
22272 @section Formatting Variables
22273 @cindex formatting variables
22274
22275 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22276 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22277 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22278 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22279 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22280 be annoyed by.
22281
22282 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22283 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22284 lots of percentages everywhere.
22285
22286 @menu
22287 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22288 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22289 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22290 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22291 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22292 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22293 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22294 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22295 @end menu
22296
22297 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22298 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22299 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22300 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22301 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22302 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22303 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22304 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22305
22306 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22307 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22308
22309 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22310 @findex gnus-update-format
22311 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22312 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22313 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22314 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22315
22316
22317
22318 @node Formatting Basics
22319 @subsection Formatting Basics
22320
22321 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22322 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22323 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22324
22325 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22326 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22327 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22328 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22329 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22330 the right instead.
22331
22332 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22333 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22334 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22335 less than 4 characters wide.
22336
22337 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22338 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22339
22340
22341 @node Mode Line Formatting
22342 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22343
22344 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22345 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22346 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22347 with the following two differences:
22348
22349 @enumerate
22350
22351 @item
22352 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22353
22354 @item
22355 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22356 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22357 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22358 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22359 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22360 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22361 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22362
22363 @end enumerate
22364
22365
22366 @node Advanced Formatting
22367 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22368
22369 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22370 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22371 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22372 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22373
22374 These are the valid modifiers:
22375
22376 @table @code
22377 @item pad
22378 @itemx pad-left
22379 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22380 length.
22381
22382 @item pad-right
22383 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22384 length.
22385
22386 @item max
22387 @itemx max-left
22388 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22389
22390 @item max-right
22391 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22392 length.
22393
22394 @item cut
22395 @itemx cut-left
22396 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22397
22398 @item cut-right
22399 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22400
22401 @item ignore
22402 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22403
22404 @item form
22405 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22406 used.
22407
22408 Here's an example:
22409
22410 @lisp
22411 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22412 @end lisp
22413
22414 @end table
22415
22416 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22417 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22418 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22419 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22420 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22421 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22422 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22423
22424 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22425 last operation, padding.
22426
22427
22428 @node User-Defined Specs
22429 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22430
22431 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22432 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22433 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22434 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22435 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22436 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22437 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22438 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22439 should protect against that.
22440
22441 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22442 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22443
22444 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22445 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22446 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22447 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22448 inserted.
22449
22450
22451 @node Formatting Fonts
22452 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22453
22454 @cindex %(, %)
22455 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22456 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22457 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22458 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22459 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22460 over it.
22461
22462 @cindex %@{, %@}
22463 @vindex gnus-face-0
22464 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22465 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22466 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22467 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22468 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22469 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22470
22471 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22472 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22473 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22474 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22475 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22476 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22477 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22478 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22479 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22480 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22481 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22482 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22483 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22484 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22485 paragraph.)
22486
22487 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22488
22489 @lisp
22490 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22491 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22492 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22493
22494 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22495 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22496 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22497 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22498 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22499 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22500 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22501
22502 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22503 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22504 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22505 @end lisp
22506
22507 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22508 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22509
22510 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22511 mode-line variables.
22512
22513 @node Positioning Point
22514 @subsection Positioning Point
22515
22516 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22517 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22518 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22519
22520 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22521
22522 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22523 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22524 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22525
22526 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22527 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22528 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22529 place point there.
22530
22531
22532 @node Tabulation
22533 @subsection Tabulation
22534
22535 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22536 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22537 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22538 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22539
22540 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22541 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22542
22543 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22544 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22545 This is the soft tabulator.
22546
22547 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22548 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22549 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22550
22551
22552 @node Wide Characters
22553 @subsection Wide Characters
22554
22555 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22556 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22557 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22558
22559 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22560 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22561 these countries, that's not true.
22562
22563 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22564 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22565 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22566 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22567 for Emacs.
22568
22569
22570 @node Window Layout
22571 @section Window Layout
22572 @cindex window layout
22573
22574 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22575
22576 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22577 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22578 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22579 @code{t} by default.
22580
22581 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22582 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22583
22584 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22585 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22586 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22587
22588 @lisp
22589 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22590 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22591 (article 1.0))))
22592 @end lisp
22593
22594 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22595 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22596 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22597 possible names is listed below.
22598
22599 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22600 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
22601
22602 @lisp
22603 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22604 (article 1.0)))
22605 @end lisp
22606
22607 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22608 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22609 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22610 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22611 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22612 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22613 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22614 size spec per split.
22615
22616 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22617 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22618 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
22619 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22620 present) gets focus.
22621
22622 Here's a more complicated example:
22623
22624 @lisp
22625 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22626 (summary 0.25 point)
22627 (article 1.0)))
22628 @end lisp
22629
22630 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22631 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22632 occupy, not a percentage.
22633
22634 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22635 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22636 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22637 be used as a split.
22638
22639 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22640
22641 @lisp
22642 (article (horizontal 1.0
22643 (vertical 0.5
22644 (group 1.0))
22645 (vertical 1.0
22646 (summary 0.25 point)
22647 (article 1.0))))
22648 @end lisp
22649
22650 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22651 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22652
22653 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22654 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22655 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22656 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22657 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22658
22659 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22660 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22661 lines from the splits.
22662
22663 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22664 may look like:
22665
22666 @example
22667 @group
22668 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22669 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22670 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22671 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22672 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22673 size = number | frame-params
22674 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22675 @end group
22676 @end example
22677
22678 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22679 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22680 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22681 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22682
22683 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22684 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22685 @cindex window height
22686 @cindex window width
22687 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22688 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22689 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22690 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22691 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22692 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22693
22694 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22695 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22696 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22697 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22698
22699 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22700 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22701 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22702 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22703 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22704 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22705 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22706 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22707 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22708 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22709 configuration list.
22710
22711 @lisp
22712 (gnus-configure-frame
22713 '(horizontal 1.0
22714 (vertical 10
22715 (group 1.0)
22716 (article 0.3 point))
22717 (vertical 1.0
22718 (article 1.0)
22719 (horizontal 4
22720 (group 1.0)
22721 (article 10)))))
22722 @end lisp
22723
22724 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22725 @code{frame} split:
22726
22727 @lisp
22728 (gnus-configure-frame
22729 '(frame 1.0
22730 (vertical 1.0
22731 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22732 (article 1.0))
22733 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22734 (user-position . t)
22735 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22736 (picon 1.0))))
22737
22738 @end lisp
22739
22740 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22741 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22742 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22743 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22744 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22745 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22746 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22747 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22748 is such a plist.
22749 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22750 be found in its default value.
22751
22752 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22753 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22754 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22755 might be used:
22756
22757 @lisp
22758 (message (horizontal 1.0
22759 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22760 (vertical 0.24
22761 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22762 '(summary 0.5))
22763 (group 1.0))))
22764 @end lisp
22765
22766 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22767 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22768 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22769
22770 @lisp
22771 (message
22772 (frame 1.0
22773 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22774 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22775 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22776 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22777 (name . "Message"))
22778 (message 1.0 point))))
22779 @end lisp
22780
22781 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22782 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22783 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22784 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22785 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22786
22787 @lisp
22788 (gnus-add-configuration
22789 '(article (vertical 1.0
22790 (group 4)
22791 (summary .25 point)
22792 (article 1.0))))
22793 @end lisp
22794
22795 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22796 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22797 Gnus has been loaded.
22798
22799 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22800 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22801 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22802 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22803 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22804
22805 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22806 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22807 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22808 windows resized.
22809
22810 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22811
22812 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22813 and when they're used:
22814
22815 @table @code
22816 @item group
22817 The group buffer.
22818
22819 @item summary
22820 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22821
22822 @item article
22823 Selecting an article.
22824
22825 @item server
22826 The server buffer.
22827
22828 @item browse
22829 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22830
22831 @item message
22832 Composing a (new) message.
22833
22834 @item only-article
22835 Showing only the article buffer.
22836
22837 @item edit-article
22838 Editing an article.
22839
22840 @item edit-form
22841 Editing group parameters and the like.
22842
22843 @item edit-score
22844 Editing a server definition.
22845
22846 @item post
22847 Composing a news message.
22848
22849 @item reply
22850 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22851
22852 @item forward
22853 Forwarding a message.
22854
22855 @item reply-yank
22856 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22857
22858 @item mail-bound
22859 Bouncing a message.
22860
22861 @item pipe
22862 Sending an article to an external process.
22863
22864 @item bug
22865 Sending a bug report.
22866
22867 @item score-trace
22868 Displaying the score trace.
22869
22870 @item score-words
22871 Displaying the score words.
22872
22873 @item split-trace
22874 Displaying the split trace.
22875
22876 @item compose-bounce
22877 Composing a bounce message.
22878
22879 @item mml-preview
22880 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22881
22882 @end table
22883
22884
22885 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22886
22887 @itemize @bullet
22888 @item
22889 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22890 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22891
22892 @ifinfo
22893 @example
22894 +---+---------+
22895 | G | Summary |
22896 | r +---------+
22897 | o | |
22898 | u | Article |
22899 | p | |
22900 +---+---------+
22901 @end example
22902 @end ifinfo
22903
22904 @lisp
22905 (gnus-add-configuration
22906 '(article
22907 (horizontal 1.0
22908 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22909 (vertical 1.0
22910 (summary 0.16 point)
22911 (article 1.0)))))
22912
22913 (gnus-add-configuration
22914 '(summary
22915 (horizontal 1.0
22916 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22917 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22918 @end lisp
22919
22920 @end itemize
22921
22922
22923 @node Faces and Fonts
22924 @section Faces and Fonts
22925 @cindex faces
22926 @cindex fonts
22927 @cindex colors
22928
22929 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22930 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22931 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22932 interface.
22933
22934
22935 @node Mode Lines
22936 @section Mode Lines
22937 @cindex mode lines
22938
22939 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22940 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22941 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22942 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22943 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22944 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22945 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22946 quicker.
22947
22948 @cindex display-time
22949
22950 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22951 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22952 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22953 to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22954 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22955 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22956 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22957 additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
22958 this variable:
22959
22960 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22961 @lisp
22962 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22963 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22964 (+ 21
22965 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22966 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22967 (length display-time-string)))))
22968 @end lisp
22969
22970 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22971 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22972 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22973 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22974 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22975
22976
22977 @node Highlighting and Menus
22978 @section Highlighting and Menus
22979 @cindex visual
22980 @cindex highlighting
22981 @cindex menus
22982
22983 @vindex gnus-visual
22984 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22985 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22986 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22987 file.
22988
22989 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22990 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22991
22992 @table @code
22993 @item group-highlight
22994 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22995 @item summary-highlight
22996 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22997 @item article-highlight
22998 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22999 @item highlight
23000 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
23001 @item group-menu
23002 Create menus in the group buffer.
23003 @item summary-menu
23004 Create menus in the summary buffers.
23005 @item article-menu
23006 Create menus in the article buffer.
23007 @item browse-menu
23008 Create menus in the browse buffer.
23009 @item server-menu
23010 Create menus in the server buffer.
23011 @item score-menu
23012 Create menus in the score buffers.
23013 @item menu
23014 Create menus in all buffers.
23015 @end table
23016
23017 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
23018 buffers, you could say something like:
23019
23020 @lisp
23021 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
23022 @end lisp
23023
23024 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23025
23026 @lisp
23027 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23028 @end lisp
23029
23030 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23031 in all Gnus buffers.
23032
23033 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23034
23035 @table @code
23036 @item gnus-mouse-face
23037 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23038 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23039 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23040
23041 @end table
23042
23043 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23044
23045 @table @code
23046
23047 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23048 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23049 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23050
23051 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23052 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23053 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23054
23055 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23056 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23057 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23058
23059 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23060 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23061 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23062
23063 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23064 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23065 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23066
23067 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23068 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23069 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23070
23071 @end table
23072
23073
23074 @node Daemons
23075 @section Daemons
23076 @cindex demons
23077 @cindex daemons
23078
23079 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23080 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23081 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23082 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23083 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23084
23085 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23086 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23087 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23088
23089 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23090 been idle for thirty minutes:
23091
23092 @lisp
23093 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23094 @end lisp
23095
23096 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23097 Emacs is idle:
23098
23099 @lisp
23100 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23101 @end lisp
23102
23103 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23104 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23105 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23106
23107 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23108 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23109 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23110 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23111
23112 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23113 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23114 @var{idle} minutes.
23115
23116 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23117 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23118 minutes.
23119
23120 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23121 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23122 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23123
23124 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23125 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23126 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23127 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23128
23129 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23130 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23131
23132 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23133 @lisp
23134 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23135 @end lisp
23136
23137 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23138 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23139 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23140 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23141 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23142 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23143 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23144 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23145 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23146 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23147
23148 @findex gnus-demon-init
23149 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23150 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23151 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23152 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23153 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23154
23155 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23156 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23157 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23158 behave.
23159
23160
23161 @node Undo
23162 @section Undo
23163 @cindex undo
23164
23165 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23166 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23167 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23168
23169 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23170 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23171 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23172 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23173 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23174 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23175 @code{undo} function.
23176
23177 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23178 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23179 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23180 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23181 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23182 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23183 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23184 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23185 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23186 never be totally undoable.
23187
23188 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23189 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23190 @findex gnus-undo
23191 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23192 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23193 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23194 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23195 command.
23196
23197
23198 @node Predicate Specifiers
23199 @section Predicate Specifiers
23200 @cindex predicate specifiers
23201
23202 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23203 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23204 to type all that much.
23205
23206 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23207
23208 Here's an example:
23209
23210 @lisp
23211 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23212 gnus-article-unread-p)
23213 @end lisp
23214
23215 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23216 functions all take one parameter.
23217
23218 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23219 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23220 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23221 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23222 specifier.
23223
23224
23225 @node Moderation
23226 @section Moderation
23227 @cindex moderation
23228
23229 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23230 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23231 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23232 get a copy.
23233
23234 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23235 buffers. Put
23236
23237 @lisp
23238 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23239 @end lisp
23240
23241 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23242
23243 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23244 supposed to work:
23245
23246 @enumerate
23247 @item
23248 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23249 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23250 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23251
23252 @item
23253 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23254 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23255
23256 @item
23257 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23258 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23259 @kbd{c} command.
23260 @end enumerate
23261
23262 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23263
23264 @lisp
23265 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23266 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23267 @end lisp
23268
23269
23270 @node Fetching a Group
23271 @section Fetching a Group
23272 @cindex fetching a group
23273
23274 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23275 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23276 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23277 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23278 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23279 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23280
23281
23282 @node Image Enhancements
23283 @section Image Enhancements
23284
23285 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23286 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23287 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23288
23289 @menu
23290 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23291 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23292 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23293 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23294 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23295 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23296 @end menu
23297
23298
23299 @node X-Face
23300 @subsection X-Face
23301 @cindex x-face
23302
23303 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23304 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23305 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23306 readers.
23307
23308 @cindex x-face
23309 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23310 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23311 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23312 @iftex
23313 @iflatex
23314 \include{xface}
23315 @end iflatex
23316 @end iftex
23317 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23318
23319 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23320 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23321 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23322 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23323 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23324 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23325 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23326 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23327 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23328 @code{display} program.
23329
23330 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23331 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23332 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23333 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23334 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23335 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23336 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23337 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23338
23339 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23340 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23341 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23342 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23343 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23344 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23345
23346 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23347 @code{xface}).
23348
23349 @noindent
23350 Face and variable:
23351
23352 @table @code
23353 @item gnus-x-face
23354 @vindex gnus-x-face
23355 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23356 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23357 default colors are black and white.
23358
23359 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23360 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23361 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23362 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23363 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23364 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23365
23366 @lisp
23367 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23368 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23369 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23370 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23371
23372 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23373 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23374 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23375 (png . (:relief -2))))
23376 @end lisp
23377
23378 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23379 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23380 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23381 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23382 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23383 @samp{libcompface} library.
23384 @end table
23385
23386 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23387 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23388 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23389 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23390 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23391 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23392
23393 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23394 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23395 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23396 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23397 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23398 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23399 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23400 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23401 header data as a string.
23402
23403 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23404 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23405 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23406 randomly generated data.
23407
23408 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23409 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23410 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23411 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23412 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23413
23414 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23415 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23416
23417 @lisp
23418 (setq message-required-news-headers
23419 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23420 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23421 @end lisp
23422
23423 Using the last function would be something like this:
23424
23425 @lisp
23426 (setq message-required-news-headers
23427 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23428 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23429 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23430 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23431 @end lisp
23432
23433
23434 @node Face
23435 @subsection Face
23436 @cindex face
23437
23438 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23439
23440 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23441 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23442 represent the author of the message.
23443
23444 @cindex face
23445 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23446 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23447 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23448 specifications.
23449
23450 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23451 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23452
23453 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23454 PNG images.
23455 @c Maybe add this:
23456 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23457 @c (featurep 'png)
23458 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23459
23460 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23461 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23462
23463 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23464 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23465 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23466
23467 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23468 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23469 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23470 converts the file to Face format by using the
23471 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23472
23473 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23474 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23475
23476 @lisp
23477 (setq message-required-news-headers
23478 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23479 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23480 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23481 @end lisp
23482
23483
23484 @node Smileys
23485 @subsection Smileys
23486 @cindex smileys
23487
23488 @iftex
23489 @iflatex
23490 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23491 \input{smiley}
23492 @end iflatex
23493 @end iftex
23494
23495 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23496 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23497
23498 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23499 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23500
23501 @lisp
23502 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23503 @end lisp
23504
23505 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23506 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23507 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23508 text and maps that to file names.
23509
23510 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23511 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23512 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23513 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23514 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23515 displayed.
23516
23517 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23518
23519 @table @code
23520
23521 @item smiley-style
23522 @vindex smiley-style
23523 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23524 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23525 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23526 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23527 face.
23528
23529 @item smiley-data-directory
23530 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23531 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23532 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23533
23534 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23535 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23536 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23537
23538 @end table
23539
23540
23541 @node Picons
23542 @subsection Picons
23543
23544 @iftex
23545 @iflatex
23546 \include{picons}
23547 @end iflatex
23548 @end iftex
23549
23550 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23551 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23552 over your shoulder as you read news.
23553
23554 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23555
23556 @iftex
23557 @iflatex
23558 \margindex{}
23559 @end iflatex
23560 @end iftex
23561
23562 @quotation
23563 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23564 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23565 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23566 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23567 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23568 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23569 @code{GIF} formats.
23570 @end quotation
23571
23572 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23573 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23574 point your Web browser at
23575 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23576
23577 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23578 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23579
23580 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23581 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23582 Picons databases.
23583
23584 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23585 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23586 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23587 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23588
23589 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23590 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23591 properties applied to picons.
23592
23593 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23594
23595 @table @code
23596
23597 @item gnus-picon-databases
23598 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23599 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23600 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23601 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23602 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23603
23604 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23605 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23606 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23607 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23608
23609 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23610 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23611 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23612 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23613
23614 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23615 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23616 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23617 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23618 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23619
23620 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23621 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23622 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23623 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23624
23625 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23626 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23627 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23628 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23629 interesting.
23630
23631 @end table
23632
23633 @node Gravatars
23634 @subsection Gravatars
23635
23636 @iftex
23637 @iflatex
23638 \include{gravatars}
23639 @end iflatex
23640 @end iftex
23641
23642 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23643
23644 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23645
23646 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23647
23648 @table @code
23649
23650 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23651 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23652 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23653 number for the size is enough.
23654
23655 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23656 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23657 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23658
23659 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23660 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23661 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23662 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23663 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23664
23665 @end table
23666
23667 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23668 @lisp
23669 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23670 @end lisp
23671
23672 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23673
23674 @lisp
23675 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23676 @end lisp
23677
23678
23679 @node XVarious
23680 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23681
23682 @table @code
23683 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23684 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23685 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23686 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23687 unusual directory structure.
23688
23689 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23690 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23691 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23692 default.
23693
23694 @end table
23695
23696 @subsubsection Toolbar
23697
23698 @table @code
23699
23700 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23701 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23702 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23703 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23704 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23705 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23706 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23707 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23708
23709 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23710 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23711 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23712 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23713 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23714 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23715
23716 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23717 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23718 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23719
23720 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23721 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23722 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23723
23724 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23725 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23726 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23727
23728 @end table
23729
23730 @iftex
23731 @iflatex
23732 \margindex{}
23733 @end iflatex
23734 @end iftex
23735
23736
23737 @node Fuzzy Matching
23738 @section Fuzzy Matching
23739 @cindex fuzzy matching
23740
23741 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23742 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23743
23744 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23745 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23746 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23747
23748 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23749 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23750 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23751 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23752 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23753
23754
23755 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23756 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23757 @cindex email spam
23758 @cindex spam
23759 @cindex UCE
23760 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23761
23762 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23763 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23764 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23765 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23766 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23767 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23768 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23769 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23770 in the end.
23771
23772 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23773 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23774 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23775 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23776 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23777 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23778
23779 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23780
23781 @menu
23782 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23783 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23784 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23785 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23786 @end menu
23787
23788 @node The problem of spam
23789 @subsection The problem of spam
23790 @cindex email spam
23791 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23792 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23793 @cindex UCE
23794 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23795
23796 First, some background on spam.
23797
23798 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23799 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23800 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23801 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23802 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23803 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23804 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23805 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23806 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23807
23808 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23809 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23810 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23811 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23812 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23813 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23814 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23815 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23816 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23817 and processing.
23818
23819 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23820 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23821 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23822 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23823 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23824 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23825 from Bulgarian IPs.
23826
23827 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23828 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23829 etc.)@: or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.)@: from contacting
23830 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23831
23832 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23833 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23834 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23835 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23836
23837 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23838 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23839 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23840 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23841 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23842 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23843 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23844 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23845 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23846
23847 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23848 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23849 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23850 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23851 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23852 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23853 down for some time because of the incident.
23854
23855 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23856 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23857 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23858 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23859 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23860 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23861 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23862 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23863 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23864 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23865 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23866
23867 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23868 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23869 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23870 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23871 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23872 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23873 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23874 spam plague.
23875
23876 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23877 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23878 @cindex email spam
23879 @cindex spam
23880 @cindex UCE
23881 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23882
23883 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23884 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23885
23886 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23887 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23888 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23889 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23890 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23891 part of the mail address.)
23892
23893 @lisp
23894 (setq message-default-news-headers
23895 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23896 @end lisp
23897
23898 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23899 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23900
23901 @lisp
23902 (...
23903 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23904 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23905 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23906 "spam"))
23907 ...)
23908 @end lisp
23909
23910 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23911 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23912 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23913 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23914
23915 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23916 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23917 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23918 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23919 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23920 your fancy split rule in this way:
23921
23922 @lisp
23923 (
23924 ...
23925 (to "larsi" "misc")
23926 "spam")
23927 @end lisp
23928
23929 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23930 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23931 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23932 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23933 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23934
23935 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23936 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23937 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23938 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23939
23940 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23941
23942
23943 @node SpamAssassin
23944 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23945 @cindex SpamAssassin
23946 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23947 @cindex DCC
23948
23949 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23950 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23951 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23952 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23953 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23954 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23955 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23956
23957 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23958 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23959 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23960 recipes.
23961
23962 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23963 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23964 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23965 Specifiers}) follow.
23966
23967 @lisp
23968 (setq mail-sources
23969 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23970 (pop :user "jrl"
23971 :server "pophost"
23972 :postscript
23973 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23974 @end lisp
23975
23976 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23977 the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23978 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23979
23980 @lisp
23981 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23982 ...))
23983 @end lisp
23984
23985 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23986
23987 @lisp
23988 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23989 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23990 ...))
23991 @end lisp
23992
23993 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23994 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23995 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23996 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23997
23998 @lisp
23999 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
24000 ...))
24001 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
24002 (save-excursion
24003 (save-restriction
24004 (widen)
24005 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
24006 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
24007 "spam"))))
24008 @end lisp
24009
24010 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
24011 downloaded by default. You need to set
24012 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
24013 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
24014
24015 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
24016 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
24017 spam. And here is the nifty function:
24018
24019 @lisp
24020 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
24021 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
24022 (interactive)
24023 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
24024 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24025 @end lisp
24026
24027 @node Hashcash
24028 @subsection Hashcash
24029 @cindex hashcash
24030
24031 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
24032 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24033 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24034 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24035 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24036
24037 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24038 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24039 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24040 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24041 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24042 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24043 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24044 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24045 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24046 one of them separately.
24047
24048 @cindex X-Hashcash
24049 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24050 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24051 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24052 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24053 need to install to use this feature, see
24054 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24055 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24056
24057 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24058 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24059 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24060
24061 @lisp
24062 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24063 @end lisp
24064
24065 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24066
24067 @table @code
24068
24069 @item hashcash-default-payment
24070 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24071 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24072 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24073 include 17 to 29.
24074
24075 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24076 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24077 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24078 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24079 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24080 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24081 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24082 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24083 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24084
24085 @item hashcash-path
24086 @vindex hashcash-path
24087 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24088 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24089 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24090 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24091 when you generate hashcash payments.
24092
24093 @end table
24094
24095 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24096 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24097 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24098 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24099 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24100 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24101 Hashcash Payments}).
24102
24103 @node Spam Package
24104 @section Spam Package
24105 @cindex spam filtering
24106 @cindex spam
24107
24108 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24109 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24110 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24111 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24112
24113 @menu
24114 * Spam Package Introduction::
24115 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24116 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24117 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24118 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24119 * Spam Back Ends::
24120 * Extending the Spam package::
24121 * Spam Statistics Package::
24122 @end menu
24123
24124 @node Spam Package Introduction
24125 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24126 @cindex spam filtering
24127 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24128 @cindex spam
24129
24130 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24131 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24132
24133 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24134 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24135
24136 @cindex spam-initialize
24137 @vindex spam-use-stat
24138 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24139 @code{spam-initialize}:
24140
24141 @example
24142 (spam-initialize)
24143 @end example
24144
24145 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24146 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24147 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24148 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24149 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24150
24151 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24152 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24153
24154 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24155 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24156
24157 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24158 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24159 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24160 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24161 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24162
24163 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24164 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24165 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24166 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24167 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24168 Groups}.
24169
24170 @cindex spam back ends
24171 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24172 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24173 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24174 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24175 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24176
24177 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24178 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24179
24180 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24181 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24182 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24183 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24184 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24185 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24186 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24187
24188 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24189 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24190 point, the Spam package does several things:
24191
24192 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24193 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24194 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24195 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24196 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24197 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24198 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24199 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24200 Ham Processors}.
24201
24202 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24203 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24204 group:
24205
24206 @table @kbd
24207 @item $
24208 @itemx M-d
24209 @itemx M s x
24210 @itemx S x
24211 @kindex $ (Summary)
24212 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24213 @kindex S x (Summary)
24214 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24215 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24216 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24217 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24218 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24219 @end table
24220
24221 @noindent
24222 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24223 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24224
24225 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24226 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24227 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24228 to be processed as ham by setting
24229 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24230 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24231
24232 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24233 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24234 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24235 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24236 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24237 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24238 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24239 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24240 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24241 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24242 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24243 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24244
24245 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24246 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24247 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24248 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24249 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24250 Configuration Examples}.
24251
24252 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24253 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24254 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24255 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24256
24257 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24258 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24259
24260 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24261 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24262 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24263
24264 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24265 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24266 @cindex spam filtering
24267 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24268 @cindex spam
24269
24270 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24271 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24272 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24273 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24274 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24275
24276 @example
24277 (: spam-split)
24278 @end example
24279
24280 @vindex spam-split-group
24281 @noindent
24282 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24283 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24284 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24285 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24286 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24287 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24288 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24289 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24290 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24291
24292 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24293
24294 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24295 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24296 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24297 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24298 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24299 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24300 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24301 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24302 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24303 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24304 IMAP Splitting}.
24305
24306 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24307 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24308 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24309 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24310 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24311 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24312 ends, and the following split rule:
24313
24314 @example
24315 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24316 (any "ding" "ding")
24317 (: spam-split)
24318 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24319 "mail")
24320 @end example
24321
24322 @noindent
24323 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24324 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24325 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24326 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24327 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24328 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24329
24330 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24331 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24332 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24333 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24334
24335 @example
24336 nnimap-split-fancy
24337 '(|
24338 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24339 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24340 (any "ding" "ding")
24341 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24342 (: spam-split)
24343 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24344 "mail")
24345 @end example
24346
24347 @noindent
24348 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24349 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24350 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24351 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24352 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24353 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24354 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24355
24356 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24357 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24358 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24359 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24360
24361 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24362 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24363 @c don't.}
24364
24365 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24366 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24367
24368 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24369 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24370 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24371 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24372
24373 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24374 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24375 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24376 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24377
24378 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24379 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24380 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24381
24382 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24383 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24384 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24385 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24386 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24387 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24388 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24389
24390 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24391 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24392 @cindex spam filtering
24393 @cindex spam filtering variables
24394 @cindex spam variables
24395 @cindex spam
24396
24397 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24398 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24399 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24400 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24401 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24402 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24403 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24404
24405 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24406 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24407 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24408 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24409
24410 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24411 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24412 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24413 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24414 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24415 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24416 by customizing the corresponding variable
24417 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24418 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24419 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24420 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24421 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24422 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24423 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24424 default.
24425
24426 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24427 @cindex $
24428 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24429 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24430 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24431 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24432 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24433 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24434 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24435 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24436 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24437 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24438 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24439 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24440 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24441
24442 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24443 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24444 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24445 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24446 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24447 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24448 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24449 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24450
24451 @defvar ham-marks
24452 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24453 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24454 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24455 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24456 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24457 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24458 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24459 happy for you.
24460 @end defvar
24461
24462 @defvar spam-marks
24463 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24464 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24465 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24466 you really want to.
24467 @end defvar
24468
24469 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24470 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24471 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24472 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24473 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24474 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24475 and nothing else.
24476
24477 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24478 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24479 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24480 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24481 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24482 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24483 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24484 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24485 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24486 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24487 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24488 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24489 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24490 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24491 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24492
24493 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24494 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24495
24496 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24497 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24498 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24499
24500 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24501 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24502
24503 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24504 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24505 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24506 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24507 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24508
24509 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24510 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24511 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24512 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24513 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24514 it there.
24515
24516 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24517 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24518 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24519 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24520 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24521 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24522 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24523 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24524 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24525 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24526 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24527 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24528 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24529
24530 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24531 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24532
24533 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24534 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24535 training} groups.
24536
24537 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24538 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24539 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24540 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24541 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24542 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24543 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24544
24545 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24546 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24547 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24548 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24549
24550 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24551 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24552 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24553 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24554 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24555 from the mail server.
24556
24557 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24558 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24559 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24560 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24561
24562 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24563 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24564 @cindex spam filtering
24565 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24566 @cindex spam configuration examples
24567 @cindex spam
24568
24569 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24570
24571 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24572 @example
24573 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24574 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24575 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24576 (spam-initialize)
24577
24578 (setq
24579 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24580 spam-use-BBDB t
24581 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24582 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24583 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24584 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24585 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24586 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24587 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24588 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24589 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24590 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24591 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24592 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24593 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24594 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24595 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24596 (any "ding" "ding")
24597 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24598 (: spam-split)
24599 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24600 "mail"))
24601
24602 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24603
24604 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24605 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24606 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24607 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24608
24609 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24610
24611 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24612 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24613 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24614 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24615 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24616
24617 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24618 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24619
24620 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24621
24622 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24623 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24624
24625 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24626 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24627 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24628
24629 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24630
24631 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24632 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24633
24634 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24635 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24636 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24637 (ham-marks
24638 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24639 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24640 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24641 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24642
24643 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24644 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24645 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24646
24647 @end example
24648
24649 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24650 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24651
24652 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24653 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24654 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24655 i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24656 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24657 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24658 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24659 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24660 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24661
24662 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24663 does most of the job for me:
24664
24665 @lisp
24666 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24667 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24668 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24669 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24670 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24671 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24672 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24673 @end lisp
24674
24675 @itemize
24676
24677 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24678
24679 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24680 (i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24681 bogofilter or DCC).
24682
24683 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24684 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24685 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24686 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24687 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24688 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24689 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24690
24691 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24692 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24693 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
24694 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24695 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24696 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24697
24698 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24699
24700 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24701 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24702 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24703 @samp{training.spam}.
24704 @end itemize
24705
24706 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24707
24708 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24709
24710 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24711 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24712 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24713
24714 @lisp
24715 ("^gmane\\."
24716 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24717 @end lisp
24718
24719 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24720 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24721 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
24722 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24723 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24724
24725 @node Spam Back Ends
24726 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24727 @cindex spam back ends
24728
24729 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24730 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24731 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24732 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24733 Processors}).
24734
24735 @menu
24736 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24737 * BBDB Whitelists::
24738 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24739 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24740 * Blackholes::
24741 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24742 * Bogofilter::
24743 * SpamAssassin back end::
24744 * ifile spam filtering::
24745 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24746 * SpamOracle::
24747 @end menu
24748
24749 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24750 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24751 @cindex spam filtering
24752 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24753 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24754 @cindex spam
24755
24756 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24757
24758 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24759 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24760 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24761 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24762 be spammers.
24763
24764 @end defvar
24765
24766 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24767
24768 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24769 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24770 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24771 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24772 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24773
24774 @end defvar
24775
24776 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24777
24778 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24779 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24780 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24781
24782 @end defvar
24783
24784 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24785
24786 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24787 customizing the group parameters or the
24788 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24789 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24790 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24791
24792 @emph{WARNING}
24793
24794 Instead of the obsolete
24795 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24796 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24797 the same way, we promise.
24798
24799 @end defvar
24800
24801 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24802
24803 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24804 customizing the group parameters or the
24805 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24806 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24807 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24808 whitelist.
24809
24810 @emph{WARNING}
24811
24812 Instead of the obsolete
24813 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24814 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24815 the same way, we promise.
24816
24817 @end defvar
24818
24819 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24820 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24821 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24822 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24823 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24824
24825 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24826 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24827 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24828 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24829
24830 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24831 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24832 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24833 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24834 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24835 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24836
24837 @node BBDB Whitelists
24838 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24839 @cindex spam filtering
24840 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24841 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24842 @cindex spam
24843
24844 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24845
24846 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24847 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24848 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24849 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24850 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24851 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24852 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24853
24854 @end defvar
24855
24856 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24857
24858 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24859 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24860 unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
24861 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24862 classified as spammers.
24863
24864 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24865 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24866 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24867 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24868 will be exclusive.
24869
24870 @end defvar
24871
24872 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24873
24874 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24875 customizing the group parameters or the
24876 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24877 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24878 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24879 BBDB.
24880
24881 @emph{WARNING}
24882
24883 Instead of the obsolete
24884 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24885 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24886 the same way, we promise.
24887
24888 @end defvar
24889
24890 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24891 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24892 @cindex spam reporting
24893 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24894 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24895 @cindex spam
24896
24897 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24898
24899 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24900 customizing the group parameters or the
24901 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24902 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24903 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24904 HTTP request.
24905
24906 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24907
24908 @emph{WARNING}
24909
24910 Instead of the obsolete
24911 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24912 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24913 same way, we promise.
24914
24915 @end defvar
24916
24917 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24918
24919 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24920 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24921 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24922 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24923 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24924
24925 @end defvar
24926
24927 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24928
24929 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24930 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24931 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24932
24933 @end defvar
24934
24935 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24936 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24937 @cindex spam filtering
24938 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24939 @cindex spam
24940
24941 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24942
24943 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24944 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24945 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24946 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24947 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24948 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24949
24950 @end defvar
24951
24952 @node Blackholes
24953 @subsubsection Blackholes
24954 @cindex spam filtering
24955 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24956 @cindex spam
24957
24958 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24959
24960 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24961 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24962 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24963 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24964 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24965 contains outdated servers.
24966
24967 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24968 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24969 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24970 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24971 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24972 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24973
24974 @end defvar
24975
24976 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24977
24978 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24979
24980 @end defvar
24981
24982 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24983
24984 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24985 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24986
24987 @end defvar
24988
24989 @defvar spam-use-dig
24990
24991 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24992 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24993
24994 @end defvar
24995
24996 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24997 ham processor for blackholes.
24998
24999 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
25000 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
25001 @cindex spam filtering
25002 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
25003 @cindex spam
25004
25005 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
25006
25007 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
25008 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
25009 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
25010 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
25011 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
25012 message is spam or ham, respectively.
25013
25014 @end defvar
25015
25016 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
25017
25018 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25019 the message, positively identify it as spam.
25020
25021 @end defvar
25022
25023 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25024
25025 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25026 the message, positively identify it as ham.
25027
25028 @end defvar
25029
25030 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25031 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25032
25033 @node Bogofilter
25034 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25035 @cindex spam filtering
25036 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25037 @cindex spam
25038
25039 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25040
25041 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25042 speedy Bogofilter.
25043
25044 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25045 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25046 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25047 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25048 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25049 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25050
25051 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25052 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25053 documentation.
25054
25055 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25056 processing will be turned off.
25057
25058 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25059
25060 @end defvar
25061
25062 @table @kbd
25063 @item M s t
25064 @itemx S t
25065 @kindex M s t
25066 @kindex S t
25067 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25068 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25069 @end table
25070
25071 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25072
25073 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25074 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25075 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25076 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25077 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25078 installation documents for details.
25079
25080 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25081
25082 @end defvar
25083
25084 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25085 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25086 customizing the group parameters or the
25087 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25088 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25089 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25090
25091 @emph{WARNING}
25092
25093 Instead of the obsolete
25094 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25095 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25096 the same way, we promise.
25097 @end defvar
25098
25099 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25100 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25101 customizing the group parameters or the
25102 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25103 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25104 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25105 of non-spam messages.
25106
25107 @emph{WARNING}
25108
25109 Instead of the obsolete
25110 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25111 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25112 the same way, we promise.
25113 @end defvar
25114
25115 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25116
25117 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25118 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25119 database directory.
25120
25121 @end defvar
25122
25123 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25124 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25125 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25126 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25127 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25128 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25129
25130 @node SpamAssassin back end
25131 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25132 @cindex spam filtering
25133 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25134 @cindex spam
25135
25136 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25137
25138 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25139
25140 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25141 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25142 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25143 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25144 mode.
25145
25146 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25147 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25148 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25149 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25150 instead.
25151
25152 You should not enable this if you use
25153 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25154
25155 @end defvar
25156
25157 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25158
25159 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25160 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25161
25162 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25163
25164 @end defvar
25165
25166 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25167
25168 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25169 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25170 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25171 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25172
25173 @end defvar
25174
25175 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25176 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25177 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25178 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25179 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25180 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25181 to test this functionality.
25182
25183 @node ifile spam filtering
25184 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25185 @cindex spam filtering
25186 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25187 @cindex spam
25188
25189 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25190
25191 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25192 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25193
25194 @end defvar
25195
25196 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25197
25198 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25199 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25200 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25201
25202 @end defvar
25203
25204 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25205
25206 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25207 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25208 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25209 @end defvar
25210
25211 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25212
25213 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25214 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25215
25216 @end defvar
25217
25218 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25219 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25220 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25221 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25222 functionality.
25223
25224 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25225 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25226 @cindex spam filtering
25227 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25228 @cindex spam-stat
25229 @cindex spam
25230
25231 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25232 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25233 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25234 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25235 spam-stat dictionary}.
25236
25237 @defvar spam-use-stat
25238
25239 @end defvar
25240
25241 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25242 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25243 customizing the group parameters or the
25244 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25245 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25246 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25247
25248 @emph{WARNING}
25249
25250 Instead of the obsolete
25251 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25252 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25253 the same way, we promise.
25254 @end defvar
25255
25256 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25257 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25258 customizing the group parameters or the
25259 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25260 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25261 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25262 of non-spam messages.
25263
25264 @emph{WARNING}
25265
25266 Instead of the obsolete
25267 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25268 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25269 the same way, we promise.
25270 @end defvar
25271
25272 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25273 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25274 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25275 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25276 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25277
25278 @node SpamOracle
25279 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25280 @cindex spam filtering
25281 @cindex SpamOracle
25282 @cindex spam
25283
25284 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25285 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25286 installed separately.
25287
25288 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25289 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25290 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25291 mail as a spam mail or not.
25292
25293 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25294 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25295 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25296
25297 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25298 call SpamOracle.
25299
25300 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25301 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25302 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25303 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25304 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25305 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25306 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25307 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25308
25309 @example
25310 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25311 spam-split-group "Junk"
25312 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25313 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25314 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25315 @end example
25316
25317 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25318 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25319 SpamOracle.
25320 @end defvar
25321
25322 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25323 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25324 user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25325 can be customized.
25326 @end defvar
25327
25328 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25329 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25330 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25331 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25332 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25333 database to live somewhere special, set
25334 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25335 @end defvar
25336
25337 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25338 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25339 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25340 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25341 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25342 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25343 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25344 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25345 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25346 @xref{Spam Package}.
25347
25348 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25349 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25350 customizing the group parameter or the
25351 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25352 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25353 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25354
25355 @emph{WARNING}
25356
25357 Instead of the obsolete
25358 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25359 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25360 the same way, we promise.
25361 @end defvar
25362
25363 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25364 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25365 customizing the group parameter or the
25366 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25367 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25368 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25369 messages.
25370
25371 @emph{WARNING}
25372
25373 Instead of the obsolete
25374 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25375 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25376 the same way, we promise.
25377 @end defvar
25378
25379 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25380 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25381 messages.
25382 @example
25383 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25384 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25385 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25386 @end example
25387 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25388 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25389 (e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25390 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25391 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25392 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25393
25394 @node Extending the Spam package
25395 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25396 @cindex spam filtering
25397 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25398 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25399
25400 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25401 incoming mail, provide the following:
25402
25403 @enumerate
25404
25405 @item
25406 Code
25407
25408 @lisp
25409 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25410 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25411 @end lisp
25412
25413 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25414
25415 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25416 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25417 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25418 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25419 register/unregister spam and ham.
25420
25421 @item
25422 Functionality
25423
25424 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25425 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25426 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25427 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25428 why you aren't.
25429
25430 @end enumerate
25431
25432 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25433
25434 @enumerate
25435
25436 @item
25437 Code
25438
25439 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25440 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25441
25442 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25443 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25444 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25445 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25446
25447 @lisp
25448 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25449 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25450 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25451
25452 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25453 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25454 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25455
25456 @end lisp
25457
25458 @item
25459 Gnus parameters
25460
25461 Add
25462 @lisp
25463 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25464 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25465 @end lisp
25466 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25467 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25468 variable customization.
25469
25470 Add
25471 @lisp
25472 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25473 @end lisp
25474 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25475 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25476
25477 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25478 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25479
25480
25481 @enumerate
25482
25483 @item
25484 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25485
25486 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25487 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25488 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25489
25490 @item
25491 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25492
25493 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25494 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25495 such a back end.
25496
25497 @item
25498 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25499
25500 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25501 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25502 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25503 back ends.
25504
25505 @item
25506 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25507
25508 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25509 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25510 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25511
25512 @item
25513 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25514
25515 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25516 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25517 set up this way.
25518
25519 @item
25520 @code{spam-install-backend}
25521
25522 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25523 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25524 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25525
25526 @item
25527 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25528
25529 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25530 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25531 never install such a back end.
25532 @end enumerate
25533
25534 @end enumerate
25535
25536 @node Spam Statistics Package
25537 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25538 @cindex Paul Graham
25539 @cindex Graham, Paul
25540 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25541 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25542 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25543
25544 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25545 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25546 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25547 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25548 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25549 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25550 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25551 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25552 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25553 or not.
25554
25555 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25556 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25557 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25558 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25559 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25560 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25561 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25562 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25563
25564 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25565 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25566 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25567
25568 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25569 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25570 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25571 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25572 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25573
25574 @menu
25575 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25576 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25577 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25578 @end menu
25579
25580 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25581 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25582
25583 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25584 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25585 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25586 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25587 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25588
25589 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25590 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25591 per mail. Use the following:
25592
25593 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25594 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25595 is treated as one spam mail.
25596 @end defun
25597
25598 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25599 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25600 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25601 @end defun
25602
25603 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25604 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25605 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25606 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25607 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25608 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25609
25610 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25611 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25612 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25613 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25614 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25615
25616 @defvar spam-stat
25617 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25618 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25619 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25620 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25621 @end defvar
25622
25623 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25624 reset the dictionary.
25625
25626 @defun spam-stat-reset
25627 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25628 @end defun
25629
25630 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25631 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25632 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25633 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25634 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25635 only non-spam mails.
25636
25637 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25638 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25639 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25640 @end defun
25641
25642 @defun spam-stat-save
25643 Save the dictionary.
25644 @end defun
25645
25646 @defvar spam-stat-file
25647 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25648 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25649 @end defvar
25650
25651 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25652 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25653
25654 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25655 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25656
25657 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25658
25659 @lisp
25660 (require 'spam-stat)
25661 (spam-stat-load)
25662 @end lisp
25663
25664 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25665 created.
25666
25667 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25668 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25669 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25670 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25671
25672 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25673 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25674 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25675 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25676
25677 @lisp
25678 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25679 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25680 "mail.misc"))
25681 @end lisp
25682
25683 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25684 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25685 @end defvar
25686
25687 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25688 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25689 expression are considered potential spam.
25690
25691 @lisp
25692 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25693 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25694 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25695 "mail.misc"))
25696 @end lisp
25697
25698 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25699 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25700 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25701 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25702 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25703
25704 @lisp
25705 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25706 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25707 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25708 "mail.misc"))
25709 @end lisp
25710
25711 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25712 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25713 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25714 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25715 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25716 dictionary!
25717
25718 @lisp
25719 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25720 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25721 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25722 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25723 "mail.misc"))
25724 @end lisp
25725
25726
25727 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25728 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25729
25730 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25731
25732 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25733 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25734 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25735 @end defun
25736
25737 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25738 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25739 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25740 @end defun
25741
25742 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25743 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25744 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25745 already been processed as non-spam.
25746 @end defun
25747
25748 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25749 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25750 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25751 been processed as spam.
25752 @end defun
25753
25754 @defun spam-stat-save
25755 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25756 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25757 @end defun
25758
25759 @defun spam-stat-load
25760 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25761 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25762 @end defun
25763
25764 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25765 Return the spam score for a word.
25766 @end defun
25767
25768 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25769 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25770 @end defun
25771
25772 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25773 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25774 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25775 @end defun
25776
25777 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25778 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25779
25780 @lisp
25781 (require 'spam-stat)
25782 (spam-stat-load)
25783 @end lisp
25784
25785 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25786
25787 @smallexample
25788 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25789 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25790 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25791 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25792 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25793 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25794 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25795 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25796 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25797 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25798 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25799 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25800 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25801 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25802 @end smallexample
25803
25804 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25805
25806 @smallexample
25807 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25808 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25809 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25810 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25811 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25812 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25813 @end smallexample
25814
25815 @node The Gnus Registry
25816 @section The Gnus Registry
25817 @cindex registry
25818 @cindex split
25819 @cindex track
25820
25821 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25822 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25823 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25824 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25825 features are pretty cool.
25826
25827 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25828 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25829
25830 @enumerate
25831 @item
25832 Split messages to their parent
25833
25834 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25835 the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
25836 available.
25837
25838 @item
25839 Refer to messages by ID
25840
25841 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25842 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25843 of the group the message is in.
25844
25845 @item
25846 Store custom flags and keywords
25847
25848 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25849 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25850 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25851 etc. backends.
25852
25853 @item
25854 Store arbitrary data
25855
25856 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25857 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25858 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25859 @end enumerate
25860
25861 @menu
25862 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25863 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25864 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25865 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25866 * Store arbitrary data::
25867 @end menu
25868
25869 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25870 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25871
25872 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25873
25874 @lisp
25875 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25876
25877 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25878 @end lisp
25879
25880 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25881 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
25882 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.)@: so
25883 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25884 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25885
25886 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25887 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25888
25889 @lisp
25890 (setq
25891 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25892 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25893 ("nnrss" t)
25894 ("spam" t)
25895 ("train" t))
25896 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25897 ;; this is the default
25898 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25899 @end lisp
25900
25901 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25902 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25903 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25904 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25905 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25906 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25907
25908 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25909 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25910 the general settings.
25911
25912 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25913 The groups that will not be followed by
25914 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25915 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25916 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25917 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25918 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25919 @end defvar
25920
25921 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25922 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25923 registry will keep.
25924 @end defvar
25925
25926 @defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25927 The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25928 the registry will keep after pruning.
25929 @end defvar
25930
25931 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
25932 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25933 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25934 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
25935 @end defvar
25936
25937 @node Registry Article Refer Method
25938 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25939
25940 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25941 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25942 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25943 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25944
25945 @vindex nnregistry
25946 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25947
25948 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25949 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25950 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25951 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25952 lines:
25953
25954 @example
25955 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25956 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25957 ;; knows where the article is.
25958 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25959
25960 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25961
25962 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
25963 '(current
25964 (nnregistry)
25965 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
25966 @end example
25967
25968 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
25969 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
25970 all else fails, using Gmane.
25971
25972 @node Fancy splitting to parent
25973 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
25974
25975 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
25976
25977 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
25978 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
25979 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
25980 strategy.
25981
25982 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
25983 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
25984 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
25985 have to put a rule like this:
25986
25987 @lisp
25988 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
25989
25990 ;; split to parent: you need this
25991 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
25992
25993 ;; other rules, as an example
25994 (: spam-split)
25995 ;; default mailbox
25996 "mail")
25997 @end lisp
25998
25999 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
26000 following variables.
26001
26002 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
26003 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
26004 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender)}, which
26005 may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large and
26006 people don't stick to the same groups.
26007 @end defvar
26008
26009 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
26010 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
26011 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
26012 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
26013 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
26014 works best.
26015 @end defvar
26016
26017 @node Store custom flags and keywords
26018 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
26019
26020 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
26021 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
26022 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26023
26024 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
26025 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26026 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26027 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26028 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26029 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26030
26031 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26032 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26033 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26034 letter.
26035 @end defvar
26036
26037 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26038 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26039 will offer the available marks for completion.
26040 @end defun
26041
26042 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26043 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26044 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26045 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26046
26047 @lisp
26048 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26049 ;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
26050 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
26051
26052 ;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
26053 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26054 @end lisp
26055
26056
26057 @node Store arbitrary data
26058 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26059
26060 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26061 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26062 storage).
26063
26064 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26065 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26066 @end defun
26067
26068 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26069 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26070 @end defun
26071
26072 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26073 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26074 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26075 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26076 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26077 precious.
26078 @end defvar
26079
26080 @node Other modes
26081 @section Interaction with other modes
26082
26083 @subsection Dired
26084 @cindex dired
26085
26086 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26087 buffers. It is enabled with
26088 @lisp
26089 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26090 @end lisp
26091
26092 @table @kbd
26093 @item C-c C-m C-a
26094 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26095 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26096 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26097 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26098
26099 @item C-c C-m C-l
26100 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26101 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26102 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26103 buffer.
26104
26105 @item C-c C-m C-p
26106 @findex gnus-dired-print
26107 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26108 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26109 @end table
26110
26111 @node Various Various
26112 @section Various Various
26113 @cindex mode lines
26114 @cindex highlights
26115
26116 @table @code
26117
26118 @item gnus-home-directory
26119 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26120 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26121 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26122
26123 @item gnus-directory
26124 @vindex gnus-directory
26125 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26126 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26127 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26128
26129 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26130 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26131 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26132 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26133
26134 @item gnus-default-directory
26135 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26136 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26137 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26138 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26139 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26140 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26141 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26142
26143 @item gnus-verbose
26144 @vindex gnus-verbose
26145 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26146 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26147 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26148 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26149 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26150
26151 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26152 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26153 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26154 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26155
26156 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26157 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26158 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26159 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26160 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26161 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26162 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26163 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26164 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26165 displayed in the echo area.
26166
26167 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26168 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26169 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26170 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26171 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26172 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26173 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26174 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26175 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26176 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26177
26178 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26179 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26180 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26181 read when doing the operation described above.
26182
26183 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26184 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26185 @cindex file names
26186 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26187 @cindex characters in file names
26188 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26189 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26190 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26191
26192 @lisp
26193 @group
26194 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26195 '((?: . ?_)))
26196 @end group
26197 @end lisp
26198
26199 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26200 Windows (phooey) systems.
26201
26202 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26203 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26204 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26205 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26206 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26207
26208 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26209 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26210 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26211 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26212 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26213
26214 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26215 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26216 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26217
26218 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26219 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26220
26221 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26222 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26223 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26224 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26225 group).
26226
26227 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26228
26229 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26230 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26231 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26232 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26233 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26234 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26235 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26236 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26237 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26238
26239 @end table
26240
26241 @node The End
26242 @chapter The End
26243
26244 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26245 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26246
26247 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26248
26249 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26250
26251 @quotation
26252 @strong{Te Deum}
26253
26254 @sp 1
26255 Not because of victories @*
26256 I sing,@*
26257 having none,@*
26258 but for the common sunshine,@*
26259 the breeze,@*
26260 the largess of the spring.
26261
26262 @sp 1
26263 Not for victory@*
26264 but for the day's work done@*
26265 as well as I was able;@*
26266 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26267 but at the common table.@*
26268 @end quotation
26269
26270
26271 @node Appendices
26272 @chapter Appendices
26273
26274 @menu
26275 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26276 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26277 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26278 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26279 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26280 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26281 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26282 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26283 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26284 @end menu
26285
26286
26287 @node XEmacs
26288 @section XEmacs
26289 @cindex XEmacs
26290 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26291
26292 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26293 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26294 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26295 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26296 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26297 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26298
26299
26300 @node History
26301 @section History
26302
26303 @cindex history
26304 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26305 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26306
26307 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26308 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26309 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26310 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26311 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26312
26313 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26314 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26315 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26316 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26317 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26318 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26319
26320 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26321 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26322 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26323 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26324
26325 @menu
26326 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26327 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26328 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26329 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26330 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26331 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26332 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26333 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26334 @end menu
26335
26336
26337 @node Gnus Versions
26338 @subsection Gnus Versions
26339 @cindex ding Gnus
26340 @cindex September Gnus
26341 @cindex Red Gnus
26342 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26343 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26344 @cindex Oort Gnus
26345 @cindex No Gnus
26346 @cindex Ma Gnus
26347 @cindex Gnus versions
26348
26349 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26350 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26351 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26352
26353 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26354 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26355
26356 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26357 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26358
26359 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26360 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26361
26362 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26363 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26364 1999.
26365
26366 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26367 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26368
26369 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26370
26371 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26372 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26373 with the information when possible).
26374
26375 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26376
26377 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26378 Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26379 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
26380 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26381 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26382 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26383 that instead.
26384
26385
26386 @node Why?
26387 @subsection Why?
26388
26389 What's the point of Gnus?
26390
26391 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26392 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26393 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26394 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26395 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26396 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26397 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26398 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26399 keep track of millions of people who post?
26400
26401 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26402 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26403 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26404 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26405 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26406 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26407 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26408 every one of you to explore and invent.
26409
26410 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26411 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26412
26413
26414 @node Compatibility
26415 @subsection Compatibility
26416
26417 @cindex compatibility
26418 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26419 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26420 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26421
26422 Our motto is:
26423 @quotation
26424 @cartouche
26425 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26426 @end cartouche
26427 @end quotation
26428
26429 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26430 their names.
26431
26432 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26433 Articles}.
26434
26435 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26436 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26437 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26438 important variables have their values copied into their global
26439 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26440 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26441
26442 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26443 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26444 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26445 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26446 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26447 peculiar results.
26448
26449 @cindex hilit19
26450 @cindex highlighting
26451 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26452 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26453 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26454 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26455 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26456 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26457 Away!
26458
26459 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26460 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26461 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26462 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26463
26464 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26465 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26466 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26467 to stop doing it the old way.
26468
26469 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26470
26471 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26472 @findex gnus-bug
26473 @cindex reporting bugs
26474 @cindex bugs
26475 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26476 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26477 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26478
26479 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26480 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26481 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26482 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26483 up at you.
26484
26485
26486 @node Conformity
26487 @subsection Conformity
26488
26489 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26490 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26491 with, of course.
26492
26493 @table @strong
26494
26495 @item RFC (2)822
26496 @cindex RFC 822
26497 @cindex RFC 2822
26498 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26499
26500 @item RFC 1036
26501 @cindex RFC 1036
26502 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26503
26504 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26505 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26506 We do have some breaches to this one.
26507
26508 @table @emph
26509
26510 @item X-Newsreader
26511 @itemx User-Agent
26512 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26513 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26514 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26515 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26516 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26517 @end table
26518
26519 @item USEFOR
26520 @cindex USEFOR
26521 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26522 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26523 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26524 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26525
26526 @item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
26527 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26528 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26529
26530 @item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
26531 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26532
26533 @item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26534 @cindex RFC 1991
26535 @cindex RFC 2440
26536 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26537 published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26538 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26539 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26540 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26541 decryption).
26542
26543 @item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
26544 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26545 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26546 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26547
26548 @item S/MIME---RFC 2633
26549 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26550
26551 @item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26552 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26553 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26554 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26555 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26556 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26557 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26558 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26559
26560 @end table
26561
26562 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26563 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26564 know.
26565
26566
26567 @node Emacsen
26568 @subsection Emacsen
26569 @cindex Emacsen
26570 @cindex XEmacs
26571 @cindex Mule
26572 @cindex Emacs
26573
26574 This version of Gnus should work on:
26575
26576 @itemize @bullet
26577
26578 @item
26579 Emacs 21.1 and up.
26580
26581 @item
26582 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26583
26584 @end itemize
26585
26586 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26587 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26588 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26589 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26590
26591 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26592 @c synced here!
26593
26594 @node Gnus Development
26595 @subsection Gnus Development
26596
26597 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26598 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26599 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26600 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26601 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26602 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26603 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26604 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26605
26606 After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26607 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26608 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26609 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26610 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26611 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26612 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26613 in Emacs.
26614
26615 @cindex Incoming*
26616 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26617 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26618 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26619 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26620 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26621
26622 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26623 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26624 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26625 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26626 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26627 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26628 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26629 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26630 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26631 can't be assumed to do so.
26632
26633 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26634 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26635 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26636
26637 @cindex Incoming*
26638 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26639 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26640 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26641 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26642 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26643
26644 @node Contributors
26645 @subsection Contributors
26646 @cindex contributors
26647
26648 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26649 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26650 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26651 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26652 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26653 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26654 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26655 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26656 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26657 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26658
26659 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26660 wrong show.
26661
26662 @itemize @bullet
26663
26664 @item
26665 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26666
26667 @item
26668 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26669 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26670 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26671 functionality and stuff.
26672
26673 @item
26674 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26675 well as numerous other things).
26676
26677 @item
26678 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26679
26680 @item
26681 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26682
26683 @item
26684 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26685
26686 @item
26687 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26688
26689 @item
26690 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26691 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26692
26693 @item
26694 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26695
26696 @item
26697 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26698
26699 @item
26700 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26701
26702 @item
26703 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26704
26705 @item
26706 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26707
26708 @item
26709 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26710
26711 @item
26712 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26713 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26714
26715 @item
26716 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26717
26718 @item
26719 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26720
26721 @item
26722 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26723
26724 @item
26725 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26726 .newsrc files.
26727
26728 @item
26729 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26730
26731 @item
26732 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26733
26734 @item
26735 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26736
26737 @item
26738 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26739 well as autoconf support.
26740
26741 @end itemize
26742
26743 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26744 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26745
26746 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26747
26748 Christopher Davis,
26749 Andrew Eskilsson,
26750 Kai Grossjohann,
26751 Kevin Greiner,
26752 Jesper Harder,
26753 Paul Jarc,
26754 Simon Josefsson,
26755 David K@aa{}gedal,
26756 Richard Pieri,
26757 Fabrice Popineau,
26758 Daniel Quinlan,
26759 Michael Shields,
26760 Reiner Steib,
26761 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26762 Jack Vinson,
26763 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26764 and
26765 Teodor Zlatanov.
26766
26767 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26768
26769 Jari Aalto,
26770 Adrian Aichner,
26771 Vladimir Alexiev,
26772 Russ Allbery,
26773 Peter Arius,
26774 Matt Armstrong,
26775 Marc Auslander,
26776 Miles Bader,
26777 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26778 Frank Bennett,
26779 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26780 Chris Bone,
26781 Mark Borges,
26782 Mark Boyns,
26783 Lance A. Brown,
26784 Rob Browning,
26785 Kees de Bruin,
26786 Martin Buchholz,
26787 Joe Buehler,
26788 Kevin Buhr,
26789 Alastair Burt,
26790 Joao Cachopo,
26791 Zlatko Calusic,
26792 Massimo Campostrini,
26793 Castor,
26794 David Charlap,
26795 Dan Christensen,
26796 Kevin Christian,
26797 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26798 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26799 Laura Conrad,
26800 Michael R. Cook,
26801 Glenn Coombs,
26802 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26803 Neil Crellin,
26804 Frank D. Cringle,
26805 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26806 Andre Deparade,
26807 Ulrik Dickow,
26808 Dave Disser,
26809 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26810 Joev Dubach,
26811 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26812 Dave Edmondson,
26813 Paul Eggert,
26814 Mark W. Eichin,
26815 Karl Eichwalder,
26816 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26817 Michael Ernst,
26818 Luc Van Eycken,
26819 Sam Falkner,
26820 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26821 Sigbjorn Finne,
26822 Sven Fischer,
26823 Paul Fisher,
26824 Decklin Foster,
26825 Gary D. Foster,
26826 Paul Franklin,
26827 Guy Geens,
26828 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26829 David S. Goldberg,
26830 Michelangelo Grigni,
26831 Dale Hagglund,
26832 D. Hall,
26833 Magnus Hammerin,
26834 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26835 Raja R. Harinath,
26836 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26837 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26838 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26839 Scott Hofmann,
26840 Tassilo Horn,
26841 Marc Horowitz,
26842 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26843 Richard Hoskins,
26844 Brad Howes,
26845 Miguel de Icaza,
26846 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
26847 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26848 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26849 Lee Iverson,
26850 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26851 Rajappa Iyer,
26852 Andreas Jaeger,
26853 Adam P. Jenkins,
26854 Randell Jesup,
26855 Fred Johansen,
26856 Gareth Jones,
26857 Greg Klanderman,
26858 Karl Kleinpaste,
26859 Michael Klingbeil,
26860 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26861 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26862 Petr Konecny,
26863 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26864 Thor Kristoffersen,
26865 Jens Lautenbacher,
26866 Martin Larose,
26867 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26868 Joerg Lenneis,
26869 Carsten Leonhardt,
26870 James LewisMoss,
26871 Christian Limpach,
26872 Markus Linnala,
26873 Dave Love,
26874 Mike McEwan,
26875 Tonny Madsen,
26876 Shlomo Mahlab,
26877 Nat Makarevitch,
26878 Istvan Marko,
26879 David Martin,
26880 Jason R. Mastaler,
26881 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26882 Timo Metzemakers,
26883 Richard Mlynarik,
26884 Lantz Moore,
26885 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26886 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26887 Hrvoje Niksic,
26888 Andy Norman,
26889 Fred Oberhauser,
26890 C. R. Oldham,
26891 Alexandre Oliva,
26892 Ken Olstad,
26893 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26894 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26895 Ettore Perazzoli,
26896 William Perry,
26897 Stephen Peters,
26898 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26899 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26900 Matt Pharr,
26901 Andy Piper,
26902 John McClary Prevost,
26903 Bill Pringlemeir,
26904 Mike Pullen,
26905 Jim Radford,
26906 Colin Rafferty,
26907 Lasse Rasinen,
26908 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26909 Joe Reiss,
26910 Renaud Rioboo,
26911 Roland B. Roberts,
26912 Bart Robinson,
26913 Christian von Roques,
26914 Markus Rost,
26915 Jason Rumney,
26916 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26917 Jay Sachs,
26918 Dewey M. Sasser,
26919 Conrad Sauerwald,
26920 Loren Schall,
26921 Dan Schmidt,
26922 Ralph Schleicher,
26923 Philippe Schnoebelen,
26924 Andreas Schwab,
26925 Randal L. Schwartz,
26926 Danny Siu,
26927 Matt Simmons,
26928 Paul D. Smith,
26929 Jeff Sparkes,
26930 Toby Speight,
26931 Michael Sperber,
26932 Darren Stalder,
26933 Richard Stallman,
26934 Greg Stark,
26935 Sam Steingold,
26936 Paul Stevenson,
26937 Jonas Steverud,
26938 Paul Stodghill,
26939 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26940 Kurt Swanson,
26941 Samuel Tardieu,
26942 Teddy,
26943 Chuck Thompson,
26944 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26945 Philippe Troin,
26946 James Troup,
26947 Trung Tran-Duc,
26948 Jack Twilley,
26949 Aaron M. Ucko,
26950 Aki Vehtari,
26951 Didier Verna,
26952 Vladimir Volovich,
26953 Jan Vroonhof,
26954 Stefan Waldherr,
26955 Pete Ware,
26956 Barry A. Warsaw,
26957 Christoph Wedler,
26958 Joe Wells,
26959 Lee Willis,
26960 and
26961 Lloyd Zusman.
26962
26963
26964 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
26965 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
26966 (550kB and counting).
26967
26968 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
26969 sure.
26970
26971 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
26972 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
26973
26974
26975 @node New Features
26976 @subsection New Features
26977 @cindex new features
26978
26979 @menu
26980 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
26981 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
26982 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
26983 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
26984 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
26985 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
26986 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
26987 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
26988 @end menu
26989
26990 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
26991 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
26992 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
26993
26994 @node ding Gnus
26995 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
26996
26997 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
26998
26999 @itemize @bullet
27000
27001 @item
27002 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
27003 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
27004
27005 @item
27006 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
27007 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
27008
27009 @item
27010 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
27011
27012 @item
27013 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
27014 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
27015 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
27016
27017 @item
27018 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
27019 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
27020 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
27021 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27022
27023 @item
27024 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27025 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27026
27027 @item
27028 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27029 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27030 (@pxref{The Active File}).
27031
27032 @item
27033 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27034 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27035
27036 @item
27037 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27038 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27039 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27040
27041 @item
27042 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27043 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27044 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27045
27046 @item
27047 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27048 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27049
27050 @item
27051 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27052 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27053
27054 @item
27055 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27056 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27057
27058 @item
27059 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27060 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27061
27062 @item
27063 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27064 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27065
27066 @item
27067 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27068
27069 @item
27070 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27071 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27072
27073 @item
27074 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27075 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27076
27077 @item
27078 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27079 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27080
27081 @item
27082 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27083
27084 @item
27085 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27086 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27087
27088 @item
27089 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27090 Articles}).
27091
27092 @item
27093 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27094 Buttons}).
27095
27096 @item
27097 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27098 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27099
27100 @end itemize
27101
27102
27103 @node September Gnus
27104 @subsubsection September Gnus
27105
27106 @iftex
27107 @iflatex
27108 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27109 @end iflatex
27110 @end iftex
27111
27112 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27113
27114 @itemize @bullet
27115
27116 @item
27117 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27118 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27119 now obsolete.
27120
27121 @item
27122 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27123 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27124 Threading}).
27125
27126 @lisp
27127 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27128 @end lisp
27129
27130 @item
27131 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27132 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27133
27134 @item
27135 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27136 referred.
27137
27138 @item
27139 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27140
27141 @item
27142 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27143
27144 @item
27145 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27146
27147 @lisp
27148 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27149 @end lisp
27150
27151 @item
27152 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27153 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27154
27155 @lisp
27156 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27157 @end lisp
27158
27159 @item
27160 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27161 Groups}).
27162
27163 @item
27164 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27165 Topics}).
27166
27167 @lisp
27168 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27169 @end lisp
27170
27171 @item
27172 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27173
27174 @item
27175 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27176 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27177
27178 @lisp
27179 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27180 @end lisp
27181
27182 @item
27183 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27184 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27185
27186 @item
27187 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27188
27189 @item
27190 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27191 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27192 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27193
27194 @item
27195 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27196
27197 @item
27198 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27199
27200 @item
27201 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27202 Groups}).
27203
27204 @item
27205 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27206 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27207
27208 @item
27209 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27210 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27211
27212 @item
27213 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27214 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27215
27216 @item
27217 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27218 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27219 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27220
27221 @item
27222 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27223 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27224
27225 @item
27226 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27227
27228 @item
27229 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27230
27231 @item
27232 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27233
27234 @item
27235 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27236
27237 @item
27238 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27239 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27240
27241 @item
27242 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27243 Layout}).
27244
27245 @item
27246 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27247 @iftex
27248 @iflatex
27249 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27250 @end iflatex
27251 @end iftex
27252
27253 @item
27254 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27255
27256 @lisp
27257 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27258 @end lisp
27259
27260 @item
27261 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27262
27263 @item
27264 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27265
27266 @item
27267 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27268 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27269
27270 @lisp
27271 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27272 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27273 @end lisp
27274
27275 @item
27276 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27277 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27278
27279 @lisp
27280 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27281 @end lisp
27282
27283 @item
27284 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27285 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27286
27287 @item
27288 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27289
27290 @item
27291 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27292 Articles}).
27293
27294 @lisp
27295 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27296 @end lisp
27297
27298 @item
27299 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27300 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27301
27302 @lisp
27303 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27304 @end lisp
27305
27306 @item
27307 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27308 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27309
27310 @item
27311 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27312 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27313
27314 @lisp
27315 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27316 @end lisp
27317
27318 @item
27319 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27320
27321 @item
27322 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27323
27324 @item
27325 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27326
27327 @end itemize
27328
27329
27330 @node Red Gnus
27331 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27332
27333 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27334
27335 @iftex
27336 @iflatex
27337 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27338 @end iflatex
27339 @end iftex
27340
27341 @itemize @bullet
27342
27343 @item
27344 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27345
27346 @item
27347 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27348 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27349
27350 @item
27351 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27352 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27353 Scoring}).
27354
27355 @item
27356 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27357 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27358
27359 @item
27360 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27361
27362 @item
27363 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27364 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27365
27366 @lisp
27367 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27368 @end lisp
27369
27370 @item
27371 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27372 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27373 been added.
27374
27375 @item
27376 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27377 Server Internals}).
27378
27379 @item
27380 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27381 Parameters}).
27382
27383 @item
27384 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27385
27386 @item
27387 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27388 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27389
27390 @item
27391 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27392 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27393 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27394
27395 @item
27396 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27397 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27398
27399 @item
27400 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27401 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27402
27403 @item
27404 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27405 (@pxref{Undo}).
27406
27407 @item
27408 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27409 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27410
27411 @item
27412 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27413 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27414
27415 @lisp
27416 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27417 @end lisp
27418
27419 @item
27420 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27421
27422 @lisp
27423 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27424 @end lisp
27425
27426 @item
27427 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27428 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27429
27430 @item
27431 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27432 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27433
27434 @item
27435 A new command for reading collections of documents
27436 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27437 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27438
27439 @item
27440 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27441 Marks}).
27442
27443 @item
27444 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27445 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27446
27447 @item
27448 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27449 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27450 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27451
27452 @item
27453 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27454 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27455 Sorting}).
27456
27457 @item
27458 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27459 Groups}).
27460
27461 @item
27462 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27463 Commands}).
27464 @iftex
27465 @iflatex
27466 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27467 @end iflatex
27468 @end iftex
27469
27470 @item
27471 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27472 Variables}).
27473
27474 @item
27475 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27476 Mail}).
27477
27478 @item
27479 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27480 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27481
27482 @item
27483 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27484
27485 @end itemize
27486
27487
27488 @node Quassia Gnus
27489 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27490
27491 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27492
27493 @itemize @bullet
27494
27495 @item
27496 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27497 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27498 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27499
27500 @item
27501 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27502 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27503 group, which is created automatically.
27504
27505 @item
27506 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27507 values.
27508
27509 @item
27510 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
27511
27512 @item
27513 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27514 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27515
27516 @item
27517 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27518 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27519
27520 @item
27521 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27522
27523 @item
27524 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27525 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27526
27527 @item
27528 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27529
27530 @item
27531 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27532 details.
27533
27534 @item
27535 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27536 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27537
27538 @item
27539 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27540 control over simplification.
27541
27542 @item
27543 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27544
27545 @item
27546 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27547 limit.
27548
27549 @item
27550 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27551
27552 @item
27553 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27554
27555 @item
27556 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27557 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27558 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27559
27560 @item
27561 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27562 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27563
27564 @item
27565 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27566 text---@kbd{W d}.
27567
27568 @item
27569 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27570 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27571
27572 @item
27573 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27574 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27575
27576 @item
27577 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27578 has been added.
27579
27580 @item
27581 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27582
27583 @item
27584 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27585
27586 @item
27587 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27588 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27589
27590 @item
27591 A new function for citing in Message has been
27592 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27593
27594 @item
27595 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27596
27597 @item
27598 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27599 been added.
27600
27601 @item
27602 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27603 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27604
27605 @item
27606 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27607 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27608
27609 @item
27610 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27611
27612 @item
27613 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27614
27615 @end itemize
27616
27617 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27618 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27619
27620 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27621
27622 @itemize @bullet
27623
27624 @item
27625 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27626 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27627
27628 If you used procmail like in
27629
27630 @lisp
27631 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27632 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27633 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27634 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27635 @end lisp
27636
27637 this now has changed to
27638
27639 @lisp
27640 (setq mail-sources
27641 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27642 :suffix ".in")))
27643 @end lisp
27644
27645 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27646
27647 @item
27648 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27649 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27650
27651 @item
27652 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27653 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27654
27655 @item
27656 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27657 called to position point.
27658
27659 @item
27660 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27661 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27662
27663 @item
27664 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27665 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27666
27667 @item
27668 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27669 subtly different manner.
27670
27671 @item
27672 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27673 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27674 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27675
27676 @item
27677 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27678
27679 @end itemize
27680
27681 @node Oort Gnus
27682 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27683 @cindex Oort Gnus
27684
27685 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27686
27687 @itemize @bullet
27688
27689 @item Installation changes
27690 @c ***********************
27691
27692 @itemize @bullet
27693 @item
27694 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27695
27696 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27697 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27698 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27699 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27700 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27701 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27702 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27703 isn't save in general.
27704
27705 @item
27706 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27707 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27708 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27709 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27710 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27711 remove-installed-shadows}.
27712
27713 @item
27714 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27715
27716 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27717 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27718 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27719 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27720 the second parameter.
27721
27722 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27723 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27724 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27725 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27726 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27727 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27728 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27729 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27730 cycle used under Unix systems.
27731
27732 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27733 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27734
27735 @item
27736 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27737
27738 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27739 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27740 hierarchy.
27741
27742 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27743 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27744 @item
27745 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27746
27747 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27748 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27749 lisp directory into load-path.
27750
27751 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27752 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27753
27754 @end itemize
27755
27756 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27757 @c *****************************************
27758
27759 @itemize @bullet
27760
27761 @item
27762 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27763 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27764
27765 @item
27766 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27767
27768 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27769 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27770
27771 @item
27772 Improved anti-spam features.
27773
27774 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27775 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27776 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27777 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27778 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27779 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27780
27781 @item
27782 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27783
27784 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27785 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27786 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27787 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27788 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27789
27790 @end itemize
27791
27792 @item Changes in group mode
27793 @c ************************
27794
27795 @itemize @bullet
27796
27797 @item
27798 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27799 using @kbd{G M}.
27800
27801 @item
27802 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27803
27804 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27805 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27806
27807 @item
27808 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27809
27810 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27811 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27812 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27813 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27814 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27815 parameters, a'la:
27816 @lisp
27817 (setq gnus-parameters
27818 '(("mail\\..*"
27819 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27820 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27821 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27822 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27823 @end lisp
27824
27825 @item
27826 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27827
27828 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27829 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27830 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27831 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27832 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27833 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27834 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27835 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27836 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27837
27838 @item
27839 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27840
27841 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27842 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27843 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27844
27845 @item
27846 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27847 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27848
27849 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27850 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27851 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27852 @lisp
27853 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27854 @end lisp
27855
27856 @item
27857 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27858 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27859 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27860
27861 @end itemize
27862
27863 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27864 @c **************************************
27865
27866 @itemize @bullet
27867
27868 @item
27869 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27870 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27871 region if the region is active.
27872
27873 @item
27874 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27875 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27876
27877 @item
27878 Article Buttons
27879
27880 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27881 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27882 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27883 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27884
27885 @item
27886 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27887
27888 @item
27889 Picons
27890
27891 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27892 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27893
27894 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27895 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27896 @xref{Picons}.
27897
27898 @item
27899 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27900 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27901
27902 @item
27903 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27904
27905 @item
27906 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27907 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27908
27909 @item
27910 Warn about email replies to news
27911
27912 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27913 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27914 you.
27915
27916 @item
27917 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27918 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27919 built.
27920
27921 @item
27922 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27923 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27924
27925 @item
27926 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27927 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27928
27929 @item
27930 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27931 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27932
27933 @item
27934 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27935
27936 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27937 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27938 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27939 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27940 citations.
27941
27942 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27943 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27944 Outlook (Express) articles.
27945
27946 @item
27947 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27948
27949 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27950 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27951 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27952 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27953
27954 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
27955 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
27956 message cited below.
27957
27958 @item
27959 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc.)@: are now displayed graphically in
27960 Emacs too.
27961
27962 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
27963 disable it.
27964
27965 @item
27966 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
27967
27968 @item
27969 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
27970 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
27971
27972 @item
27973 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
27974
27975 @item
27976 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
27977
27978 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
27979 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
27980 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
27981 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
27982 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
27983 groups.
27984
27985 @item
27986 Deleting of attachments.
27987
27988 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
27989 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
27990 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
27991 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
27992 that support editing.
27993
27994 @item
27995 @code{gnus-default-charset}
27996
27997 The default value is determined from the
27998 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
27999 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
28000 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
28001
28002 @item
28003 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
28004
28005 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
28006 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
28007 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
28008
28009 @item
28010 Extended format specs.
28011
28012 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
28013 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
28014 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
28015 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
28016 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
28017 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
28018
28019 @item
28020 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
28021 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
28022
28023 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28024 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28025 out other articles.
28026
28027 @item
28028 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28029
28030 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28031 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28032 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28033 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28034
28035 @item
28036 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28037
28038 @end itemize
28039
28040 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28041 @c ****************************************************
28042
28043 @itemize @bullet
28044
28045 @item
28046 Delayed articles
28047
28048 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28049 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28050 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28051
28052 @item
28053 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28054 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28055
28056 @item
28057 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28058 Gcc articles as read.
28059
28060 @item
28061 Externalizing of attachments
28062
28063 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28064 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28065 local files as external parts.
28066
28067 @item
28068 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28069 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28070
28071 @item
28072 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28073
28074 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28075 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28076 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28077 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28078 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28079 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28080 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28081 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28082 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28083
28084 @item
28085 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28086
28087 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28088 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28089 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28090 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28091 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28092 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28093
28094 @item
28095 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28096 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28097 @code{nil}.
28098
28099 @item
28100 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28101
28102 @item
28103 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28104
28105 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28106 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28107 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28108 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28109 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28110 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28111 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28112 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28113 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28114 was inserted directly.
28115
28116 @item
28117 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28118
28119 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28120 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28121 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28122 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28123 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28124
28125 @item
28126 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28127
28128 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28129 @lisp
28130 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28131 'bbdb-complete-name)
28132 @end lisp
28133
28134 @item
28135 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28136
28137 Add a new format of match like
28138 @lisp
28139 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28140 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28141 @end lisp
28142 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28143 @lisp
28144 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28145 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28146 @end lisp
28147
28148 @item
28149 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28150
28151 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28152 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28153 need add those two headers too.
28154
28155 @item
28156 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28157 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28158 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28159 versions.
28160
28161 @item
28162 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28163 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28164 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28165 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28166 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28167
28168 @item
28169 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28170
28171 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28172
28173 @item
28174 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28175
28176 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28177 the valid values.
28178
28179 @item
28180 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28181
28182 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28183 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28184 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28185 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28186 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28187 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28188 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28189 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28190
28191 @item
28192 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28193 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
28194
28195 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28196 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28197 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28198 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28199
28200 @item
28201 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28202 C-m}.
28203
28204 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28205 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28206
28207 @item
28208 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28209 @code{best}.
28210
28211 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28212 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28213 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28214 invalidate the digital signature.
28215
28216 @item
28217 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28218 decompressed when activated.
28219 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28220
28221 @item
28222 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28223
28224 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28225 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28226 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28227 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28228 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28229 controls this.
28230
28231 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28232 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28233 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28234 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28235
28236 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28237 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28238 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28239 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28240
28241 @end itemize
28242
28243 @item Changes in back ends
28244 @c ***********************
28245
28246 @itemize @bullet
28247 @item
28248 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28249
28250 @item
28251 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28252
28253 @item
28254 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28255
28256 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28257
28258 @item
28259 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28260
28261 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28262 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28263 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28264 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
28265 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28266 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28267 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28268 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28269 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28270 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28271 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28272
28273 @end itemize
28274
28275 @item Appearance
28276 @c *************
28277
28278 @itemize @bullet
28279
28280 @item
28281 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28282 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28283
28284 @item
28285 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28286 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28287 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28288 message, Message Manual}).
28289
28290 @item
28291 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28292 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28293 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28294 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28295
28296 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28297 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28298 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28299 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28300 @end itemize
28301
28302
28303 @item Miscellaneous changes
28304 @c ************************
28305
28306 @itemize @bullet
28307
28308 @item
28309 @code{gnus-agent}
28310
28311 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28312 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28313 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28314 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28315 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28316 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28317 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28318 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28319 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28320 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28321 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28322 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28323 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28324 is not needed any more.
28325
28326 @item
28327 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28328
28329 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28330 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28331 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28332
28333 @item
28334 Dired integration
28335
28336 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28337 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28338 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28339 entry.
28340
28341 @item
28342 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28343
28344 @item
28345 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28346
28347 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28348
28349 @end itemize
28350
28351 @end itemize
28352
28353 @node No Gnus
28354 @subsubsection No Gnus
28355 @cindex No Gnus
28356
28357 New features in No Gnus:
28358 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28359
28360 @include gnus-news.texi
28361
28362 @node Ma Gnus
28363 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28364 @cindex Ma Gnus
28365
28366 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28367 Gnus.
28368
28369 New features in Ma Gnus:
28370
28371 @itemize @bullet
28372
28373 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28374 @c ****************************************************
28375
28376 @itemize @bullet
28377
28378 @item
28379 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28380 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28381 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28382 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28383
28384 @end itemize
28385
28386 @end itemize
28387
28388 @iftex
28389
28390 @page
28391 @node The Manual
28392 @section The Manual
28393 @cindex colophon
28394 @cindex manual
28395
28396 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28397 either @code{texi2dvi}
28398 @iflatex
28399 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28400 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28401 @end iflatex
28402 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28403
28404 The following conventions have been used:
28405
28406 @enumerate
28407
28408 @item
28409 This is a @samp{string}
28410
28411 @item
28412 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28413
28414 @item
28415 This is a @file{file}
28416
28417 @item
28418 This is a @code{symbol}
28419
28420 @end enumerate
28421
28422 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28423 mean:
28424
28425 @lisp
28426 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28427 @end lisp
28428
28429 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28430
28431 @lisp
28432 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28433 @end lisp
28434
28435 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28436 ever get them confused.
28437
28438 @iflatex
28439 @c @head
28440 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28441 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28442 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28443 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28444 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28445 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28446 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28447 @end iflatex
28448
28449 @end iftex
28450
28451
28452 @node On Writing Manuals
28453 @section On Writing Manuals
28454
28455 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28456 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28457 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28458 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28459 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28460 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28461 in hand.
28462
28463 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28464 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28465 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28466 started with Gnus.
28467
28468 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28469 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28470
28471
28472 @page
28473 @node Terminology
28474 @section Terminology
28475
28476 @cindex terminology
28477 @table @dfn
28478
28479 @item news
28480 @cindex news
28481 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28482 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28483 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28484 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28485 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28486
28487 @item mail
28488 @cindex mail
28489 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28490 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28491 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28492 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28493
28494 @item reply
28495 @cindex reply
28496 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28497
28498 @item follow up
28499 @cindex follow up
28500 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28501 are reading.
28502
28503 @item back end
28504 @cindex back end
28505 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28506 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28507 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28508 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28509 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28510 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28511 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28512 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28513 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28514 number 4711''.
28515
28516 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28517 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28518 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28519 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28520 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28521 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28522
28523 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28524 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28525 access the articles.
28526
28527 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28528 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28529 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28530 confusing.
28531
28532 @item native
28533 @cindex native
28534 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28535 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28536 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28537
28538 @item foreign
28539 @cindex foreign
28540 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28541 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28542 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28543 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28544
28545 @item secondary
28546 @cindex secondary
28547 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28548 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28549 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28550
28551 @item article
28552 @cindex article
28553 A message that has been posted as news.
28554
28555 @item mail message
28556 @cindex mail message
28557 A message that has been mailed.
28558
28559 @item message
28560 @cindex message
28561 A mail message or news article
28562
28563 @item head
28564 @cindex head
28565 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.)@: is
28566 put.
28567
28568 @item body
28569 @cindex body
28570 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28571 body.
28572
28573 @item header
28574 @cindex header
28575 A line from the head of an article.
28576
28577 @item headers
28578 @cindex headers
28579 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28580 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28581
28582 @item @acronym{NOV}
28583 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28584 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28585 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28586 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28587 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28588 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28589
28590 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28591 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28592 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28593 normal @sc{head} format.
28594
28595 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28596 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28597 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28598 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28599 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28600 references, etc.
28601
28602 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28603 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28604 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28605 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28606 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28607 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28608 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28609
28610 @item level
28611 @cindex levels
28612 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
28613 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28614 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28615 @dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28616 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28617 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28618
28619 @item killed groups
28620 @cindex killed groups
28621 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28622 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28623
28624 @item zombie groups
28625 @cindex zombie groups
28626 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28627
28628 @item active file
28629 @cindex active file
28630 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28631 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28632 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28633
28634 @item bogus groups
28635 @cindex bogus groups
28636 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28637 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28638 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28639
28640 @item activating
28641 @cindex activating groups
28642 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28643 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28644 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28645
28646 @item spool
28647 @cindex spool
28648 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28649 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28650 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28651
28652 @item server
28653 @cindex server
28654 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28655
28656 @item select method
28657 @cindex select method
28658 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28659 server settings.
28660
28661 @item virtual server
28662 @cindex virtual server
28663 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28664 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28665 whole is a virtual server.
28666
28667 @item washing
28668 @cindex washing
28669 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28670 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28671 original.
28672
28673 @item ephemeral groups
28674 @cindex ephemeral groups
28675 @cindex temporary groups
28676 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28677 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28678 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28679
28680 @item solid groups
28681 @cindex solid groups
28682 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28683 group buffer are solid groups.
28684
28685 @item sparse articles
28686 @cindex sparse articles
28687 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28688 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28689
28690 @item threading
28691 @cindex threading
28692 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28693 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28694
28695 @item root
28696 @cindex root
28697 @cindex thread root
28698 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28699 articles in the thread.
28700
28701 @item parent
28702 @cindex parent
28703 An article that has responses.
28704
28705 @item child
28706 @cindex child
28707 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28708
28709 @item digest
28710 @cindex digest
28711 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28712 specified by RFC 1153.
28713
28714 @item splitting
28715 @cindex splitting, terminology
28716 @cindex mail sorting
28717 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28718 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28719 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28720
28721 @end table
28722
28723
28724 @page
28725 @node Customization
28726 @section Customization
28727 @cindex general customization
28728
28729 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28730 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28731 for some quite common situations.
28732
28733 @menu
28734 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28735 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28736 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28737 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28738 @end menu
28739
28740
28741 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28742 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28743
28744 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28745 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28746 Gnus has to get from the server.
28747
28748 @table @code
28749
28750 @item gnus-read-active-file
28751 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28752 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28753 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28754 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28755 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28756
28757 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28758 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28759 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28760 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28761 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28762 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28763 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28764 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28765 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28766 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28767 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28768
28769 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28770 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28771 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28772 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28773 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28774 variables.
28775 @end table
28776
28777
28778 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28779 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28780
28781 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28782 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28783 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28784
28785 @table @code
28786
28787 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28788 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28789 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28790 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28791 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28792
28793 @item gnus-visible-headers
28794 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28795 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28796 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28797 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28798
28799 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28800 @lisp
28801 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28802 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28803 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28804 @end lisp
28805
28806 @item gnus-use-full-window
28807 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28808 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28809 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28810 want to read them anyway.
28811
28812 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28813 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28814 hidden initially.
28815
28816
28817 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28818 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28819 lines, which might save some time.
28820 @end table
28821
28822
28823 @node Little Disk Space
28824 @subsection Little Disk Space
28825 @cindex disk space
28826
28827 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28828 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28829
28830 @table @code
28831
28832 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28833 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28834 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28835 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28836 default.
28837
28838 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28839 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28840 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28841 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28842 default.
28843
28844 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28845 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28846 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28847 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28848 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28849
28850 @end table
28851
28852
28853 @node Slow Machine
28854 @subsection Slow Machine
28855 @cindex slow machine
28856
28857 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28858 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28859
28860 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28861 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28862
28863 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28864 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28865 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28866
28867
28868 @page
28869 @node Troubleshooting
28870 @section Troubleshooting
28871 @cindex troubleshooting
28872
28873 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28874 problems, really.
28875
28876 Ahem.
28877
28878 @enumerate
28879
28880 @item
28881 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28882
28883 @item
28884 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28885 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28886 Gnus will work.
28887
28888 @item
28889 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28890 like @c
28891 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28892 @c
28893 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28894 files lying around. Delete these.
28895
28896 @item
28897 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28898 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28899
28900 @item
28901 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28902 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28903 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28904 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28905 something like that.
28906 @end enumerate
28907
28908 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28909
28910 @cindex bugs
28911 @cindex reporting bugs
28912
28913 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
28914 @findex gnus-bug
28915 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28916 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28917 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28918 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28919
28920 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28921 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28922 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28923 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28924 time.
28925
28926 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28927 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28928 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28929 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28930 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28931 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28932
28933 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28934 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28935 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28936 the bug report.
28937
28938 @cindex patches
28939 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28940 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28941
28942 @cindex edebug
28943 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28944 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28945 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28946 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28947 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28948 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28949 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28950 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28951 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28952 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28953 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28954 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
28955 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
28956 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
28957
28958 @cindex elp
28959 @cindex profile
28960 @cindex slow
28961 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
28962 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
28963 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
28964 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
28965 helps isolating the real problem areas).
28966
28967 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
28968 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
28969 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
28970 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
28971 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
28972 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
28973 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
28974 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
28975 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
28976 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
28977 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
28978 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
28979 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
28980 work perfectly.
28981
28982 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
28983 @cindex ding mailing list
28984 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
28985 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
28986 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
28987 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
28988
28989
28990 @page
28991 @node Gnus Reference Guide
28992 @section Gnus Reference Guide
28993
28994 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
28995 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
28996 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
28997 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
28998 it.
28999
29000 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
29001 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
29002 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
29003 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
29004 and general methods of operation.
29005
29006 @menu
29007 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
29008 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
29009 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
29010 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
29011 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
29012 * Group Info:: The group info format.
29013 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
29014 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
29015 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
29016 @end menu
29017
29018
29019 @node Gnus Utility Functions
29020 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
29021 @cindex Gnus utility functions
29022 @cindex utility functions
29023 @cindex functions
29024 @cindex internal variables
29025
29026 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29027 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29028 Below is a list of the most common ones.
29029
29030 @table @code
29031
29032 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
29033 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29034 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29035
29036 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29037 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29038 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29039
29040 @item gnus-group-real-name
29041 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29042 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29043 name.
29044
29045 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29046 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29047 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29048 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29049
29050 @item gnus-get-info
29051 @findex gnus-get-info
29052 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29053
29054 @item gnus-group-unread
29055 @findex gnus-group-unread
29056 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29057 unknown.
29058
29059 @item gnus-active
29060 @findex gnus-active
29061 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29062 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29063
29064 @item gnus-set-active
29065 @findex gnus-set-active
29066 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29067
29068 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29069 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29070 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29071 exit.
29072
29073 @item gnus-continuum-version
29074 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29075 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29076 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29077 versions.
29078
29079 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29080 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29081 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29082
29083 @item gnus-news-group-p
29084 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29085 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29086
29087 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29088 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29089 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29090
29091 @item gnus-server-to-method
29092 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29093 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29094
29095 @item gnus-server-equal
29096 @findex gnus-server-equal
29097 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29098 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29099 this function will consider them equal.
29100
29101 @item gnus-group-native-p
29102 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29103 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29104
29105 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29106 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29107 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29108
29109 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29110 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29111 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29112
29113 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29114 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29115 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29116 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29117 @var{group}.
29118
29119 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29120 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29121 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29122
29123 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29124 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29125 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29126
29127 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29128 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29129 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29130 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29131
29132 @lisp
29133 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29134 @result{} t
29135 @end lisp
29136
29137 @item gnus-read-method
29138 @findex gnus-read-method
29139 Prompts the user for a select method.
29140
29141 @end table
29142
29143
29144 @node Back End Interface
29145 @subsection Back End Interface
29146
29147 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29148 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29149 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29150 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29151 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29152 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29153
29154 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29155 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29156 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29157 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29158 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29159 been opened, the function should fail.
29160
29161 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29162 name. Take this example:
29163
29164 @lisp
29165 (nntp "odd-one"
29166 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29167 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29168 @end lisp
29169
29170 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29171 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29172
29173 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29174 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29175 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29176
29177 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29178 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29179 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29180
29181 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29182 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29183 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29184 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29185 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29186 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29187 return value.
29188
29189 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29190 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29191 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29192 they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29193 more.
29194
29195 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29196 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29197 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29198 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29199 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29200 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29201 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29202 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29203 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29204 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29205
29206 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29207 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29208 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29209 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29210 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29211 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29212 of numbers as long as possible.
29213
29214 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29215 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29216 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29217
29218 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29219 @code{nnchoke}.
29220
29221 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29222
29223 @menu
29224 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29225 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29226 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29227 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29228 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29229 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29230 @end menu
29231
29232
29233 @node Required Back End Functions
29234 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29235
29236 @table @code
29237
29238 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29239
29240 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29241 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29242 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29243 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29244
29245 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29246 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29247 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29248 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29249
29250 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29251 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29252 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29253 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29254 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29255 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29256 number, do maximum fetches.
29257
29258 Here's an example HEAD:
29259
29260 @example
29261 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29262 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29263 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29264 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29265 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29266 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29267 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29268 Lines: 26
29269 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29270 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29271 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29272 .
29273 @end example
29274
29275 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29276 these in the data buffer.
29277
29278 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29279
29280 @example
29281 headers = *head
29282 head = error / valid-head
29283 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29284 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29285 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29286 header = <text> eol
29287 @end example
29288
29289 @cindex BNF
29290 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29291
29292 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29293 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29294 separated by tabs.
29295
29296 @example
29297 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29298 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29299 field = <text except TAB>
29300 @end example
29301
29302 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29303 @pxref{Headers}.
29304
29305
29306 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29307
29308 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29309 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29310
29311 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29312 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29313 server. In fact, it should do so.
29314
29315 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29316 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29317
29318
29319 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29320
29321 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29322 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29323 reason.
29324
29325 There should be no data returned.
29326
29327
29328 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29329
29330 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29331 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29332 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29333 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29334
29335 There should be no data returned.
29336
29337
29338 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29339
29340 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29341 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29342 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29343 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29344
29345 There should be no data returned.
29346
29347
29348 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29349
29350 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29351
29352 There should be no data returned.
29353
29354
29355 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29356
29357 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29358 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29359 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29360 it would be nice if that were possible.
29361
29362 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29363 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29364 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29365 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29366 into its article buffer.
29367
29368 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29369 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29370 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29371 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29372 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29373 on successful article retrieval.
29374
29375
29376 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29377
29378 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29379 making @var{group} the current group.
29380
29381 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29382 the current group.
29383
29384 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29385 structure.
29386
29387 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29388
29389 @example
29390 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29391 @end example
29392
29393 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29394 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29395 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29396 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29397 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29398 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29399 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29400 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29401 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29402 highest as 0.
29403
29404 @example
29405 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29406 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29407 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29408 @end example
29409
29410
29411 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29412
29413 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29414 a no-op on most back ends.
29415
29416 There should be no data returned.
29417
29418
29419 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29420
29421 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29422 @emph{all}.
29423
29424 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29425
29426 @example
29427 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29428 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29429 @end example
29430
29431 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29432 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29433 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29434 and the highest as 0.
29435
29436 @example
29437 active-file = *active-line
29438 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29439 name = <string>
29440 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29441 @end example
29442
29443 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29444 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29445 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29446
29447
29448 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29449
29450 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29451 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29452 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29453 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29454 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29455 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29456
29457 There should be no result data from this function.
29458
29459 @end table
29460
29461
29462 @node Optional Back End Functions
29463 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29464
29465 @table @code
29466
29467 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29468
29469 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29470 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29471 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29472
29473 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29474 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29475 former is in the same format as the data from
29476 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29477 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29478
29479 @example
29480 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29481 @end example
29482
29483
29484 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29485
29486 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29487 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29488 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29489 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29490 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29491 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29492 the network resources).
29493
29494 There should be no result data from this function.
29495
29496
29497 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29498
29499 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29500 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29501 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29502 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29503 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29504 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29505 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29506 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29507
29508 There should be no result data from this function.
29509
29510
29511 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29512
29513 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29514 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc.)@: internally, and store them in
29515 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29516 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29517 propagate the mark information to the server.
29518
29519 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29520
29521 @example
29522 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29523 @end example
29524
29525 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29526 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29527 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29528 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29529 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29530 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29531 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29532 itself to these.
29533
29534 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29535 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29536 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29537 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29538
29539 An example action list:
29540
29541 @example
29542 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29543 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29544 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29545 @end example
29546
29547 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29548 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29549
29550 There should be no result data from this function.
29551
29552 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29553
29554 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29555 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29556 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29557 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29558 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29559
29560 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29561 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29562 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29563 expirable.
29564
29565 There should be no result data from this function.
29566
29567
29568 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29569
29570 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29571 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29572 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29573 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29574 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29575 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29576 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29577 local if that's practical.
29578
29579 There should be no result data from this function.
29580
29581
29582 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29583
29584 The result data from this function should be a description of
29585 @var{group}.
29586
29587 @example
29588 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29589 name = <string>
29590 description = <text>
29591 @end example
29592
29593 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29594
29595 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29596 groups available on the server.
29597
29598 @example
29599 description-buffer = *description-line
29600 @end example
29601
29602
29603 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29604
29605 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29606 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29607 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29608 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29609 in the active buffer format.
29610
29611 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29612 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29613 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29614 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29615 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29616 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29617 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29618
29619
29620 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29621
29622 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29623
29624 There should be no return data.
29625
29626
29627 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29628
29629 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29630 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29631 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29632 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29633 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29634 they are.
29635
29636 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29637 able to delete.
29638
29639 There should be no result data returned.
29640
29641
29642 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29643
29644 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29645 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29646
29647 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29648 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29649 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29650 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29651 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29652 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29653
29654 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29655 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29656 optimizations.
29657
29658 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29659 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29660
29661 There should be no data returned.
29662
29663
29664 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29665
29666 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29667 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29668 this function in short order.
29669
29670 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29671 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29672
29673 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29674 article for that group.
29675
29676 There should be no data returned.
29677
29678
29679 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29680
29681 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29682 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29683
29684 There should be no data returned.
29685
29686
29687 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29688
29689 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29690 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29691 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29692
29693 There should be no data returned.
29694
29695
29696 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29697
29698 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29699 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29700
29701 There should be no data returned.
29702
29703 @end table
29704
29705
29706 @node Error Messaging
29707 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29708
29709 @findex nnheader-report
29710 @findex nnheader-get-report
29711 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29712 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29713 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29714 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29715 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29716 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29717
29718 @lisp
29719 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29720
29721 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29722 @end lisp
29723
29724 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29725 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29726 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29727 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29728
29729 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29730 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29731 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29732
29733
29734 @node Writing New Back Ends
29735 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29736
29737 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29738 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29739 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29740 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29741 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29742 editing articles.
29743
29744 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29745 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29746 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29747
29748 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29749 package called @code{nnoo}.
29750
29751 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29752 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29753 following macros:
29754
29755 @table @code
29756
29757 @item nnoo-declare
29758 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29759 parameters. For instance:
29760
29761 @lisp
29762 (nnoo-declare nndir
29763 nnml nnmh)
29764 @end lisp
29765
29766 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29767 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29768
29769 @item defvoo
29770 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29771 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29772 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29773
29774 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29775 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29776 a function in those back ends.
29777
29778 @lisp
29779 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29780 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29781 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29782 @end lisp
29783
29784 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29785 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29786 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29787
29788 @item nnoo-define-basics
29789 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29790 have.
29791
29792 @lisp
29793 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29794 @end lisp
29795
29796 @item deffoo
29797 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29798 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29799 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29800
29801 @item nnoo-map-functions
29802 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29803 functions from the parent back ends.
29804
29805 @lisp
29806 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29807 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29808 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29809 @end lisp
29810
29811 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29812 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29813 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29814 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29815
29816 @item nnoo-import
29817 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29818 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29819 haven't already been defined.
29820
29821 @lisp
29822 (nnoo-import nndir
29823 (nnmh
29824 nnmh-request-list
29825 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29826 (nnml))
29827 @end lisp
29828
29829 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29830 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29831 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29832 defined now.
29833
29834 @end table
29835
29836 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29837
29838 @lisp
29839 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29840 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29841
29842 ;;; @r{Code:}
29843
29844 (require 'nnheader)
29845 (require 'nnmh)
29846 (require 'nnml)
29847 (require 'nnoo)
29848 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29849
29850 (nnoo-declare nndir
29851 nnml nnmh)
29852
29853 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29854 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29855 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29856
29857 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29858 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29859 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29860
29861 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29862 nil
29863 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29864 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29865 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29866
29867 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29868 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29869
29870 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29871
29872 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29873
29874 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29875 (setq nndir-directory
29876 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29877 server))
29878 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29879 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29880 (push `(nndir-current-group
29881 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29882 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29883 defs)
29884 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29885 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29886 defs)
29887 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29888
29889 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29890 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29891 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29892 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29893 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29894
29895 (nnoo-import nndir
29896 (nnmh
29897 nnmh-status-message
29898 nnmh-request-list
29899 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29900
29901 (provide 'nndir)
29902 @end lisp
29903
29904
29905 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29906 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29907
29908 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29909 @findex gnus-declare-backend
29910 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29911 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29912 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29913
29914 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29915 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29916
29917 Here's an example:
29918
29919 @lisp
29920 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29921 @end lisp
29922
29923 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29924
29925 The abilities can be:
29926
29927 @table @code
29928 @item mail
29929 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29930 @item post
29931 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29932 @item post-mail
29933 This back end supports both mail and news.
29934 @item none
29935 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29936 different.
29937 @item respool
29938 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29939 articles and groups.
29940 @item address
29941 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29942 true for almost all back ends.
29943 @item prompt-address
29944 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29945 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29946 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29947 @end table
29948
29949
29950 @node Mail-like Back Ends
29951 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29952
29953 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29954 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
29955 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
29956 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
29957
29958 @lisp
29959 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
29960 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
29961 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
29962 @end lisp
29963
29964 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
29965 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
29966 mail.
29967
29968 This function takes four parameters.
29969
29970 @table @var
29971 @item method
29972 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
29973 the call.
29974
29975 @item exit-function
29976 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
29977
29978 @item temp-directory
29979 Where the temporary files should be stored.
29980
29981 @item group
29982 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
29983 performed for one group only.
29984 @end table
29985
29986 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
29987 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
29988 find the article number assigned to this article.
29989
29990 The function also uses the following variables:
29991 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
29992 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
29993 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
29994 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
29995 this:
29996
29997 @example
29998 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
29999 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
30000 @end example
30001
30002
30003 @node Score File Syntax
30004 @subsection Score File Syntax
30005
30006 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
30007 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
30008 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
30009
30010 Here's a typical score file:
30011
30012 @lisp
30013 (("summary"
30014 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
30015 ("Gnus"))
30016 ("from"
30017 ("Lars" -1000))
30018 (mark -100))
30019 @end lisp
30020
30021 BNF definition of a score file:
30022
30023 @example
30024 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30025 element = rule / atom
30026 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30027 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30028 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30029 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30030 quote = <ascii 34>
30031 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30032 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30033 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30034 date-header = "date"
30035 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30036 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30037 score = "nil" / <integer>
30038 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30039 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30040 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30041 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30042 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30043 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30044 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30045 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30046 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30047 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30048 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30049 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30050 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30051 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30052 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30053 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30054 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30055 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30056 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30057 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30058 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30059 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30060 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30061 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30062 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30063 eval = "eval" space <form>
30064 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30065 @end example
30066
30067 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30068 discarded.
30069
30070 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30071 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30072 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30073 one looong line, then that's ok.
30074
30075 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30076 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30077
30078
30079 @node Headers
30080 @subsection Headers
30081
30082 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30083 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30084 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30085 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30086
30087 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30088 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30089 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30090 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30091 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30092 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30093 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30094
30095 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30096 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30097 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30098 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30099 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30100
30101 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30102 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30103
30104
30105 @node Ranges
30106 @subsection Ranges
30107
30108 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30109 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30110
30111 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30112 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30113 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30114 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30115
30116 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30117 sequence.
30118
30119 @example
30120 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30121 @end example
30122
30123 is transformed into
30124
30125 @example
30126 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30127 @end example
30128
30129 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30130 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30131
30132 @example
30133 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30134 @end example
30135
30136 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30137 is slightly tricky:
30138
30139 @example
30140 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30141 @end example
30142
30143 and
30144
30145 @example
30146 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30147 @end example
30148
30149 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30150
30151 @example
30152 (1 2 3 4 5)
30153 @end example
30154
30155 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30156 also valid:
30157
30158 @example
30159 (1 . 5)
30160 @end example
30161
30162 and is equal to the previous range.
30163
30164 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30165 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30166 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30167 range handling.)
30168
30169 @example
30170 range = simple-range / normal-range
30171 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30172 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30173 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30174 number *[ " " contents ]
30175 @end example
30176
30177 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30178 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30179 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30180 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30181 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30182 sequences.)
30183
30184
30185 @node Group Info
30186 @subsection Group Info
30187
30188 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30189 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30190 describes the group.
30191
30192 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30193 second is a more complex one:
30194
30195 @example
30196 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30197
30198 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30199 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30200 (nnml "")
30201 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30202 @end example
30203
30204 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30205 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30206 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30207 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30208 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30209 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30210 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30211 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30212 this section is about.
30213
30214 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30215 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30216 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30217
30218 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30219
30220 @example
30221 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30222 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30223 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30224 group = quote <string> quote
30225 ralevel = rank / level
30226 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30227 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30228 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30229 read = range
30230 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30231 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30232 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30233 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30234 @end example
30235
30236 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30237 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30238 in pseudo-BNF.
30239
30240 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30241 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30242
30243 @table @code
30244 @item gnus-info-group
30245 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30246 @findex gnus-info-group
30247 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30248 Get/set the group name.
30249
30250 @item gnus-info-rank
30251 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30252 @findex gnus-info-rank
30253 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30254 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30255
30256 @item gnus-info-level
30257 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30258 @findex gnus-info-level
30259 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30260 Get/set the group level.
30261
30262 @item gnus-info-score
30263 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30264 @findex gnus-info-score
30265 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30266 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30267
30268 @item gnus-info-read
30269 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30270 @findex gnus-info-read
30271 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30272 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30273
30274 @item gnus-info-marks
30275 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30276 @findex gnus-info-marks
30277 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30278 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30279
30280 @item gnus-info-method
30281 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30282 @findex gnus-info-method
30283 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30284 Get/set the group select method.
30285
30286 @item gnus-info-params
30287 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30288 @findex gnus-info-params
30289 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30290 Get/set the group parameters.
30291 @end table
30292
30293 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30294 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30295
30296 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30297 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30298 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30299 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30300
30301
30302 @node Extended Interactive
30303 @subsection Extended Interactive
30304 @cindex interactive
30305 @findex gnus-interactive
30306
30307 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30308 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30309 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30310
30311 @lisp
30312 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30313 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30314 ...
30315 )
30316 @end lisp
30317
30318 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30319 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30320 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30321 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30322 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30323 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30324 @code{interactive}.
30325
30326 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30327 adds a few more.
30328
30329 @table @samp
30330 @item y
30331 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30332 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30333 variable.
30334
30335 @item Y
30336 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30337 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30338 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30339
30340 @item A
30341 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30342 function.
30343
30344 @item H
30345 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30346 function.
30347
30348 @item g
30349 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30350 function.
30351
30352 @end table
30353
30354
30355 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30356 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30357 @cindex XEmacs
30358 @cindex Emacsen
30359
30360 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30361 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30362 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30363
30364 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30365 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30366 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30367 Gnus, that's very useful.
30368
30369 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30370 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30371 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30372 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30373 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30374 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30375 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30376 following function:
30377
30378 @lisp
30379 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30380 (start-itimer
30381 "gnus-run-at-time"
30382 `(lambda ()
30383 (,function ,@@args))
30384 time repeat))
30385 @end lisp
30386
30387 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30388 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30389 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30390 all over.
30391
30392 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30393 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30394 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30395
30396 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30397 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30398 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30399
30400
30401 @node Various File Formats
30402 @subsection Various File Formats
30403
30404 @menu
30405 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30406 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30407 @end menu
30408
30409
30410 @node Active File Format
30411 @subsubsection Active File Format
30412
30413 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30414 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30415 in each group.
30416
30417 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30418
30419 @example
30420 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30421 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30422 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30423 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30424 no.general 1000 900 y
30425 @end example
30426
30427 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30428
30429 @example
30430 active = *group-line
30431 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30432 group = <non-white-space string>
30433 spc = " "
30434 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30435 low-number = <positive integer>
30436 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30437 @end example
30438
30439 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30440 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30441
30442
30443 @node Newsgroups File Format
30444 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30445
30446 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30447 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30448 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30449 the user.
30450
30451 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30452 Here's the definition:
30453
30454 @example
30455 newsgroups = *line
30456 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30457 group = <non-white-space string>
30458 tab = <TAB>
30459 description = <string>
30460 @end example
30461
30462
30463 @page
30464 @node Emacs for Heathens
30465 @section Emacs for Heathens
30466
30467 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30468 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30469 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30470 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30471 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30472 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30473 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30474 cat instead.
30475
30476 @menu
30477 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30478 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30479 @end menu
30480
30481
30482 @node Keystrokes
30483 @subsection Keystrokes
30484
30485 @itemize @bullet
30486 @item
30487 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30488
30489 @item
30490 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30491 @end itemize
30492
30493 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30494 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30495 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30496 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30497 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30498 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30499
30500 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30501 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30502 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30503 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30504 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30505 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30506 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30507
30508 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30509 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30510 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30511 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30512 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30513 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30514 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30515
30516 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30517 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30518 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30519 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30520 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30521 it.
30522
30523
30524
30525 @node Emacs Lisp
30526 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30527
30528 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30529 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30530 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30531 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30532
30533 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30534 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30535 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30536 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30537 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30538 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30539 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30540 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30541 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30542 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30543
30544 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30545 write the following:
30546
30547 @lisp
30548 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30549 @end lisp
30550
30551 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30552 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30553 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30554 change how Gnus works.
30555
30556 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30557 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30558 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30559 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30560 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30561
30562 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30563 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30564 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30565
30566 Some pitfalls:
30567
30568 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30569 that means:
30570
30571 @lisp
30572 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30573 @end lisp
30574
30575 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30576 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30577
30578 @lisp
30579 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30580 @end lisp
30581
30582 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30583 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30584
30585 @page
30586 @include gnus-faq.texi
30587
30588 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30589 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30590 @include doclicense.texi
30591
30592 @node Index
30593 @chapter Index
30594 @printindex cp
30595
30596 @node Key Index
30597 @chapter Key Index
30598 @printindex ky
30599
30600 @bye
30601
30602 @iftex
30603 @iflatex
30604 \end{document}
30605 @end iflatex
30606 @end iftex
30607
30608 @c Local Variables:
30609 @c mode: texinfo
30610 @c coding: utf-8
30611 @c End: